0% found this document useful (0 votes)
579 views214 pages

Dan Foss VLT

Manual de fabricante de Variador Danfoss VLT Automation Drive FC300

Uploaded by

Victor A Diaz
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
579 views214 pages

Dan Foss VLT

Manual de fabricante de Variador Danfoss VLT Automation Drive FC300

Uploaded by

Victor A Diaz
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd

MAKING MODERN LIVING POSSIBLE

Design Guide
VLT AutomationDrive FC 301/302
0.2575 kW

www.danfoss.com/drives

Contents

Design Guide

Contents
1 Introduction

1.1 Purpose of the Design Guide

1.2 Additional Resources

1.3 Abbreviations, Symbols and Conventions

1.4 Definitions

10

1.5 Document and Software Version

11

1.6 Regulatory Compliance

11

1.6.1 CE Mark

11

1.6.1.1 Low Voltage Directive

11

1.6.1.2 EMC Directive

12

1.6.1.3 Machinery Directive

12

1.6.2 UL Compliance

12

1.6.3 C-tick Compliance

12

1.6.4 Marine Compliance

12

1.7 Disposal Instruction

12

1.8 Safety

12

2 Safety

MG33BF22

13

2.1 Safety Symbols

13

2.2 Qualified Personnel

13

2.3 Safety Precautions

13

3 Basic Operating Principles

15

3.1 General

15

3.2 Description of Operation

15

3.3 Sequence of Operation

15

3.3.1 Rectifier Section

15

3.3.2 Intermediate Section

15

3.3.3 Inverter Section

15

3.3.4 Brake Option

16

3.3.5 Load Sharing

16

3.4 Control Interface

16

3.5 Wiring Schematic

17

3.6 Controls

19

3.6.1 Control Principle

19

3.6.2 FC 301 vs. FC 302 Control Principle

20

3.6.3 Control Structure in VVCplus

21

3.6.4 Control Structure in Flux Sensorless (FC 302 only)

22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

Contents

Design Guide

3.6.5 Control Structure in Flux with Motor Feedback (FC 302 only)

23

3.6.6 PID

24

3.6.6.1 Speed PID Control

24

3.6.6.2 Tuning PID speed control

27

3.6.6.3 Process PID Control

27

3.6.6.4 Advanced PID Control

29

3.6.7 Internal Current Control in VVCplus Mode

29

3.6.8 Local (Hand On) and Remote (Auto On) Control

29

3.7 Reference Handling

31

3.7.1 References

31

3.7.2 Reference Limits

33

3.7.3 Scaling of Preset References and Bus References

34

3.7.4 Scaling of Analog and Pulse References and Feedback

34

3.7.5 Dead Band Around Zero

35

4 Product Features

39

4.1 Automated Operational Features

39

4.1.1 Short Circuit Protection

39

4.1.2 Overvoltage Protection

39

4.1.3 Missing Motor Phase Detection

40

4.1.4 Line Phase Imbalance Detection

40

4.1.5 Switching on the Output

40

4.1.6 Overload Protection

40

4.1.7 Locked Rotor Protection

40

4.1.8 Automatic Derating

41

4.1.9 Automatic Energy Optimization

41

4.1.10 Automatic Switching Frequency Modulation

41

4.1.11 Automatic Derating for High Carrier Frequency

41

4.1.12 Power Fluctuation Performance

41

4.1.13 Resonance Damping

41

4.1.14 Temperature-controlled Fans

41

4.1.15 EMC Compliance

42

4.1.16 Galvanic Isolation of Control Terminals

42

4.2 Custom Application Features

42

4.2.1 Automatic Motor Adaptation

42

4.2.2 Motor Thermal Protection

42

4.2.3 Line Drop-out

43

4.2.4 Built-in PID Controller

43

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Contents

Design Guide

4.2.5 Automatic Restart

43

4.2.6 Flying Start

43

4.2.7 Full Torque at Reduced Speed

43

4.2.8 Frequency Bypass

44

4.2.9 Motor Preheat

44

4.2.10 Four Programmable Set-ups

44

4.2.11 Dynamic Braking

44

4.2.12 Open-loop Mechanical Brake Control

45

4.2.13 Closed-loop Mechanical Brake Control/Hoist Mechanical Brake

46

4.2.14 Smart Logic Control (SLC)

47

4.2.15 Safe Torque Off

48

4.3 Danfoss

VLT

FlexConcept

5 System Integration

49

5.1 Ambient Operating Conditions

49

5.1.1 Humidity

49

5.1.2 Temperature

49

5.1.3 Temperature and Cooling

49

5.1.4 Manual Derating

50

5.1.4.1 Derating for Running at Low Speed

50

5.1.4.2 Derating for Low Air Pressure

50

5.1.5 Acoustic Noise

51

5.1.6 Vibration and Shock

51

5.1.7 Aggressive Atmospheres

51

5.1.7.1 Gases

51

5.1.7.2 Dust Exposure

52

5.1.7.3 Potentially Explosive Atmospheres

52

5.1.8 Maintenance

53

5.1.9 Storage

53

5.2 General Aspects of EMC

53

5.2.1 EMC Test Results

54

5.2.2 Emission Requirements

56

5.2.3 Immunity Requirements

57

5.2.4 Motor Insulation

58

5.2.5 Motor Bearing Currents

58

5.3 Line Power Supply Interference/Harmonics

MG33BF22

48

59

5.3.1 The Effect of Harmonics in a Power Distribution System

59

5.3.2 Harmonic Limitation Standards and Requirements

60

5.3.3 Harmonic Mitigation

60

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

Contents

Design Guide

5.3.4 Harmonic Calculation

5.4 Galvanic Isolation (PELV)


5.4.1 PELV - Protective Extra Low Voltage

5.5 Brake Functions

60
61
61
61

5.5.1 Selection of Brake Resistor

61

6 Product Specifications

64

6.1 Electrical Data

64

6.1.1 Line Power Supply 200240 V

64

6.1.2 Line Power Supply 380500 V

66

6.1.3 Line Power Supply 525600 V (FC 302 only)

69

6.1.4 Line Power Supply 525690 V (FC 302 only)

72

6.2 General Specifications

75

6.2.1 Line Power Supply

75

6.2.2 Motor Output and Motor Data

75

6.2.3 Ambient Conditions

76

6.2.4 Cable Specifications

76

6.2.5 Control Input/Output and Control Data

77

6.2.6 Derating for Ambient Temperature

81

6.2.6.1 Derating for Ambient Temperature, Enclosure Type A

81

6.2.6.2 Derating for Ambient Temperature, Enclosure Types B

81

6.2.6.3 Derating for Ambient Temperature, Enclosure Types C

84

6.2.7 Measured Values for dU/dt Testing

87

6.2.8 Efficiency

90

6.2.9 Acoustic Noise

90

7 How to Order

91

7.1 Drive Configurator

91

7.1.1 Type Code

91

7.1.2 Language

94

7.2 Ordering Numbers

95

7.2.1 Options and Accessories

95

7.2.2 Spare Parts

97

7.2.3 Accessory Bags

97

7.2.4 VLT AutomationDrive FC 301

98

7.2.5 Brake Resistors for FC 302

102

7.2.6 Other Flat Pack Brake Resistors

109

7.2.7 Harmonic Filters

111

7.2.8 Sine-Wave Filters

113

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Contents

Design Guide

7.2.9 dU/dt Filters

115

8 Mechanical Installation

117

8.1 Safety

117

8.2 Mechanical Dimensions

118

8.2.1 Mechanical Mounting

121

8.2.1.1 Clearance

121

8.2.1.2 Wall Mounting

121

9 Electrical Installation

123

9.1 Safety

123

9.2 Cables

124

9.2.1 Tightening Torque

124

9.2.2 Entry Holes

125

9.2.3 Tightening of the Cover after Connections are Made

129

9.3 AC line input connections


9.3.1 Fuses and Circuit Breakers

133

9.3.1.1 Fuses

133

9.3.1.2 Recommendations

133

9.3.1.3 CE Compliance

134

9.3.1.4 UL Compliance

137

9.4 Motor Connection

142

9.5 Ground Leakage Current Protection

144

9.6 Additional Connections

146

9.6.1 Relay

146

9.6.2 Disconnectors and Contactors

147

9.6.3 Load Sharing

148

9.6.4 Brake Resistor

148

9.6.5 PC Software

148

9.6.5.1 MCT 10

149

9.6.5.2 MCT 31

149

9.6.5.3 Harmonic Calculation Software (HCS)

149

9.7 Additional Motor Information

150

9.7.1 Motor Cable

150

9.7.2 Connection of Multiple Motors

150

9.8 Safety

153

9.8.1 High Voltage Test

153

9.8.2 EMC Grounding

153

10 Application Examples
MG33BF22

129

154
Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

Contents

Design Guide

10.1 Commonly Used Applications

154

10.1.1 Closed-loop Drive System

159

10.1.2 Programming of Torque Limit and Stop

159

10.1.3 Programming of Speed Control

160

11 Options and Accessories

162

11.1 Communication Options

162

11.2 I/O, Feedback and Safety Options

162

11.2.1 VLT General Purpose I/O Module MCB 101

162

11.2.2 VLT Encoder Option MCB 102

164

11.2.3 VLT Resolver Option MCB 103

166

11.2.4

VLT

Relay Card MCB 105

168

11.2.5 VLT Safe PLC Interface Option MCB 108

170

11.2.6 VLT PTC Thermistor Card MCB 112

172

11.2.7 VLT Extended Relay Card MCB 113

173

11.2.8 VLT Sensor Input Option MCB 114

175

11.2.9

VLT

Safe Option MCB 15x

11.2.10 VLT C Option Adapter MCF 106

176
180

11.3 Motion Control Options

180

11.4 Accessories

182

11.4.1 Brake Resistors

182

11.4.2 Sine-wave Filters

182

11.4.3 dU/dt Filters

182

11.4.4 Common Mode Filters

182

11.4.5 Harmonic Filters

182

11.4.6 IP21/Type 1 Enclosure Kit

183

11.4.7 Remote Mounting Kit for LCP

185

11.4.8 Mounting Bracket for Enclosure Types A5, B1, B2, C1 and C2

186

12 RS-485 Installation and Set-up

188

12.1 Installation and Set-up

188

12.1.1 Overview

188

12.2 Network Connection

189

12.3 Bus Termination

189

12.4 RS-485 Installation and Set-up

189

12.5 FC Protocol Overview

190

12.6 Network Configuration

190

12.7 FC Protocol Message Framing Structure

190

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Contents

Design Guide

12.7.1 Content of a Character (byte)

190

12.7.2 Message Structure

190

12.7.3 Message Length (LGE)

191

12.7.4 Adjustable Frequency Drive Address (ADR)

191

12.7.5 Data Control Byte (BCC)

191

12.7.6 The Data Field

192

12.7.7 The PKE Field

193

12.7.8 Parameter Number (PNU)

193

12.7.9 Index (IND)

193

12.7.10 Parameter Value (PWE)

194

12.7.11 Supported Data Types

194

12.7.12 Conversion

194

12.7.13 Process Words (PCD)

195

12.8 Examples

195

12.8.1 Writing a Parameter Value

195

12.8.2 Reading a Parameter Value

195

12.9 Modbus RTU Overview

MG33BF22

196

12.9.1 Assumptions

196

12.9.2 What the User Should Already Know

196

12.9.3 Modbus RTU Overview

196

12.9.4 Adjustable Frequency Drive with Modbus RTU

196

12.10 Network Configuration

197

12.11 Modbus RTU Message Framing Structure

197

12.11.1 Adjustable Frequency Drive with Modbus RTU

197

12.11.2 Modbus RTU Message Structure

197

12.11.3 Start/Stop Field

197

12.11.4 Address Field

198

12.11.5 Function Field

198

12.11.6 Data Field

198

12.11.7 CRC Check Field

198

12.11.8 Coil Register Addressing

198

12.11.9 How to Control the Adjustable Frequency Drive

200

12.11.10 Function Codes Supported by Modbus RTU

200

12.11.11 Modbus Exception Codes

200

12.12 How to Access Parameters

201

12.12.1 Parameter Handling

201

12.12.2 Storage of Data

201

12.12.3 IND (Index)

201

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

Contents

Design Guide

12.12.4 Text Blocks

201

12.12.5 Conversion Factor

201

12.12.6 Parameter Values

201

12.13 Danfoss FC Control Profile

202

12.13.1 Control Word According to FC Profile (8-10 Control Profile = FC profile)

202

12.13.2 Status Word According to FC Profile (STW) (8-10 Control Profile = FC


profile)

203

12.13.3 Bus Speed Reference Value

204

12.13.4 Control Word according to PROFIdrive Profile (CTW)

205

12.13.5 Status Word according to PROFIdrive Profile (STW)

206

Index

208

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Introduction

Design Guide

1 1

1 Introduction
1.1 Purpose of the Design Guide

60 AVM

60 Asynchronous Vector Modulation

Ampere/AMP

AC

Alternating current

AD

Air discharge

AI

Analog Input

AMA

Automatic Motor Adaptation

AWG

American wire gauge

1.2 Additional Resources

Degrees Celsius

CD

Contant discharge

Other resources are available to understand advanced


adjustable frequency drive operation, programming, and
directives compliance.

CM

Common mode

CT

Constant torque

DC

Direct current

DI

Digital Input

DM

Differential mode

D-TYPE

Drive Dependent

The Design Guide provides information required for


integration of the adjustable frequency drive in a diversity
of applications.
VLT is a registered trademark.

The Instruction Manual provides detailed


information for the installation and start up of
the adjustable frequency drive.

EMC

Electro Magnetic Compatibility

The Programming Guide provides greater detail in


how to work with parameters and many
application examples.

ETR

Electronic Thermal Relay

fJOG

Motor frequency when jog function is


activated

The VLT Safe Torque Off Instruction Manual


describes how to use Danfoss adjustable
frequency drives in functional safety applications.

fM

Motor frequency

fMAX

Supplementary publications and manuals are


available from Danfoss. See danfoss.com/Product/
Literature/Technical+Documentation.htm for
listings.

The maximum output frequency the


adjustable frequency drive applies on its
output.

fMIN

The minimum motor frequency from


adjustable frequency drive.

fM,N

Nominal motor frequency

FC

Adjustable frequency drive

Optional equipment is available that may change


some of the information described in these
publications. Be sure to see the instructions
supplied with the options for specific
requirements.

Contact a Danfoss supplier or go to www.danfoss.com for


additional information.

1.3 Abbreviations, Symbols and


Conventions
Conventions
Numbered lists indicate procedures.
Bullet lists indicate other information and description of
figures.
Italicized text indicates

Gram

Hiperface

Hiperface is a registered trademark by


Stegmann

hp

Horsepower

HTL

HTL encoder (1030 V) pulses - High-voltage


Transistor Logic

Hz

Hertz

IINV

Rated Inverter Output Current

ILIM

Current limit

IM,N

Nominal motor current

IVLT,MAX

The maximum output current

IVLT,N

The rated output current supplied by the


adjustable frequency drive

kHz

Kilohertz

LCP

Local Control Panel

lsb

Least significant bit

cross reference

Meter

link

mA

Milliampere

MCM

Mille Circular Mil

MCT

Motion Control Tool

mH

Millihenry Inductance

footnote
parameter name, parameter group name,
parameter option

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

1 1

Design Guide

Introduction

The following symbols are used in this document:

min

Minute

ms

Millisecond

msb

Most significant bit

VLT

Efficiency of the adjustable frequency drive


defined as ratio between power output and
power input

nF

Nanofarad

NLCP

Numerical Local Control Panel

Nm

Newton Meters

ns

Synchronous Motor Speed

Online/Offline
Parameters

Changes to online parameters are activated


immediately after the data value is changed.

Pbr,cont.

Rated power of the brake resistor (average


power during continuous braking)

PCB

Printed Circuit Board

PCD

Process Data
Protective Extra Low Voltage

Pm

Adjustable frequency drive nominal output


power as HO

PM,N

Nominal motor power

PM motor

Permanent Magnet motor

Process PID

The PID regulator maintains the desired speed,


pressure, temperature, etc.

Rbr,nom

The nominal resistor value that ensures a


braking energy on motor shaft of 150/160%
for 1 minute

RCD

Residual Current Device

Regen

Regenerative terminals

Rmin

Minimum permissible brake resistor value by


adjustable frequency drive

RMS

Root Mean Square

RPM

Revolutions Per Minute

Rrec

Resistor value and resistance of the brake


resistor

Second

SFAVM

Stator Flux-oriented Asynchronous Vector


Modulation

STW

Status Word

SMPS

Switch Mode Power Supply

THD

Total Harmonic Distortion

TLIM

Torque limit

TTL

TTL encoder (5 V) pulses - Transistor Transistor


Logic

UM,N

Nominal motor voltage

Volts
Variable Torque

VVCplus

Voltage Vector Control

Table 1.1 Abbreviations

10

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which could


result in death or serious injury.

CAUTION

PELV

VT

WARNING

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which could


result in minor or moderate injury. It may also be used
to alert against unsafe practices.

NOTICE!
Indicates important information, including situations that
may result in damage to equipment or property.

1.4 Definitions
Coast
The motor shaft is in free mode. No torque on motor.
Brake Resistor
The brake resistor is a module capable of absorbing the
braking energy generated in regenerative braking. This
regenerative braking energy increases the intermediate
circuit voltage and a brake chopper ensures that the
power is transmitted to the brake resistor.
CT Characteristics
Constant torque characteristics used for all applications
such as conveyor belts, displacement pumps and cranes.
Initializing
If initialization is carried out (14-22 Operation Mode), the
adjustable frequency drive returns to the default setting.
Intermittent Duty Cycle
An intermittent duty rating refers to a sequence of duty
cycles. Each cycle consists of an on-load and an off-load
period. The operation can be either periodic duty or nonperiodic duty.
Set-up
Save parameter settings in four set-ups. Change between
the four parameter set-ups and edit one set-up, while
another set-up is active.
Slip Compensation
The adjustable frequency drive compensates for the motor
slip by giving the frequency a supplement that follows the
measured motor load, keeping the motor speed almost
constant.
Smart Logic Control (SLC)
The SLC is a sequence of user-defined actions executed
when the associated user-defined events are evaluated as
true by the Smart Logic Controller. (Parameter group 13-**
Smart Logic.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Introduction

Design Guide

FC Standard Bus
Includes RS-485 bus with FC protocol or MC protocol. See
8-30 Protocol.
Thermistor
A temperature-dependent resistor placed where the
temperature is to be monitored (adjustable frequency drive
or motor).
Trip
A state entered in fault situations, e.g., if the adjustable
frequency drive is subject to an overtemperature or when
the adjustable frequency drive is protecting the motor,
process or mechanism. Restart is prevented until the cause
of the fault has disappeared and the trip state is canceled
by activating reset or, in some cases, by being
programmed to reset automatically. Trip may not be used
for personal safety.
Trip Locked
A state entered in fault situations when the adjustable
frequency drive is protecting itself and requiring physical
intervention, e.g., if the adjustable frequency drive is
subject to a short circuit on the output. A locked trip can
only be canceled by cutting off line power, removing the
cause of the fault, and reconnecting the adjustable
frequency drive. Restart is prevented until the trip state is
canceled by activating reset or, in some cases, by being
programmed to reset automatically. Trip may not be used
for personal safety.
VT Characteristics
Variable torque characteristics used for pumps and fans.
Power Factor
The True Power Factor (lambda) takes all the harmonics
into consideration and is always smaller than the Power
Factor (cos-phi) that only considers the 1st harmonics of
current and voltage.
cos =

P kW
U x I x cos
=
P kVA
U x I

Cos-phi is also known as displacement power factor.


Both lambda and cos-phi are stated for Danfoss VLT
adjustable frequency drives in chapter 6.2.1 Line Power
Supply.
The power factor indicates to which extent the adjustable
frequency drive imposes a load on the line power supply.
The lower the power factor, the higher the IRMS for the
same kW performance.
In addition, a high power factor indicates that the different
harmonic currents are low.
All adjustable frequency drives have built-in DC coils in the
DC link to have a high power factor and to reduce the
THD on the main supply.

MG33BF22

1 1
1.5 Document and Software Version
This manual is regularly reviewed and updated. All
suggestions for improvement are welcome. Table 1.2 shows
the document version and the corresponding software
version.
Edition

Remarks

Software version

MG33BFxx

Replaces MG33BExx

6.72

Table 1.2 Document and Software Version

1.6 Regulatory Compliance


Adjustable frequency drives are designed in compliance
with the directives described in this section.

1.6.1 CE Mark
The CE mark (Communaut europenne) indicates that the
product manufacturer conforms to all applicable EU
directives. The three EU directives applicable to the design
and manufacture of adjustable frequency drives are the
directive low-voltage, the EMC directive, and (for units with
an integrated safety function) the machinery directive.
The CE mark is intended to eliminate technical barriers to
free trade between the EC and EFTA states inside the ECU.
The CE mark does not regulate the quality of the product.
Technical specifications cannot be deduced from the CE
mark.

1.6.1.1 Low Voltage Directive


Adjustable frequency drives are classified as electronic
components and must be CE-labelled in accordance with
the low-voltage directive. The directive applies to all
electrical equipment in the 501000 V AC and the 751600
V DC voltage ranges.
The directive mandates that the equipment design must
ensure the safety and health of people and livestock are
not endangered and the preservation of material worth so
long as the equipment is properly installed, maintained,
and used as intended. Danfoss CE labels comply with the
low-voltage directive and provide a declaration of
conformity upon request.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

11

1 1

Introduction

Design Guide

1.6.1.2 EMC Directive

1.6.2 UL Compliance

Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) means that electromagnetic interference between apparatus does not hinder
their performance. The basic protection requirement of the
EMC Directive 2004/108/EC states that devices that
generate electromagnetic interference (EMI), or whose
operation could be affected by EMI, must be designed to
limit the generation of electromagnetic interference and
shall have a suitable degree of immunity to EMI when
properly installed, maintained, and used as intended.

UL-listed

An adjustable frequency drive can be used as stand-alone


device or as part of a more complex installation. Devices
used as stand alone or as part of a system must bear the
CE mark. Systems must not be CE-marked but must
comply with the basic protection requirements of the EMC
directive.

1.6.1.3 Machinery Directive

Figure 1.1 UL

NOTICE!
Adjustable frequency drives of enclosure type T7
(525690 V) are not certified for UL.
The adjustable frequency drive complies with UL508C
thermal memory retention requirements. For more
information, refer to the section Motor Thermal Protection
in the Design Guide.

1.6.3 C-tick Compliance

Adjustable frequency drives are classified as electronic


components subject to the low-voltage directive; however,
adjustable frequency drives with an integrated safety
function must comply with the machinery directive
2006/42/EC. Adjustable frequency drives without the safety
function do not fall under the machinery directive. If an
adjustable frequency drive is integrated into machinery
system, Danfoss provides information on safety aspects
relating to the adjustable frequency drive.
Machinery Directive 2006/42/EC covers a machine
consisting of an aggregate of interconnected components
or devices of which at least one is capable of mechanical
movement. The directive mandates that the equipment
design must ensure the safety and health of people and
livestock are not endangered and the preservation of
material worth so long as the equipment is properly
installed, maintained, and used as intended.
When adjustable frequency drives are used in machines
with at least one moving part, the machine manufacturer
must provide declaration stating compliance with all
relevant statutes and safety measures. Danfoss CE labels
comply with the machinery directive for adjustable
frequency drives with an integrated safety function and
provide a declaration of conformity upon request.

1.6.4 Marine Compliance


1.7 Disposal Instruction
Do not dispose of equipment containing
electrical components together with
domestic waste.
Collect it separately in accordance with
local and currently valid legislation.
Table 1.3 Disposal Instruction

1.8 Safety
Adjustable frequency drives contain high-voltage
components and have the potential for fatal injury if
handled improperly. Only trained technicians should install
and operate the equipment. No repair work should be
attempted without first removing power from the
adjustable frequency drive and waiting the designated
amount of time for stored electrical energy to dissipate.
Refer to the Instruction Manual, shipped with the unit and
available online for:

discharge time, and


detailed safety instructions and warnings.

Strict adherence to safety precautions and notices is


mandatory for safe operation of the adjustable frequency
drive.

12

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Safety

Design Guide

2 Safety

2 2
2.3 Safety Precautions

2.1 Safety Symbols

WARNING

The following symbols are used in this document:

HIGH VOLTAGE

WARNING
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which could
result in death or serious injury.

CAUTION

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which could


result in minor or moderate injury. It may also be used
to alert against unsafe practices.

Installation, start-up, and maintenance must be


performed by qualified personnel only.

WARNING
UNINTENDED START

NOTICE!
Indicates important information, including situations that
may result in damage to equipment or property.

2.2 Qualified Personnel


Correct and reliable transport, storage, installation,
operation and maintenance are required for the troublefree and safe operation of the adjustable frequency drive.
Only qualified personnel is allowed to install or operate
this equipment.
Qualified personnel is defined as trained staff, who are
authorized to install, commission, and maintain equipment,
systems and circuits in accordance with pertinent laws and
regulations. Additionally, the personnel must be familiar
with the instructions and safety measures described in this
document.

MG33BF22

Adjustable frequency drives contain high voltage when


connected to AC line power. Failure to perform installation, start-up, and maintenance by qualified personnel
could result in death or serious injury.

When the adjustable frequency drive is connected to AC


line power, the motor may start at any time, causing risk
of death, serious injury, equipment, or property damage.
The motor can start by means of an external switch, a
serial bus command, an input reference signal from the
LCP, or after a cleared fault condition.
1.

Disconnect the adjustable frequency drive from


line power whenever personal safety considerations make it necessary to avoid unintended
motor start.

2.

Press [Off] on the LCP before programming


parameters.

3.

The adjustable frequency drive, motor, and any


driven equipment must be in operational
readiness when the adjustable frequency drive
is connected to AC line power.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

13

2 2

Safety

Design Guide

WARNING

WARNING

DISCHARGE TIME

EQUIPMENT HAZARD

The adjustable frequency drive contains DC link


capacitors which can remain charged even when the
adjustable frequency drive is not powered. Failure to
wait the specified time after power has been removed
before performing service or repair work could result in
death or serious injury.

Contact with rotating shafts and electrical equipment


can result in death or serious injury.

1.

Stop motor.

2.

Disconnect AC line power, permanent magnet


type motors, and remote DC link power
supplies, including battery backups, UPS, and
DC link connections to other adjustable
frequency drives.

3.

Wait for the capacitors to discharge fully before


performing any service or repair work. The
duration of waiting time is specified in
Table 2.1.

Voltage [V]

Minimum waiting time (minutes)


4

15

200240

0.345 hp
[0.253.7 kW]

7.550 hp
[5.537 kW]

380500

0.3410 hp
[0.257.5 kW]

15100 hp
[1175 kW]

525600

110 hp
[0.757.5 kW]

15100 hp
[1175 kW]

525690

210 hp
[1.57.5 kW]

Ensure that only trained and qualified


personnel perform installation, start-up, and
maintenance.

Ensure that electrical work conforms to national


and local electrical codes.

Follow the procedures in this manual.

CAUTION
WINDMILLING
Unintended rotation of permanent magnet motors
causes risk of personal injury and equipment damage.

Ensure that permanent magnet motors are


blocked to prevent unintended rotation.

CAUTION
POTENTIAL HAZARD IN THE EVENT OF INTERNAL
FAILURE
Risk of personal injury when the adjustable frequency
drive is not properly closed.

Before applying power, ensure all safety covers


are in place and securely fastened.

15100 hp
[1175 kW]

High voltage may be present even when the warning LED


indicator lights are off.
Table 2.1 Discharge Time

WARNING
LEAKAGE CURRENT HAZARD
Leakage currents exceed 3.5 mA. Failure to ground the
adjustable frequency drive properly could result in death
or serious injury.

14

Ensure correct grounding of the equipment by


a certified electrical installer.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3 Basic Operating Principles

3 3

3.1 General
This chapter provides an overview of the adjustable
frequency drives primary assemblies and circuitry. It is
intended to describe the internal electrical and signal
processing functions. A description of the internal control
structure is also included.
Also described are automated and optional adjustable
frequency drive functions available for designing robust
operating systems with sophisticated control and status
reporting performance.

3.2 Description of Operation


The adjustable frequency drive supplies a regulated
amount of AC line power to a standard 3-phase induction
motor to control the motor speed. The adjustable
frequency drive supplies variable frequency and voltage to
the motor.
The adjustable frequency drive is divided into four main
modules.

Rectifier

Figure 3.1 Internal Control Logic

3.3 Sequence of Operation


3.3.1 Rectifier Section
When power is first applied to the adjustable frequency
drive, it enters through the input terminals (L1, L2, and L3)
and on to the disconnect and/or RFI filter option,
depending on the unit's configuration.

Intermediate circuit
Inverter
Control and regulation

In chapter 3.3 Sequence of Operation, these modules are


covered in greater detail and describe how power and
control signals move within the adjustable frequency drive.

3.3.2 Intermediate Section


Following the rectifier section, voltage passes to the
intermediate section. This rectified voltage is smoothed by
an sine-wave filter circuit consisting of the DC bus inductor
and the DC bus capacitor bank.
The DC bus inductor provides series impedance to
changing current. This aids the filtering process while
reducing harmonic distortion to the input AC current
waveform normally inherent in rectifier circuits.

3.3.3 Inverter Section


In the inverter section, once a run command and speed
reference are present, the IGBTs begin switching to create
the output waveform. This waveform, as generated by the
Danfoss VVCplus PWM principle at the control card,
provides optimal performance and minimal losses in the
motor.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

15

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3.3.4 Brake Option


For adjustable frequency drives equipped with the
dynamic brake option, a brake IGBT along with terminals
81(R-) and 82(R+) are included for connecting an external
brake resistor.
The function of the brake IGBT is to limit the voltage in
the intermediate circuit whenever the maximum voltage
limit is exceeded. It does this by switching the externally
mounted resistor across the DC bus to remove excess DC
voltage present on the bus capacitors. Excess DC bus
voltage is generally a result of an overhauling load causing
regenerative energy to return to the DC bus. This occurs,
for example, when the load drives the motor causing the
voltage to return to the DC bus circuit.
Placing the brake resistor externally has the advantages of
selecting the resistor based on application need,
dissipating the energy outside of the control panel, and
protecting the drive from overheating if the brake resistor
is overloaded.
The brake IGBT gate signal originates on the control card
and is delivered to the brake IGBT via the power card and
gate drive card. Additionally, the power and control cards
monitor the brake IGBT and brake resistor connection for
short circuits and overloads.

3.3.5 Load Sharing


Units with the built-in load sharing option contain
terminals (+) 89 DC and () 88 DC. Within the adjustable
frequency drive, these terminals connect to the DC bus in
front of the DC link reactor and bus capacitors.

Attempting such a configuration requires specific considerations and should not be attempted without first
consulting Danfoss application engineering.
In the second method, the adjustable frequency drive is
powered exclusively from a DC source. This is a bit more
complicated. First, a DC source is required. Second, a
means to soft charge the DC bus at power-up is also
required. Last, a voltage source is required to power the
fans within the unit. Again such a configuration should not
be attempted with out first consulting Danfoss application
engineering.

3.4 Control Interface


3.4.1 Control Principle
The adjustable frequency drive receives control input from
several sources.

Local control panel (hand mode)


Programmable analog, digital, and analog/digital
control terminals (auto mode)
The RS-485, USB, or serial communication ports
(auto mode)

When wired and properly programmed, the control


terminals provide feedback, reference, and other input
signals to the adjustable frequency drive; output status
and fault conditions from the adjustable frequency drive,
relays to operate auxiliary equipment, and serial communication interface. A 24 V common is also provided. Control
terminals are programmable for various functions by
selecting parameter options through the local control
panel (LCP) on the front of the unit or external sources.
Most control wiring is customer supplied unless factory
ordered.

The use of the load sharing terminals can take on two


different configurations.
In one method, the terminals are used to tie the DC bus
circuits of multiple adjustable frequency drives together.
This allows one unit that is in a regenerative mode to
share its excess bus voltage with another unit that is
running a motor. Load sharing in this manner can reduce
the need for external dynamic brake resistors while also
saving energy. In theory, the number of units that can be
connected in this way is infinite; however, each unit must
be the same voltage rating. In addition, depending on the
size and number of units, it may be necessary to install DC
reactors and DC fuses in the DC link connections and AC
reactors on line power.

16

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Basic Operating Principles

3-phase
power
input

DC bus

+10 V DC

Switch Mode
Power Supply
10 V DC 24 V DC
15 mA 130/200 mA

88 (-)
89 (+)
50 (+10 V OUT)

ON

53 (A IN)

S202
ON

54 (A IN)

relay1
03

* relay2

12 (+24 V OUT)

01
06

24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)

04

19 (D IN)

24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)

(COM A OUT) 39

27

(D IN/OUT)

24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)

24 V

S801
ON

24 V

1 2

(D IN/OUT)

400 V AC, 2 A

Analog Output
0/4-20 mA

(A OUT) 42

0V
*
29

240 V AC, 2 A

05

P 5-00

18 (D IN)

(COM D IN)

240 V AC, 2 A

02

55 (COM A IN)

20

Brake
resistor

(R-) 81

ON=0/4-20 mA
OFF=0/-10 V DC +10 V DC

13 (+24 V OUT)

3 3

Motor

(R+) 82

S201

1 2

0/-10 V DC +10 V DC
0/4-20 mA

(U) 96
(V) 97
(W) 98
(PE) 99

1 2

0/-10 V DC+10 V DC
0/4-20 mA

91 (L1)
92 (L2)
93 (L3)
95 PE

130BD599.10

3.5 Wiring Schematic

ON=Terminated
OFF=Open

5V
24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)
S801

0V
32 (D IN)

24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)

33 (D IN)

24 V (NPN)
0 V (PNP)

RS-485
Interface

0V
RS-485

(N RS-485) 69
(P RS-485) 68
(COM RS-485) 61

*
37 (D IN)

**
: Chassis
: Ground

Figure 3.2 Basic Wiring Schematic

A=Analog, D=Digital
*Terminal 37 (optional) is used for Safe Torque Off. For Safe Torque Off installation instructions, refer to the Safe Torque Off
Instruction Manual for Danfoss VLT Adjustable Frequency Drives. Terminal 37 is not included in FC 301 (except enclosure type
A1). Relay 2 and terminal 29 have no function in FC 301.
**Do not connect cable shield.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

17

Design Guide

130BD529.11

Basic Operating Principles

3 3

9
10
11
L1
L2
L3
PE

U
V
W
PE
8

PLC

Motor, 3--phase and PE (shielded)

Adjustable frequency drive

Line power, 3--phase and reinforced PE (non-shielded)

Output contactor

Control wiring (shielded)

Cable clamp

10

Potential equalization min. 16 mm2 (0.025 in2)

Cable insulation (stripped)

Cable connector

11

Clearance between control cable, motor cable and line


cable: Min. 7.9 in [200 mm]

Figure 3.3 EMC-compliant Electrical Connection

For more information about EMC, see chapter 4.1.15 EMC Compliance.

18

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

NOTICE!
EMC INTERFERENCE
Run cables for input power, motor wiring and control
wiring in three separate metallic conduits. Failure to
isolate power, motor and control cables can result in
unintended behavior or reduced performance. Minimum
7.9 in [200 mm] clearance between power, motor and
control cables is required.

3.6 Controls
3.6.1 Control Principle
An adjustable frequency drive rectifies AC voltage from
line power into DC voltage, after which DC voltage is
converted into an AC current with a variable amplitude
and frequency.
The motor is supplied with variable voltage/current and
frequency, which enables variable speed control of 3phased, standard asynchronous motors and permanent
magnet motors.
The adjustable frequency drive is capable of controlling
either the speed or the torque on the motor shaft. Setting
1-00 Configuration Mode determines the type of control.
Speed control

Torque control
The torque control function is used in applications where
the torque on motor output shaft is controlling the
application as tension control. Torque control can be
selected in 1-00 Configuration Mode, either in VVCplus [4]
Torque open-loop or Flux control closed-loop with [2] motor
speed feedback. Torque setting is done by setting an
analog, digital or bus controlled reference. The max speed
limit factor is set in 4-21 Speed Limit Factor Source. When
running torque control, it is recommended to make a full
AMA procedure as the correct motor data are of high
importance for optimal performance.

Closed-loop in flux mode with encoder feedback


offers superior performance in all four quadrants
and at all motor speeds.

Open-loop in VVCplus mode. The function is used


in mechanical robust applications, but the
accuracy is limited. Open-loop torque function
works basically only in one speed direction. The
torque is calculated on basic of current
measurement internal in the adjustable frequency
drive.

Speed/torque reference
The reference to these controls can either be a single
reference or the sum of various references including
relatively scaled references. The handling of references is
explained in detail in chapter 3.7 Reference Handling.

There are two types of speed control:


Speed open-loop control which does not require
any feedback from the motor (sensorless).

Speed closed-loop PID control which requires a


speed feedback to an input. A properly optimized
speed closed-loop control has higher accuracy
than a speed open-loop control.

Selects which input to use as speed PID feedback in


7-00 Speed PID Feedback Source.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

19

3 3

Design Guide

3.6.2 FC 301 vs. FC 302 Control Principle

Load sharing +

89(+)

L1 91

R+
82

L2 92

R81

L3 93

Brake
Resistor
U 96
V 97

Load sharing -

88(-)

R inr

Inrush

130BA192.12

FC 301 is a general purpose adjustable frequency drive for variable speed applications. The control principle is based on
Voltage Vector Control (VVCplus).
FC 301 can handle both asynchronous and PM motors.
The current sensing principle in FC 301 is based on current measurement in the DC link or motor phase. The ground fault
protection on the motor side is solved by a de-saturation circuit in the IGBTs connected to the control board.
Short-circuit behavior on FC 301 depends on the current transducer in the positive DC link and the desaturation protection
with feedback from the three lower IGBT's and the brake.

W 98

De-saturation protection
Drive
Control
Board

Figure 3.4 Control Principle FC 301

FC 302 is a high performance adjustable frequency drive for demanding applications. The adjustable frequency drive can
handle various kinds of motor control principles such as U/f special motor mode, VVCplus or Flux Vector motor control.
FC 302 is able to handle permanent magnet synchronous motors (brushless servo motors) as well as normal squirrel cage
asynchronous motors.
Short-circuit behavior on FC 302 depends on the three current transducers in the motor phases and the desaturation
protection with feedback from the brake.
Load sharing +
89(+)

LC Filter +
(5A)

L1 91

R+
82

Brake
Resistor

R81

L2 92

130BA193.14

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

U 96

L3 93

V 97
88(-)
Load sharing -

P 14-50 Rfi Filter

R inr

Inrush

W 98

LC Filter (5A)

Figure 3.5 Control Principle FC 302

20

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

P 1-00
Config. mode

P 4-13
Motor speed
high limit (RPM)

P 4-19
Max. output freq.

P 1-00
Config. mode

P 4-14
Motor speed
high limit (Hz)

+f max.
Motor
controller

P 3-**

High
Ref.

Ramp

+
Process

P 7-20 Process feedback


1 source
P 7-22 Process feedback
2 source

Low
P 4-11
Motor speed
low limit (RPM)
P 4-12
Motor speed
low limit (Hz)

130BA055.10

3.6.3 Control Structure in VVCplus

-f max.

P 4-19
Max. output freq.
P 7-0*
+

Speed
PID

+f max.
Motor
controller
-f max.

P 7-00 Speed PID


feedback source

Figure 3.6 Control Structure in VVCplus Open-loop and Closed-loop Configurations

See Active/Inactive Parameters in Different Drive Control Modes in the Programming Guide for an overview of which control
configuration is available, depending on selection of AC motor or PM non-salient motor. In the configuration shown in
Figure 3.6, 1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to [1] VVCplus and 1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [0] Speed open-loop. The
resulting reference from the reference handling system is received and fed through the ramp limitation and speed limitation
before being sent to the motor control. The output of the motor control is then limited by the maximum frequency limit.
If 1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [1] Speed closed-loop, the resulting reference is passed from the ramp limitation and
speed limitation into a speed PID control. The Speed PID control parameters are located in parameter group 7-0* Speed PID
Ctrl. The resulting reference from the speed PID control is sent to the motor control limited by the frequency limit.
Select [3] Process in 1-00 Configuration Mode to use the process PID control for closed-loop control of, e.g. speed or pressure
in the controlled application. The Process PID parameters are located in parameter group 7-2* Process Ctrl. Feedb and 7-3*
Process PID Ctrl.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

21

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

P 1-00
Config. mode

3 3

P 4-13 Motor speed


high limit [RPM]

P 4-19
Max. output
freq.

P 4-14 Motor speed


high limit [Hz]
High
Ref.

P 7-0*

P 3-**
Ramp

Speed
PID

+f max.
Motor
controller

Low
+

Process
PID

130BA053.11

3.6.4 Control Structure in Flux Sensorless (FC 302 only)

-f max.

P 4-11 Motor speed


low limit [RPM]
P 4-12 Motor speed
low limit [Hz]

P 7-20 Process feedback


1 source
P 7-22 Process feedback
2 source

Figure 3.7 Control Structure in Flux Sensorless Open-loop and Closed-loop Configurations

See Active/Inactive Parameters in Different Drive Control Modes in the Programming Guide for an overview of which control
configuration is available, depending on selection of AC motor or PM non-salient motor. In the configuration shown,
1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to [2] Flux sensorless and 1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [0] Speed open-loop. The
resulting reference from the reference handling system is fed through the ramp and speed limitations as determined by the
parameter settings indicated.
An estimated speed feedback is generated to the speed PID to control the output frequency.
The Speed PID must be set with its P, I, and D parameters (parameter group 7-0* Speed PID control).
Select [3] Process in 1-00 Configuration Mode to use the process PID control for closed-loop control of, e.g., speed or pressure
in the controlled application. The Process PID parameters are found in parameter group 7-2* Process Ctrl. Feedb and 7-3*
Process PID Ctrl.

22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3.6.5 Control Structure in Flux with Motor Feedback (FC 302 only)
130BA054.11

P 1-00
Config. mode

P 1-00
Config. mode

Torque
P 4-13 Motor speed
high limit (RPM)
P 4-14 Motor speed
high limit (Hz)

P 7-2*
Ref.

+
_

High

P 4-19
Max. output
freq.
P 3-**

Process
PID

Ramp

P 7-0*
+
_

Speed
PID

Low
P 7-20 Process feedback
1 source
P 7-22 Process feedback
2 source

+f max.
Motor
controller
-f max.

P 4-11 Motor speed


low limit (RPM)
P 4-12 Motor speed
low limit (Hz)

P 7-00
PID source

Figure 3.8 Control Structure in Flux with Motor Feedback Configuration (only available in FC 302)

See Active/Inactive Parameters in Different Drive Control Modes in the Programming Guide for an overview of which control
configuration is available, depending on selection of AC motor or PM non-salient motor. In the configuration shown,
1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to [3] Flux w motor feedb and 1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [1] Speed closed-loop.
The motor control in this configuration relies on a feedback signal from an encoder or resolver mounted directly on the
motor (set in 1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source).
Select [1] Speed closed-loop in 1-00 Configuration Mode to use the resulting reference as an input for the Speed PID control.
The Speed PID control parameters are located in parameter group 7-0* Speed PID Control.
Select [2] Torque in 1-00 Configuration Mode to use the resulting reference directly as a torque reference. Torque control can
only be selected in the Flux with motor feedback (1-01 Motor Control Principle) configuration. When this mode has been
selected, the reference uses the Nm unit. It requires no torque feedback, since the actual torque is calculated on the basis of
the current measurement of the adjustable frequency drive.
Select [3] Process in 1-00 Configuration Mode to use the process PID control for closed-loop control of, e.g., speed or a
process variable in the controlled application.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

23

3 3

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3.6.6 PID
3.6.6.1 Speed PID Control
Speed PID Control maintains a constant motor speed regardless of the changing load on the motor.
1-00 Configuration Mode

1-01 Motor Control Principle


U/f

VVCplus

Flux Sensorless

Flux w/ enc. feedb

[0] Speed open-loop

ACTIVE

ACTIVE

ACTIVE

N.A.

[1] Speed closed-loop

N.A.

Not Active

N.A.

ACTIVE

[2] Torque

N.A.

N.A.

N.A.

Not Active

[3] Process

Not Active

Not Active

Not Active

N.A.

[4] Torque open-loop

N.A.

Not Active

N.A.

N.A.

[5] Wobble

Not Active

Not Active

Not Active

Not Active

[6] Surface Winder

Not Active

Not Active

Not Active

N.A.

[7] Extend. PID Speed OL

Not Active

Not Active

Not Active

N.A.

[8] Extend. PID Speed CL

N.A.

Not Active

N.A.

Not Active

Table 3.1 Control Configurations with Active Speed Control


N.A. means that the specific mode is not available at all. Not Active means that the specific mode is available but the Speed Control is not
active in that mode.

NOTICE!
The Speed Control PID works under the default parameter setting, but tuning the parameters is highly recommended to
optimize the motor control performance. The two flux motor control principles are particularly dependant on proper
tuning to yield their full potential.
Table 3.2 sums up the characteristics that can be set-up for speed control. See VLT AutomationDrive FC 301/FC 302
Programming Guide for details on programming.

24

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Parameter

Description of function

7-00 Speed PID Feedback Source

Select from which input the speed PID should get its feedback.

7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain

The higher the value, the quicker the control. However, too high value may lead to
oscillations.

7-03 Speed PID Integral Time


7-04 Speed PID Differentiation Time

7-05 Speed PID Diff. Gain Limit

7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time

3 3

Eliminates steady state speed error. Lower value means quick reaction. However, too
high value may lead to oscillations.
Provides a gain proportional to the rate of change of the feedback. A setting of zero
disables the differentiator.
If there are quick changes in reference or feedback in a given application - which means
that the error changes swiftly - the differentiator may soon become too dominant. This
is because it reacts to changes in the error. The quicker the error changes, the stronger
the differentiator gain is. The differentiator gain can thus be limited to allow setting of
the reasonable differentiation time for slow changes and a suitably quick gain for quick
changes.
A low-pass filter that dampens oscillations on the feedback signal and improves steady
state performance. However, a filter time that is too long causes the dynamic
performance of the speed PID control to deteriorate.
Practical settings of parameter 7-06 taken from the number of pulses per revolution from
encoder (PPR):
Encoder PPR

7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time

512

10 ms

1024

5 ms

2048

2 ms

4096

1 ms

7-07 Speed PID Feedback Gear Ratio

The adjustable frequency drive multiplies the speed feedback by this ratio.

7-08 Speed PID Feed Forward Factor

The reference signal bypasses the speed controller by the amount specified. This feature
increases the dynamic performance of the speed control loop.

7-09 Speed PID Error Correction w/ Ramp

The speed error between ramp and actual speed is held up against the setting in this
parameter. If the speed error exceeds this parameter entry, the speed error is corrected
via ramping in a controlled way.

Table 3.2 Relevant Parameters for Speed Control

Program in the order shown (see explanation of settings in the Programming Guide)
In Table 3.3, it is assumed that all other parameters and switches remain at their default setting.
Function

Parameter

Setting

Set the motor parameters using nameplate data.

1-2*

As specified by motor nameplate

Perform an Automatic Motor Adaptation.

1-29 Automatic
Motor Adaptation
(AMA)

[1] Enable complete AMA

1) Make sure the motor runs properly. Do the following:

2) Check the motor is running and the encoder is attached properly. Do the following:
Press [Hand On] on the LCP. Check that the motor is
running and note in which direction it is turning
(referred to below as the positive direction).
Go to 16-20 Motor Angle. Turn the motor slowly in the
positive direction. It must be turned so slowly (only a
few RPM) that it can be determined if the value in

Set a positive reference.

16-20 Motor Angle N.A. (read-only parameter) Note: An increasing value


overflows at 65,535 and starts again at 0.

16-20 Motor Angle is increasing or decreasing.


If 16-20 Motor Angle is decreasing, change the encoder
direction in 5-71 Term 32/33 Encoder Direction.

5-71 Term 32/33


Encoder Direction

[1] Counter-clockwise (if 16-20 Motor Angle is decreasing)

3) Make sure the adjustable frequency drive limits are set to safe values

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

25

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Function

Parameter

Setting

Set acceptable limits for the references.

3-02 Minimum
Reference
3-03 Maximum
Reference

0 RPM (default)
1500 RPM (default)

Check that the ramp settings are within adjustable


frequency drive capabilities and the allowed application
operating specifications.

3-41 Ramp 1
Ramp-up Time
3-42 Ramp 1
Ramp-down Time

default setting
default setting

Set acceptable limits for the motor speed and frequency. 4-11 Motor Speed
Low Limit [RPM]
4-13 Motor Speed
High Limit [RPM]
4-19 Max Output
Frequency

0 RPM (default)
1500 RPM (default)
60 Hz (default 132 Hz)

4) Configure the Speed Control and select the Motor Control principle
Activation of Speed Control.

1-00 Configuration
Mode

Selection of Motor Control Principle.

1-01 Motor Control [3] Flux w motor feedb


Principle

[1] Speed closed-loop

5) Configure and scale the reference to the Speed Control


Set up Analog Input 53 as a reference source.

3-15 Reference
Resource 1

Not necessary (default)

Scale Analog Input 53 0 RPM (0 V) to 1500 RPM (10 V).

6-1*

Not necessary (default)

6) Configure the 24 V HTL encoder signal as feedback for the Motor Control and the Speed Control
Set up digital input 32 and 33 as HTL encoder inputs.

5-14 Terminal 32
Digital Input
5-15 Terminal 33
Digital Input

[0] No operation (default)

Select terminal 32/33 as motor feedback.

1-02 Flux Motor


Feedback Source

Not necessary (default)

Select terminal 32/33 as Speed PID feedback.

7-00 Speed PID


Feedback Source

Not necessary (default)

7-0*

See the guidelines

0-50 LCP Copy

[1] All to LCP

7) Tune the Speed Control PID parameters


Use the tuning guidelines when relevant or tune
manually.
8) Save to finish
Save the parameter setting to the LCP for safe keeping.
Table 3.3 Programming Order

26

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Basic Operating Principles

3.6.6.2 Tuning PID speed control

3.6.6.3 Process PID Control

The following tuning guidelines are relevant when using


one of the Flux motor control principles in applications
where the load is mainly inertial (with a low amount of
friction).

Use the Process PID Control to control application


parameters that can be measured by a sensor (i.e.,
pressure, temperature, flow) and be affected by the
connected motor through a pump, fan or otherwise.

The value of 30-83 Speed PID Proportional Gain is


dependent on the combined inertia of the motor and load,
and the selected bandwidth can be calculated using the
following formula:

Table 3.4 shows the control configurations where the


process control is possible. When a flux vector motor
control principle is used, take care also to tune the speed
control PID parameters. Refer to chapter 3.6 Controls to see
where the speed control is active.

Par . 7 02 =

Total inertia kgm2 x par . 1 25


Par . 1 20 x 9550

NOTICE!

x Bandwidth rad / s

1-20 Motor Power [kW] is the motor power in [kW]


(i.e., enter 4 kW instead of 4000 W in the formula).
A practical value for the bandwidth is 20 rad/s. Check the
result of the 7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain calculation
against the following formula (not required when using a
high-resolution feedback such as a SinCos feedback):
Par . 7 02MAX =

0.01 x 4 x Encoder Resolution x Par . 7 06


x
2x

Max torque ripple %

The recommended start value for 7-06 Speed PID Lowpass


Filter Time is 5 ms (lower encoder resolution calls for a
higher filter value). Typically, a max torque ripple of 3% is
acceptable. For incremental encoders, the encoder
resolution is found in either 5-70 Term 32/33 Pulses per
Revolution (24 V HTL on standard adjustable frequency
drive) or 17-11 Resolution (PPR) (5 V TTL on Encoder Option
MCB 102).

1-00 Configuration Mode


[3] Process

3 3

1-01 Motor Control Principle


U/f

VVCplus

Flux
Flux w/
Sensorless enc. feedb

Not
Active

Process

Process &
Speed

Process &
Speed

Table 3.4 Control Configurations with Process Control

NOTICE!
The Process Control PID works under the default
parameter setting, but tuning the parameters is highly
recommended to optimize the application control
performance. The two Flux motor control principles are
specially dependant on proper Speed Control PID tuning
(before tuning the Process Control PID) to yield their full
potential.

Generally, the practical maximum limit of 7-02 Speed PID


Proportional Gain is determined by the encoder resolution
and the feedback filter time, but other factors in the
application might limit the 7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain
to a lower value.
To minimize the overshoot, 7-03 Speed PID Integral Time
could be set to approx. 2.5 s (varies with the application).
Set 7-04 Speed PID Differentiation Time to 0 until everything
else is tuned. If necessary, finish the tuning by experimenting with small increments of this setting.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

27

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3 3

Figure 3.9 Process PID Control Diagram

Table 3.5 sums up the characteristics that can be set up for the process control.
Parameter

Description of function

7-20 Process CL Feedback 1 Resource

Select from which source (i.e., analog or pulse input) the Process PID should receive its
feedback

7-22 Process CL Feedback 2 Resource

Optional: Determine if (and from where) the process PID should get an additional
feedback signal. If an additional feedback source is selected, the two feedback signals are
added together before being used in the Process PID control.

7-30 Process PID Normal/Inverse Control

Under [0] Normal operation, the Process Control responds with an increase of the motor
speed if the feedback falls lower than the reference. In the same situation, but under [1]
Inverse operation, the Process Control responds with a decreasing motor speed instead.

7-31 Process PID Anti Windup

The anti-windup function ensures that when either a frequency limit or a torque limit is
reached, the integrator is set to a gain that corresponds to the actual frequency. This
avoids integrating on an error that cannot in any case be compensated for with a speed

7-32 Process PID Controller Start Value

In some applications, reaching the required speed/set point can take a very long time. In
such applications, it might be an advantage to set a fixed motor speed from the
adjustable frequency drive before the process control is activated. This is done by setting

7-33 Process PID Proportional Gain

The higher the value, the quicker the control. However, a value that is too large may lead
to oscillations.

7-34 Process PID Integral Time

Eliminates steady state speed error. Lower value means quick reaction. However, a value
that is too small may lead to oscillations.

7-35 Process PID Differentiation Time

Provides a gain proportional to the rate of change of the feedback. A setting of zero
disables the differentiator.

7-36 Process PID Differentiation Gain Limit

If there are quick changes in reference or feedback in a given application - which means
that the error changes swiftly - the differentiator may soon become too dominant. This is
because it reacts to changes in the error. The quicker the error changes, the stronger the
differentiator gain is. The differentiator gain can thus be limited to allow setting of the
reasonable differentiation time for slow changes.

7-38 Process PID Feed Forward Factor

In applications where there is a good (and approximately linear) correlation between the
process reference and the motor speed necessary for obtaining that reference, the feed
forward factor can be used to achieve better dynamic performance of the process PID
control.

change. This function can be disabled by selecting [0] Off.

a Process PID Start Value (speed) in 7-32 Process PID Controller Start Value.

28

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Parameter

Description of function

5-54 Pulse Filter Time Constant #29 (Pulse


term. 29),
5-59 Pulse Filter Time Constant #33 (Pulse
term. 33),
6-16 Terminal 53 Filter Time Constant (Analog
term 53),
6-26 Terminal 54 Filter Time Constant (Analog
term. 54)
6-36 Term. X30/11 Filter Time Constant
6-46 Term. X30/12 Filter Time Constant
35-46 Term. X48/2 Filter Time Constant

If there are oscillations of the current/voltage feedback signal, these can be dampened by
means of a low-pass filter. This time constant represents the speed limit of the ripples
occurring on the feedback signal.
Example: If the low-pass filter has been set to 0.1s, the limit speed is 10 RAD/s (the
reciprocal of 0.1 s), corresponding to (10/(2 x )) = 1.6 Hz. This means that all currents/
voltages that vary by more than 1.6 oscillations per second are damped by the filter. The
control is only carried out on a feedback signal that varies by a frequency (speed) of less
than 1.6 Hz.
The low-pass filter improves steady state performance, but selecting a filter time that is
too long causes the dynamic performance of the Process PID Control to deteriorate.

Table 3.5 Relevant Parameters for Process Control

3.6.6.4 Advanced PID Control


Consult the VLT AutomationDrive FC 301/FC 302 Programming Guide for advanced PID control parameters

3.6.7 Internal Current Control in VVCplus Mode


When the motor current/torque exceed the torque limits set in 4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode, 4-17 Torque Limit Generator
Mode and 4-18 Current Limit, the integral current limit control is activated.
When the adjustable frequency drive is at the current limit during motor operation or regenerative operation, it tries to get
below the preset torque limits as quickly as possible without losing control of the motor.

3.6.8 Local (Hand On) and Remote (Auto On) Control


The adjustable frequency drive can be operated manually via the local control panel (LCP), or remotely via analog and
digital inputs and serial bus. If allowed in 0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCP, 0-41 [Off] Key on LCP, 0-42 [Auto on] Key on LCP, and
0-43 [Reset] Key on LCP, it is possible to start and stop the adjustable frequency drive via the LCP pressing [Hand On] and
[Off]. Alarms can be reset via [Reset]. After pressing [Hand On], the adjustable frequency drive goes into Hand mode and
follows (as default) the local reference that can be set using the navigation keys on the LCP.

Hand
on

Off

Auto
on

Reset

130BP046.10

After pressing [Auto On], the adjustable frequency drive enters Auto mode and follows (as default) the remote reference. In
this mode, it is possible to control the adjustable frequency drive via the digital inputs and various serial interfaces (RS-485,
USB, or an optional serial communication bus). See more about starting, stopping, changing ramps and parameter set-ups,
etc. in parameter group 5-1* Digital Inputs or parameter group 8-5* Serial communication.

Figure 3.10 Operation Keys

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

29

3 3

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Active Reference and Configuration Mode


The active reference can be either the local reference or
the remote reference.
In 3-13 Reference Site, the local reference can be
permanently selected by selecting [2] Local.
To permanently select the remote reference, select [1]
Remote. By selecting [0] Linked to Hand/Auto (default), the
reference site depends on which mode is active. (Hand
mode or Auto mode).

Figure 3.12 Configuration Mode

Figure 3.11 Active Reference

[Hand On] [Auto on]


Keys

3-13 Reference
Site

Active Reference

Hand

Linked to Hand/
Auto

Local

Hand Off

Linked to Hand/
Auto

Local

Auto

Linked to Hand/
Auto

Remote

Auto Off

Linked to Hand/
Auto

Remote

All keys

Local

Local

All keys

Remote

Remote

Table 3.6 Conditions for Local/Remote Reference Activation

1-00 Configuration Mode determines what kind of


application control principle (i.e., speed, torque or process
control) is used when the remote reference is active.
1-05 Local Mode Configuration determines the kind of
application control principle that is used when the local
reference is active. One of them is always active, but both
cannot be active at the same time.

30

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3.7 Reference Handling


3.7.1 References

3 3

Analog Reference
An analog signal applied to input 53 or 54. The signal can
be either voltage 010 V (FC 301 and FC 302) or -10 to
+10 V (FC 302). Current signal 020 mA or 420 mA.
Binary Reference
A signal applied to the serial communication port (RS-485
terminals 6869).
Preset Reference
A defined preset reference to be set from -100% to +100%
of the reference range. Selection of eight preset references
via the digital terminals.
Pulse Reference
A pulse reference applied to terminal 29 or 33, selected in
5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input or 5-15 Terminal 33 Digital
Input [32] Pulse time based. Scaling in parameter group 5-5*
Pulse input.
RefMAX
Determines the relationship between the reference input
at 100% full scale value (typically 10 V, 20 mA) and the
resulting reference. The maximum reference value set in
3-03 Maximum Reference.
RefMIN
Determines the relationship between the reference input
at 0% value (typically 0 V, 0 mA, 4 mA) and the resulting
reference. The minimum reference value set in
3-02 Minimum Reference.
Local Reference
The local reference is active when the adjustable frequency
drive is operated with [Hand On] active. Adjust the
reference by []/[] and []/[] navigation keys.
Remote Reference
The reference handling system for calculating the remote
reference is shown in Figure 3.13.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

31

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3 3

Figure 3.13 Remote Reference

32

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

The remote reference is calculated once every scan


interval and initially consists of two types of reference
inputs:
1.
X (the actual reference): A sum (see
3-04 Reference Function) of up to four externally
selected references, comprising any combination
(determined by the setting of 3-15 Reference
Resource 1, 3-16 Reference Resource 2 and
3-17 Reference Resource 3) of a fixed preset
reference (3-10 Preset Reference), variable analog
references, variable digital pulse references, and
various serial bus references in whatever unit the
adjustable frequency drive is controlled ([Hz],
[RPM], [Nm], etc.).
2.

3.7.2 Reference Limits


3-00 Reference Range, 3-02 Minimum Reference and
3-03 Maximum Reference define the allowed range of the
sum of all references. The sum of all references is clamped
when necessary. The relation between the resulting
reference (after clamping) and the sum of all references is
shown in Figure 3.14.

Y (the relative reference): A sum of one fixed


preset reference (3-14 Preset Relative Reference)
and one variable analog reference (3-18 Relative
Scaling Reference Resource) in [%].

The two types of reference inputs are combined in the


following formula: Remote reference = X + X * Y/100%. If
relative reference is not used, set 3-18 Relative Scaling
Reference Resource to [0] No function and 3-14 Preset
Relative Reference to 0%. The catch up/slow-down function
and the freeze reference function can both be activated by
digital inputs on the adjustable frequency drive. The
functions and parameters are described in the
Programming Guide.
The scaling of analog references are described in
parameter groups 6-1* Analog Input 1 and 6-2* Analog
Input 2, and the scaling of digital pulse references are
described in parameter group 5-5* Pulse Input.
Reference limits and ranges are set in parameter group
3-0* Reference Limits.

Figure 3.14 Relation between Resulting Reference and the


Sum of all References

Figure 3.15 Resulting Reference

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

33

3 3

Design Guide

The value of 3-02 Minimum Reference cannot be set to less


than 0 unless 1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [3] Process.
In that case, the following relations between the resulting
reference (after clamping) and the sum of all references is
shown in Figure 3.16.

3.7.4 Scaling of Analog and Pulse


References and Feedback
References and feedback are scaled from analog and pulse
inputs in the same way. The only difference is that a
reference above or below the specified minimum and
maximum endpoints (P1 and P2 in Figure 3.17) are
clamped, whereas a feedback above or below is not.

High reference/feedback
value

Figure 3.16 Sum of all References with 1-00 Configuration


Mode set to [3] Process

-10

-6

8
10
Terminal X
high
-600

3.7.3 Scaling of Preset References and Bus


References

When 3-00 Reference Range: [1] -Max - +Max 0%


reference equals 0 [unit] -100% reference equals Max Reference 100% reference equals Max
Reference.

Bus references are scaled according to the following


rules:
When 3-00 Reference Range: [0] Min - Max. To
obtain max resolution on the bus reference, the
scaling on the bus is: 0% reference equals Min
Reference and 100% reference equals Max
reference.

34

When 3-00 Reference Range: [1] -Max - +Max


-100% reference equals -Max Reference 100%
reference equals Max Reference.

Resource
input

P1

Preset references are scaled according to the following


rules:
When 3-00 Reference Range: [0] Min - Max 0%
reference equals 0 [unit] where unit can be any
unit, e.g., RPM, m/s, bar, etc. 100% reference
equals the Max (abs (3-03 Maximum Reference),
abs (3-02 Minimum Reference)).

P2

1500

Terminal X low

130BA181.10

Resource output
(RPM)

(V)

Low reference/feedback value

-1500

Figure 3.17 Scaling of Analog and Pulse References and


Feedback

130BA182.10

3 3

Basic Operating Principles

Resource output
(RPM)

High reference/feedback
value

P2

1500

Terminal X low

Resource
input

0
-10

-6

P1

8
10
Terminal X
high
-600

(V)

Low reference/feedback value

-1500

Figure 3.18 Scaling of Reference Output

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

3.7.5 Dead Band Around Zero

Quadrant 2

In some cases, the reference (in rare cases also the


feedback) should have a dead band around zero (i.e., to
make sure the machine is stopped when the reference is
near zero).

High reference/feedback
value
-10

Resource output

Quadrant 1

(RPM)
High reference/feedback
value

Low reference/feedback
value
-6

P2

1500

0
-1

P1
1
Terminal X
low

130BA179.10

The size of the dead band is defined by either P1 or P2 as


shown in Figure 3.19.

-10

-6
Terminal X
low

3 3

Low reference/feedback
value

P1

And both points defining the scaling graph are in


the same quadrant.

Quadrant 2

Quadrant 1

1500

To activate the dead band and to set the amount of


dead band, set the following:
Either Minimum Reference Value or Maximum
Reference Value must be zero. In other words,
Either P1 or P2 must be on the X-axis in
Figure 3.19.

Resource output
(RPM)

130BA180.10

Basic Operating Principles

Resource
input

P2 0

-1
Terminal X
high

10

(V)

-1500
Quadrant 3

Quadrant 4

Figure 3.20 Reverse Dead Band

Thus a reference endpoint of P1 = (0 V, 0 RPM) does not


result in any dead band, but a reference endpoint of, e.g.,
P1 = (1 V, 0 RPM) results in a -1 V to +1 V dead band in
this case, provided that the end point P2 is placed in
either Quadrant 1 or Quadrant 4.

Resource
input
6
10 (V)
Terminal X
high

-1500
Quadrant 3

Quadrant 4

Figure 3.19 Dead Band

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

35

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Figure 3.21 shows how reference input with limits inside Min Max limits clamps.

3 3

Figure 3.21 Positive Reference with Dead Band, Digital input to Trigger Reverse

36

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

Figure 3.22 shows how reference input with limits outside -Max to +Max limits clamps to the inputs low and high limits
before being added to actual reference. Figure 3.22 also shows how the actual reference is clamped to -Max to +Max by the
reference algorithm.

3 3

Figure 3.22 Positive Reference with Dead Band, Digital Input to Trigger Reverse. Clamping Rules

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

37

Basic Operating Principles

Design Guide

3 3

Figure 3.23 Negative to Positive Reference with Dead Band, Sign Determines the Direction, -Max to +Max

38

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Features

Design Guide

4 Product Features
4.1 Automated Operational Features

4.1.2 Overvoltage Protection

These features are active as soon as the adjustable


frequency drive is operating. They require no programming
or set-up. Understanding that these features are present
can optimize a system design and possibly avoid
introducing redundant components or functionality.

Motor-generated overvoltage
The voltage in the intermediate circuit is increased when
the motor acts as a generator. This occurs in the following
cases:

The adjustable frequency drive has a range of built-in


protection functions to protect itself and the motor it is
running.

The load drives the motor (at constant output


frequency from the adjustable frequency drive),
i.e., the load generates energy.

During deceleration ("ramp-down") if the moment


of inertia is high, the friction is low and the rampdown time is too short for the energy to be
dissipated as a loss in the adjustable frequency
drive, the motor and the installation.

Incorrect slip compensation setting may cause


higher DC link voltage.

Back-EMF from PM motor operation. If coasted at


high RPM, the PM motor back-EMF may
potentially exceed the maximum voltage
tolerance of the adjustable frequency drive and
cause damage. To help prevent this, the value of
4-19 Max Output Frequency is automatically
limited based on an internal calculation based on
the value of 1-40 Back EMF at 1000 RPM,
1-25 Motor Nominal Speed and 1-39 Motor Poles.

4.1.1 Short Circuit Protection


Motor (phase-phase)
The adjustable frequency drive is protected against short
circuits on the motor-side by current measurement in each
of the three motor phases or in the DC link. A short circuit
between two output phases causes an overcurrent in the
inverter. The inverter is turned off when the short circuit
current exceeds the permitted value (Alarm 16 Trip Lock).
Line power side
An adjustable frequency drive that works correctly limits
the current it can draw from the supply. Still, it is
recommended to use fuses and/or circuit breakers on the
supply side as protection in case of component breakdown inside the adjustable frequency drive (first fault). See
chapter 9.3 AC line input connections for more information.

NOTICE!

NOTICE!

This is mandatory to ensure compliance with IEC 60364


for CE or NEC 2009 for UL.

To avoid that the motor overspeeds (e.g., due to


excessive windmilling effects), equip the adjustable
frequency drive with a brake resistor.

Brake resistor
The adjustable frequency drive is protected from a short
circuit in the brake resistor.

The overvoltage can handled either via using a brake


function (2-10 Brake Function) and/or using overvoltage
control (2-17 Over-voltage Control).

Load sharing
To protect the DC bus against short circuits and the
adjustable frequency drives from overload, install DC fuses
in series with the load sharing terminals of all connected
units. See chapter 9.6.3 Load Sharing for more information.

Brake functions
Connect a brake resistor for dissipation of surplus brake
energy. Connecting a brake resistor allows a higher DC link
voltage during braking.

MG33BF22

AC brake is an alternative to improve breaking without


using a brake resistor. This function controls an overmagnetization of the motor when running generatoric. This
function can improve the OVC. Increasing the electrical
losses in the motor allows the OVC function to increase
the breaking torque without exceeding the overvoltage
limit.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

39

4 4

4 4

Product Features

Design Guide

NOTICE!

4.1.6 Overload Protection

AC brake is not as effective as dynamic breaking with a


resistor.
OverVoltage Control (OVC)
OVC reduces the risk of the adjustable frequency drive
tripping due to an overvoltage on the DC link. This is
managed by automatically extending the ramp-down time.

NOTICE!
OVC can be activated for PM motor with all control core,
PM VVCplus, Flux OL and Flux CL for PM Motors.

NOTICE!
Do not enable OVC in hoisting applications.

4.1.3 Missing Motor Phase Detection


The Missing Motor Phase Function (4-58 Missing Motor
Phase Function) is enabled by default to avoid motor
damage in the case that a motor phase is missing. The
default setting is 1,000 ms, but it can be adjusted for a
faster detection.

4.1.4 Line Phase Imbalance Detection


Operation under severe line imbalance conditions reduces
the lifetime of the motor. Conditions are considered severe
if the motor is operated continuously near nominal load.
The default setting trips the adjustable frequency drive in
case of line imbalance (14-12 Function at Mains Imbalance).

4.1.5 Switching on the Output

Current Limit
The current limit is controlled in 4-18 Current Limit and the
time before the adjustable frequency drive trips is
controlled in 14-24 Trip Delay at Current Limit.
Speed Limit
Min. speed limit: 4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM] or
4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz] limit the operating speed
range to for instance between 30 and 50/60 Hz.
Max. speed limit: (4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM] or
4-19 Max Output Frequency limit the max output speed the
adjustable frequency drive can provide.
ETR
ETR is an electronic feature that simulates a bimetal relay
based on internal measurements. The characteristic is
shown in Figure 4.1.
Voltage Limit
The inverter turns off to protect the transistors and the
intermediate circuit capacitors when a certain hard-coded
voltage level is reached.
Overtemperature
The adjustable frequency drive has built-in temperature
sensors and reacts immediately to critical values via hardcoded limits.

4.1.7 Locked Rotor Protection

Adding a switch to the output between the motor and the


adjustable frequency drive is permitted. Fault messages
may appear. Enable flying start to catch a spinning motor.

40

Torque Limit
The torque limit feature protects the motor against
overload, independent of the speed. Torque limit is
controlled in 4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and or
4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode and the time before the
torque limit warning trips is controlled in 14-25 Trip Delay
at Torque Limit.

There may be situations when the rotor is locked due to


excessive load or some other factors (bearing, or
application create locked rotor situation). This leads to
overheating of motor winding (free movement of rotor is
required for proper cooling). The adjustable frequency
drive is able to detect the locked rotor situation with
open-loop PM flux control, and PM VVCplus control
(30-22 Locked Rotor Protection).

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Features

Design Guide

4.1.8 Automatic Derating


The adjustable frequency drive constantly checks for
critical levels:

Critical high temperature on the control card or


heatsink

High motor load

Automatic switching frequency modulation regulates these


conditions automatically to provide the highest carrier
frequency without overheating the adjustable frequency
drive. By providing a regulated high carrier frequency, it
quiets motor operating noise at slow speeds when audible
noise control is critical, and produces full output power to
the motor when the demand requires.

4.1.11 Automatic Derating for High Carrier


Frequency

High DC link voltage


Low motor speed

As a response to a critical level, the adjustable frequency


drive adjusts the switching frequency. For critical high
internal temperatures and low motor speed, the adjustable
frequency drives can also force the PWM pattern to
SFAVM.

The adjustable frequency drive is designed for continuous,


full load operation at carrier frequencies between 3.0 and
4.5 kHz. A carrier frequency higher than 4.5 kHz generates
increased heat in the adjustable frequency drive and
requires the output current to be derated.

The automatic derating is different when 14-55 Output


Filter is set to [2] Sine-Wave Filter Fixed.

An automatic feature of the adjustable frequency drive is


load-dependent carrier frequency control. This feature
allows the motor to benefit from as high a carrier
frequency as the load permits.

4.1.9 Automatic Energy Optimization

4.1.12 Power Fluctuation Performance

Automatic energy optimization (AEO) directs the adjustable


frequency drive to continuously monitor the load on the
motor and adjust the output voltage to maximize
efficiency. Under light load, the voltage is reduced and the
motor current is minimized. The motor benefits from
increased efficiency, reduced heating, and quieter
operation. There is no need to select a V/Hz curve because
the adjustable frequency drive automatically adjusts motor
voltage.

The adjustable frequency drive withstands line power


fluctuations such as transients, momentary dropouts, short
voltage drops and surges. The adjustable frequency drive
automatically compensates for input voltages 10% from
the nominal to provide full rated motor voltage and
torque. With auto restart selected, the adjustable frequency
drive automatically powers up after a voltage trip. And
with flying start, the adjustable frequency drive
synchronizes to motor rotation prior to start.

4.1.10 Automatic Switching Frequency


Modulation

4.1.13 Resonance Damping

NOTICE!

The adjustable frequency drive generates short electrical


pulses to form an AC wave pattern. The carrier frequency
is the rate of these pulses. A low carrier frequency (slow
pulsing rate) causes noise in the motor, making a higher
carrier frequency preferable. A high carrier frequency,
however, generates heat in the adjustable frequency drive
which can limit the amount of current available to the
motor. The use of insulated gate bi-polar transistors (IGBT)
means very high-speed switching.

MG33BF22

High frequency motor resonance noise can be eliminated


through the use of resonance damping. Automatic or
manually selected frequency damping is available.

4.1.14 Temperature-controlled Fans


The internal cooling fans are temperature controlled by
sensors in the adjustable frequency drive. The cooling fan
often is not running during low load operation or when in
sleep mode or standby. This reduces noise, increases
efficiency, and extends the operating life of the fan.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

41

4 4

Design Guide

4.1.15 EMC Compliance

4.2.2 Motor Thermal Protection

Electromagnetic interference (EMI) or radio frequency


interference (RFI, in case of radio frequency) is disturbance
which can affect an electrical circuit due to electromagnetic induction or radiation from an external source.
The adjustable frequency drive is designed to comply with
the EMC product standard for drives IEC 61800-3 as well as
the European standard EN 55011. To comply with the
emission levels in EN 55011, the motor cable must be
shielded and properly terminated. For more information
regarding EMC performance, see chapter 5.2.1 EMC Test
Results.

Motor thermal protection can be provided in three ways:

4.1.16 Galvanic Isolation of Control


Terminals
All control terminals and output relay terminals are galvanically isolated from line power. This means the controller
circuitry is completely protected from the input current.
The output relay terminals require their own grounding.
This isolations meets the stringent protective extra-low
voltage (PELV) requirements for isolation.
The components that make up the galvanic isolation are

Power supply, including signal isolation


Gate drive for the IGBTs, the trigger transformers
and optocouplers

2000

These are the most common features programmed for use


in the adjustable frequency drive for enhanced system
performance. They require minimum programming or setup. Understanding that these features are available can
optimize a system design and possibly avoid introducing
redundant components or functionality. See the product
specific Programming Guide for instructions on activating
these functions.

1000

42

PTC or KTY sensor in the motor


windings and connected on a standard
AI or DI

PT100 or PT1000 in the motor windings


and motor bearings, connected on
sensor input card MCB 114

PTC thermistor input on PTC thermistor


card MCB 112 (ATEX approved)

Mechanical thermal switch (Klixon type) on a DI


Via the built-in Electronic Thermal Relay (ETR).

t [s]

4.2 Custom Application Features

Automatic motor adaptation (AMA) is an automated test


procedure used to measure the electrical characteristics of
the motor. AMA provides an accurate electronic model of
the motor. It allows the adjustable frequency drive to
calculate optimal performance and efficiency with the
motor. Running the AMA procedure also maximizes the
automatic energy optimization feature of the adjustable
frequency drive. AMA is performed without the motor
rotating and without uncoupling the load from the motor.

ETR calculates motor temperature by measuring current,


frequency, and operating time. The adjustable frequency
drive displays the thermal load on the motor in percentage
and can issue a warning at a programmable overload
setpoint.
Programmable options at the overload allow the
adjustable frequency drive to stop the motor, reduce
output, or ignore the condition. Even at low speeds, the
adjustable frequency drive meets I2t Class 20 electronic
motor overload standards.

The output current Hall Effect transducers

4.2.1 Automatic Motor Adaptation

Via direct temperature sensing via one of the


following

175ZA052.11

4 4

Product Features

600
500
400
300
200

fOUT = 1 x f M,N

100

fOUT = 2 x f M,N

60
50
40
30

fOUT = 0.2 x f M,N

20
10

1.0

1.2

1.4

1.6

1.8

2.0

IM
IMN

Figure 4.1 ETR Characteristics

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Features

Design Guide

The X-axis shows the ratio between Imotor and Imotor


nominal. The Y-axis shows the time in seconds before the
ETR cuts off and trips the adjustable frequency drive. The
curves show the characteristic nominal speed, at twice the
nominal speed and at 0.2 x the nominal speed.
At lower speed, the ETR cuts off at lower heat due to less
cooling of the motor. In that way, the motor is protected
from being overheated even at low speed. The ETR feature
calculates the motor temperature based on the actual
current and speed. The calculated temperature is visible as
a readout parameter in 16-18 Motor Thermal.
A special version of the ETR is also available for EX-e
motors in ATEX areas. This function makes it possible to
enter a specific curve to protect the Ex-e motor. The
Programming Guide takes the user through the set-up.

4.2.3 Line Drop-out


During a line drop-out, the adjustable frequency drive
keeps running until the intermediate circuit voltage drops
below the minimum stop level, which is typically 15%
below the adjustable frequency drive's lowest rated supply
voltage. The AC line voltage before the drop-out and the
motor load determines how long it takes for the adjustable
frequency drive to coast.
The adjustable frequency drive can be configured
(14-10 Line Failure) to different types of behavior during
line drop-out, e.g:

Trip Lock once the DC link is exhausted


Coast with flying start whenever line power
return (1-73 Flying Start)
Kinetic backup
Controlled ramp-down

Flying start
This selection makes it possible to catch a motor that is
spinning freely due to a line drop-out. This option is very
relevant for centrifuges and fans.
Kinetic backup
This selection ensures that the adjustable frequency drive
runs as long as there is energy in the system. For short line
drop-out the operation is restored upon line power return,
without bringing the application to a stop or loosing
control at any time. Several variants of kinetic backup can
be selected.

4.2.4 Built-in PID Controller


The built-in proportional, integral, derivative (PID)
controller is available, eliminating the need for auxiliary
control devices. The PID controller maintains constant
control of closed-loop systems where regulated pressure,
flow, temperature, or other system requirements must be
maintained. The adjustable frequency drive can provide
self-reliant control the motor speed in response to
feedback signals from remote sensors.
The adjustable frequency drive accommodates two
feedback signals from two different devices. This feature
allows regulating a system with different feedback
requirements. The adjustable frequency drive makes
control decisions by comparing the two signals to optimize
system performance.

4.2.5 Automatic Restart


The adjustable frequency drive can be programmed to
automatically restart the motor after a minor trip, such as
momentary power loss or fluctuation. This feature
eliminates the need for manual resetting and enhances
automated operation for remotely controlled systems. The
number of restart attempts as well as the duration
between attempts can be limited.

4.2.6 Flying Start


Flying start allows the adjustable frequency drive to
synchronize with an operating motor rotating at up to full
speed, in either direction. This prevents trips due to
overcurrent draw. It minimizes mechanical stress to the
system since the motor receives no abrupt change in
speed when the adjustable frequency drive starts.

4.2.7 Full Torque at Reduced Speed


The adjustable frequency drive follows a variable V/Hz
curve to provide full motor torque even at reduced speeds.
Full output torque can coincide with the maximum
designed operating speed of the motor. This is unlike
variable torque drives that provide reduced motor torque
at low speed, or constant torque converters that provide
excess voltage, heat and motor noise at less than full
speed.

The behavior of the adjustable frequency drive at line


drop-out can be configured in 14-10 Line Failure and
1-73 Flying Start.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

43

4 4

4 4

Product Features

Design Guide

4.2.8 Frequency Bypass


In some applications, the system may have operational
speeds that create a mechanical resonance. This can
generate excessive noise and possibly damage mechanical
components in the system. The adjustable frequency drive
has four programmable bypass-frequency bandwidths.
These allow the motor to step over speeds which induce
system resonance.

4.2.9 Motor Preheat


To preheat a motor in a cold or damp environment, a
small amount of DC current can be trickled continuously
into the motor to protect it from condensation and a cold
start. This can eliminate the need for a space heater.

4.2.10 Four Programmable Set-ups


The adjustable frequency drive has four set-ups which can
be independently programmed. Using multi-setup, it is
possible to switch between independently programmed
functions activated by digital inputs or a serial command.
Independent set-ups are used, for example, to change
references, or for day/night or summer/winter operation, or
to control multiple motors. The active set-up is displayed
on the LCP.
Set-up data can be copied from adjustable frequency drive
to adjustable frequency drive by downloading the
information from the removable LCP.

4.2.11 Dynamic Braking


Dynamic Brake is established by:
Resistor brake
A brake IGBT keeps the overvoltage under a
certain threshold by directing the brake energy
from the motor to the connected brake resistor
(2-10 Brake Function = [1]).

44

AC brake
The brake energy is distributed in the motor by
changing the loss conditions in the motor. The
AC brake function cannot be used in applications
with high cycling frequency since this overheats
the motor (2-10 Brake Function = [2]).

DC brake
An overmodulated DC current added to the AC
current works as an eddy current brake (2-02 DC
Braking Time 0 s).

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Features

Design Guide

4.2.12 Open-loop Mechanical Brake Control


Parameters for controlling operation of an electro-magnetic (mechanical) brake, typically required in hoisting applications.
To control a mechanical brake, a relay output (relay 01 or relay 02) or a programmed digital output (terminal 27 or 29) is
required. Normally, this output must be closed during periods when the adjustable frequency drive is unable to hold the
motor, e.g., due to an excessive load. Select [32] Mechanical Brake Control for applications with an electro-magnetic brake in
5-40 Function Relay, 5-30 Terminal 27 Digital Output, or 5-31 Terminal 29 digital Output. When selecting [32] Mechanical brake
control, the mechanical brake is closed from start up until the output current is above the level selected in 2-20 Release
Brake Current. During stop, the mechanical brake activates when the speed drops below the level specified in 2-21 Activate
Brake Speed [RPM]. If the adjustable frequency drive enters an alarm condition or an overcurrent or overvoltage situation,
the mechanical brake immediately cuts in. This is also the case during Safe Torque Off.

NOTICE!

Start
term.18

130BA074.12

Protection mode and trip delay features (14-25 Trip Delay at Torque Limit and 14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault) may
delay the activation of the mechanical brake in an alarm condition. These features must be disabled in hoisting
applications.

1=on
0=off

Par 1-71
Start delay time

Par 2-21
Activate brake
speed

Shaft speed
Par 1-74
Start speed

Output current
Pre-magnetizing
current or
DC hold current

Par 2-20
Release brake current

Par 1-76 Start current/


Par 2-00 DC hold current

Par 2-23
Brake delay time

Reaction time EMK brake


Relay 01

on
off

Mechanical brake
locked
Mechanical brake
free
Time

Figure 4.2 Mechanical Brake

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

45

4 4

Product Features

Design Guide

4.2.13 Closed-loop Mechanical Brake Control/Hoist Mechanical Brake


The hoist mechanical break control supports the following functions:
Two channels for mechanical brake feedback to offer further protection against unintended behavior resulting
from broken cable.

Monitoring of mechanical brake feedback throughout the complete cycle. This helps protect the mechanical brake
- especially if more adjustable frequency drives are connected to the same shaft.

No ramp up until feedback confirms mechanical brake is open.

Improved load control at stop. If 2-23 Activate Brake Delay is set too short, W22 is activated and the torque is not
allowed to ramp down.
The transition when motor takes over the load from the brake can be configured. 2-28 Gain Boost Factor can be
increased to minimize the movement. For very smooth transition, change the setting from the speed control to
the position control during the change-over.

Set 2-28 Gain Boost Factor to 0 to enable Position Control during 2-25 Brake Release Time. This enables
parameters 2-30 Position P Start Proportional Gain to 2-33 Speed PID Start Lowpass Filter Time which are PID
parameters for the Position Control.
130BA642.12

4 4

II
I

MotorSpeed

Premag

Torque Ramp
Time
p. 2-27

Torque Ref. 2-26

Brake
Release
Time
p. 2-25

Ramp 1 upp. 3-41

Ramp 1 downp. 3-42

Stop
Delay
p. 2-24

Activate
Brake
Delay
p. 2-23

Torqueref.

Relay
Gain Boost Factor
p. 2-28
GainBoost

Mech.Brake
1

Figure 4.3 Brake release sequence for hoist mechanical brake control. This brake control is available in FLUX with motor feedback
only, available for asynchronous and non-salient PM motors.

2-26 Torque Ref to 2-33 Speed PID Start Lowpass Filter Time are only available for the hoist mechanical brake control (FLUX
with motor feedback). 2-30 Position P Start Proportional Gain to 2-33 Speed PID Start Lowpass Filter Time can be set up for
very smooth transition change from speed control to position control during 2-25 Brake Release Time - the time when the
load is transferred from the mechanical brake to the adjustable frequency drive.
2-30 Position P Start Proportional Gain to 2-33 Speed PID Start Lowpass Filter Time are activated when 2-28 Gain Boost Factor is
set to 0. See Figure 4.3 for more information.

NOTICE!
For an example of advanced mechanical brake control for hoisting applications, see chapter 10 Application Examples.

46

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

4.2.14 Smart Logic Control (SLC)

Par. 13-51
SL Controller Event

Running
Warning
Torque limit
Digital input X 30/2
...

Par. 13-52
SL Controller Action

Coast
Start timer
Set Do X low
Select set-up 2
...

4 4

130BB671.13

Smart Logic Control (SLC) is a sequence of user-defined


actions (see 13-52 SL Controller Action [x]) executed by the
SLC when the associated user-defined event (see 13-51 SL
Controller Event [x]) is evaluated as TRUE by the SLC.
The condition for an event can be a particular status or
that the output from a logic rule or a comparator operand
becomes TRUE. That leads to an associated Action as
shown in Figure 4.4.

When the last event/action has been executed, the


sequence starts over again from event [0]/action [0].
Figure 4.5 shows an example with four event/actions:

Figure 4.5 Order of Execution when Four Events/Actions are


Programmed

Par. 13-43
Logic Rule Operator 2

Comparators
Comparators are used for comparing continuous variables
(i.e. output frequency, output current, analog input, etc.) to
fixed preset values.

...
...
Par. 13-11
Comparator Operator

Par. 13-11
Comparator Operator

130BB672.10

Product Features

Par. 13-10
Comparator Operand

=
TRUE longer than..

...
...

TRUE longer than.

Par. 13-12
Comparator Value

...
...

Figure 4.4 SCL Event and Action


Figure 4.6 Comparators

Logic Rules
Combine up to three boolean inputs (TRUE/FALSE inputs)
from timers, comparators, digital inputs, status bits and
events using the logical operators AND, OR, and NOT.
Par. 13-40
Logic Rule Boolean 1
Par. 13-42
Logic Rule Boolean 2

Par. 13-41
Logic Rule Operator 1

...
...

Par. 13-43
Logic Rule Operator 2

130BB673.10

Events and actions are each numbered and linked in pairs


(states). This means that when event [0] is fulfilled (attains
the value TRUE), action [0] is executed. After this, the
conditions of event [1] is evaluated and if evaluated TRUE,
action [1] is executed and so on. Only one event is
evaluated at any time. If an event is evaluated as FALSE,
nothing happens (in the SLC) during the current scan
interval and no other events are evaluated. This means that
when the SLC starts, it evaluates event [0] (and only event
[0]) each scan interval. Only when event [0] is evaluated
TRUE, the SLC executes action [0] and starts evaluating
event [1]. It is possible to program from 1 to 20 events and
actions.

...
...
Par. 13-44
Logic Rule Boolean 3

Figure 4.7 Logic Rules

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

47

4.2.15 Safe Torque Off


For information about Safe Torque Off, refer to the VLT FC
Series Safe Torque Off Instruction Manual.

4.3 Danfoss VLT FlexConcept


Danfoss VLT FlexConcept is an energy efficient, flexible
and cost-efficient adjustable frequency drive solution,
mainly for conveyors. The concept consists of the VLT
OneGearDrive driven by the VLT AutomationDrive FC
302 or VLT Decentral Drive FCD 302.
OneGearDrive is basically a permanent magnet motor with
a bevel gear. The bevel gear can be delivered with
different gear ratios.
130BB890.14

4 4

Design Guide

Product Features

P1

P2

P3

Figure 4.8 OneGearDrive

The OneGearDrive can be driven by VLT AutomationDrive


FC 302 and VLT Decentral Drive FCD 302 in the following
power sizes dependent on demands of the actual
application:

0.75 kW
1.1 kW
1.5 kW
2.2 kW
3.0 kW

When [1] PM, non-salient SPM has been selected in in


either FC 302 or FCD 302, the OneGearDrive can be
selected in 1-11 Motor Model, and the recommended
parameters are set automatically.
For further information, refer to the VLT AutomationDrive
FC 301/FC 302 Programming Guide, the VLT OneGearDrive
Selection Guide, and www.danfoss.com/BusinessAreas/DrivesSolutions/VLTFlexConcept/

48

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

System Integration

Design Guide

5 System Integration
5.1.3 Temperature and Cooling

5.1 Ambient Operating Conditions


5.1.1 Humidity
Although the adjustable frequency drive can operate
properly at high humidity (up to 95% relative humidity),
condensation must always be avoided. There is a specific
risk of condensation when the adjustable frequency drive
is colder than moist ambient air. Moisture in the air can
also condense on the electronic components and cause
short circuits. Condensation occurs to units without power.
It is advisable to install a cabinet heater when condensation is possible due to ambient conditions. Avoid
installation in areas subject to frost.
Alternatively, operating the adjustable frequency drive in
stand-by mode (with the unit connected to line power)
reduces the risk of condensation. However, ensure the
power dissipation is sufficient to keep the adjustable
frequency drive circuitry free of moisture.

5.1.2 Temperature
Minimum and maximum ambient temperature limits are
specified for all adjustable frequency drives. Avoiding
extreme ambient temperatures prolongs the life of the
equipment and maximizes overall system reliability. Follow
the recommendations listed for maximum performance
and equipment longevity.

Although drives can operate at temperatures


down to 14F [-10C], proper operation at rated
load is only guaranteed at 32F [0C] or higher.

The adjustable frequency drives have built-in fans to


ensure optimum cooling. The main fan forces the air flow
along the cooling fins on the heatsink, ensuring a cooling
of the internal air. Some power sizes have a small
secondary fan close to the control card, ensuring that the
internal air is circulated to avoid hot spots. The main fan is
controlled by the internal temperature in the adjustable
frequency drive and the speed gradually increases along
with temperature, reducing noise and energy consumption
when the need is low, and ensuring maximum cooling
when the need is there. The fan control can be adapted
via 14-52 Fan Control to accommodate any application, also
to protect against negative effects of cooling in very cold
climates. In case of overtemperature inside the adjustable
frequency drive, it derates the switching frequency and
pattern, see chapter 5.1.4 Manual Derating for more info.
Minimum and maximum ambient temperature limits are
specified for all adjustable frequency drives. Avoiding
extreme ambient temperatures prolongs the life of the
equipment and maximizes overall system reliability. Follow
the recommendations listed for maximum performance
and equipment longevity.

Although adjustable frequency drives can operate


at temperatures down to 14F [-10C], proper
operation at rated load is only guaranteed at 32F
[0C] or higher.

Do not exceed the maximum temperature limit.

Observe the minimum top and bottom clearance


requirements (chapter 8.2.1.1 Clearance).

As a rule of thumb, the lifetime of electronic


components decreases by 50% for every 17F
[10C] when operated above its design
temperature.

Do not exceed the maximum temperature limit.


The lifetime of electronic components decreases
by 50% for every 17F [10C] when operated
above its design temperature.

Even devices with IP54, IP55, or IP66 protection


ratings must adhere to the specified ambient
temperature ranges.

Additional air conditioning of the cabinet or


installation site may be required.

MG33BF22

Do not exceed the maximum 24-hour average


temperature.
(The 24-hour average temperature is the max.
ambient temperature minus 9F [5C].
Example: Max. temperature is 122F [50C],
maximum 24-hour avg. temperature is 113F
[45C]).

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

49

5 5

Design Guide

Even devices with high protection ratings must


adhere to the specified ambient temperature
ranges.

Additional air conditioning of the cabinet or


installation site may be required.

5.1.4 Manual Derating

5.1.4.2 Derating for Low Air Pressure


The cooling capability of air is decreased at a lower air
pressure.
Below 1,000 m altitude, no derating is necessary but
above 1,000 m the ambient temperature (TAMB) or max.
output current (Iout) should be derated in accordance with
Figure 5.1.

Consider derating when any of the following conditions


are present.

Operating above 3,300 ft [1,000 m] (low air


pressure)

Low speed operation


Long motor cables
Cables with a large cross-section
High ambient temperature

For more information, refer to chapter 6.2.6 Derating for


Ambient Temperature.

Figure 5.1 Derating of output current versus altitude at


TAMB, MAX for frame sizes A, B and C. At altitudes above
6,600 ft [2,000 m], contact Danfoss regarding PELV.

5.1.4.1 Derating for Running at Low Speed


When a motor is connected to an adjustable frequency
drive, it is necessary to make sure that the cooling of the
motor is adequate.
The level of heating depends on the load on the motor as
well as the operating speed and time.
Constant torque applications (CT mode)
A problem may occur at low RPM values in constant
torque applications. In a constant torque application, a
motor may overheat at low speeds due to less cooling air
from the motor integral fan.
Therefore, if the motor is to be run continuously at an RPM
value lower than half of the rated value, the motor must
be supplied with additional air-cooling (or a motor
designed for this type of operation may be used).
An alternative is to reduce the load level of the motor by
selecting a larger motor. However, the design of the
adjustable frequency drive limits the motor size.
Variable (quadratic) torque applications (VT)
In VT applications such as centrifugal pumps and fans,
where the torque is proportional to the square of the
speed and the power is proportional to the cube of the
speed, there is no need for additional cooling or derating
of the motor.

50

An alternative is to lower the ambient temperature at high


altitudes and thereby ensure 100% output current at high
altitudes. As an example of how to read the graph, the
situation at 6,600 ft [2,000 m] is elaborated for an
enclosure type B with TAMB, MAX = 122F [50C]. At a
temperature of 113F [45C] (TAMB, MAX - 3.3 K), 91% of the
rated output current is available. At a temperature of 107F
[41.7C], 100% of the rated output current is available.
130BC015.10

5 5

System Integration

TAMB, MAX
at 100% Iout
D, E and F enclosures
NO
HO

Max.Iout (%)
at TAMB, MAX
100%

0K

-5 K

96%

-3 K

-8 K

92%

-6 K

-11 K

1 km

2 km

3 km

Altitude (km)

Figure 5.2 Derating of output current versus altitude at


TAMB, MAX for enclosure types D3h.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

System Integration

5.1.5 Acoustic Noise


Acoustic noise from the adjustable frequency drive comes from three sources

DC link (intermediate circuit) coils


RFI filter choke
Internal fans

See chapter 6.2.9 Acoustic Noise for acoustic noise ratings.

5 5

5.1.6 Vibration and Shock


The adjustable frequency drive tested according to a procedure based on the IEC 68-2-6/34/35 and 36. These tests subject
the unit to 0.7 g forces, over the range of 18 to 1,000 Hz random, in three directions for two hours. All Danfoss adjustable
frequency drives comply with requirements that correspond to these conditions when the unit is wall or floor mounted, as
well as when mounted within panels bolted to walls or floors.

5.1.7 Aggressive Atmospheres


5.1.7.1 Gases
Aggressive gases, such as hydrogen sulfide, chlorine, or ammonia can damage adjustable frequency drive electrical and
mechanical components. Contamination of the cooling air can also cause the gradual decomposition of PCB tracks and door
seals. Aggressive contaminants are often present in sewage treatment plants or swimming pools. A clear sign of an
aggressive atmosphere is corroded copper.
In aggressive atmospheres, restricted IP enclosures are recommended along with conformal-coated circuit boards. See
Table 5.1 for conformal-coating values.

NOTICE!
The adjustable frequency drive comes standard with class 3C2 coating. On request, class 3C3 coating is available.
Class
Gas type

Unit

3C1

3C2
Average value

3C3
Max. value

Average value

Max. value

Sea salt

n/a

None

Salt mist

Salt mist

Sulfur oxides

mg/m3

0.1

0.3

1.0

5.0

Hydrogen sulfide

mg/m3

0.01

0.1

0.5

3.0

10

Chlorine

mg/m3

0.01

0.1

0.03

0.3

1.0

Hydrogen chloride

mg/m3

0.01

0.1

0.5

1.0

5.0

Hydrogen fluoride

mg/m3

0.003

0.01

0.03

0.1

3.0

Ammonia

mg/m3

0.3

1.0

3.0

10

35

Ozone

mg/m3

0.01

0.05

0.1

0.1

0.3

Nitrogen

mg/m3

0.1

0.5

1.0

3.0

9.0

10

Table 5.1 Conformal-coating Class Ratings


Maximum values are transient peak values not to exceed 30 minutes per day.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

51

5 5

System Integration

Design Guide

5.1.7.2 Dust Exposure

e classification consists of preventing any


occurrence of a spark. The FC 302 with firmware
version V6.3x or higher is equipped with an
"ATEX ETR thermal monitoring" function for
operation of specially approved Ex-e motors.
When combined with an ATEX approved PTC
monitoring device like the PTC Thermistor Card
MCB 112 the installation does not need an
individual approval from an approbated organization, i.e., no need for matched pairs.

d classification consists of ensuring that if a spark


occurs, it is contained in a protected area. While
not requiring approval, special wiring and
containment are required.

d/e combination is the most often used in


potentially explosive atmospheres. The motor
itself has a e ignition protection class, while the
motor cabling and connection environment is in
compliance with the e classification. The
restriction on the e connection space consists of
the maximum voltage allowed in this space. The
output voltage of an adjustable frequency drive is
usually limited to the AC line voltage. The
modulation of the output voltage may generate
unallowable high peak voltage for e classification.
In practice, using a sine-wave filter at the
adjustable frequency drive output has proven to
be an effective means to attenuate the high peak
voltage.

Installation of adjustable frequency drives in environments


with high dust exposure is often unavoidable. Dust affects
wall or frame mounted units with IP55 or IP66 protection
rating, and also cabinet mounted devices with IP21 or IP20
protection rating. Take the three aspects described below
into account when adjustable frequency drives are
installed in such environments.
Reduced Cooling
Dust forms deposits on the surface of the device and
inside on circuit boards and the electronic components.
These deposits act as insulation layers and hamper heat
transfer to the ambient air, reducing the cooling capacity.
The components become warmer. This causes accelerated
aging of the electronic components, and the service life of
the unit decreases. Dust deposits on the heatsink in the
back of the unit also decrease the service life of the unit.
Cooling Fans
The airflow for cooling the unit is produced by cooling
fans, usually located on the back of the device. The fan
rotors have small bearings into which dust can penetrate
and act as an abrasive. This leads to bearing damage and
fan failure.
Filters
High-power adjustable frequency drives are equipped with
cooling fans that expel hot air from the interior of the
device. Above a certain size, these fans are fitted with filter
mats. These filters can become quickly clogged when used
in very dusty environments. Preventative measures are
necessary under these conditions.
Periodic Maintenance
Under the conditions described above, it is advisable to
clean the adjustable frequency drive during periodic
maintenance. Remove dust off the heatsink and fans and
clean the filter mats.

5.1.7.3 Potentially Explosive Atmospheres


Systems operated in potentially explosive atmospheres
must fulfill special conditions. EU Directive 94/9/EC
describes the operation of electronic devices in potentially
explosive atmospheres.
Motors controlled by adjustable frequency drives in
potentially explosive atmospheres must be monitored for
temperature using a PTC temperature sensor. Motors with
ignition protection class d or e are approved for this
environment.

52

NOTICE!
Do not install an adjustable frequency drive in a
potentially explosive atmosphere. Install the adjustable
frequency drive in a cabinet outside of this area. Using a
sine-wave filter at the output of the adjustable frequency
drive is also recommended to attenuate the dU/dt
voltage rise and peak voltage. Keep the motor cables as
short as possible.

NOTICE!
VLT AutomationDrive units with the MCB 112 option
have PTB-certified motor thermistor sensor monitoring
capability for potentially explosive atmospheres.
Shielded motor cables are not necessary when
adjustable frequency drives are operated with sine-wave
output filters.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

System Integration

Design Guide

5.1.8 Maintenance
Danfoss adjustable frequency drive models up to 90 kW are maintenance free. High power adjustable frequency drives
(rated at 110 kW or higher) have built-in filter mats which require periodic cleaning by the operator, depending on the
exposure to dust and contaminants. Maintenance intervals for the cooling fans (approximately 3 years) and capacitors
(approximately 5 years) are recommended in most environments.

5.1.9 Storage
Like all electronic equipment, adjustable frequency drives must be stored in a dry location. Periodic forming (capacitor
charging) is not necessary during storage.

5 5

It is recommended to keep the equipment sealed in its packaging until installation.

5.2 General Aspects of EMC


Electrical interference is usually conducted at frequencies in the range 150 kHz to 30 MHz. Airborne interference from the
adjustable frequency drive system in the range 30 MHz to 1 GHz is generated from the inverter, motor cable, and the
motor.
As shown in Figure 5.3, capacitance in the motor cable coupled with a high dU/dt from the motor voltage generate leakage
currents.
The use of a shielded motor cable increases the leakage current (see Figure 5.3) because shielded cables have higher
capacitance to ground than non-shielded cables. If the leakage current is not filtered, it causes greater interference on the
line power in the radio frequency range below approximately 5 MHz. Since the leakage current (I1) is carried back to the
unit through the shield (I3), there is in principle only a small electro-magnetic field (I4) from the shielded motor cable
according to Figure 5.3.
The shield reduces the radiated interference, but increases the low-frequency interference in the line power supply. Connect
the motor cable shield to the adjustable frequency drive enclosure as well as on the motor enclosure. This is best done by
using integrated shield clamps so as to avoid twisted shield ends (pigtails) Pigtails increase the shield impedance at higher
frequencies, which reduces the shield effect and increases the leakage current (I4).
If a shielded cable is used for relay, control cable, signal interface and brake, mount the shield on the enclosure at both
ends. In some situations, however, it is necessary to break the shield to avoid current loops.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

53

Design Guide

CS

L1

L2

L3

z PE

PE

CS

U
I1

I2

CS

I3

1
2

CS

CS
I4

5 5
3

175ZA062.12

System Integration

CS

I4

Ground wire

Adjustable frequency drive

Shield

Shielded motor cable

AC line power supply

Motor

Figure 5.3 Situation that Generates Leakage Currents

If the shield is to be placed on a mounting plate for the adjustable frequency drive, the mounting plate must be made of
metal, to convey the shield currents back to the unit. Moreover, ensure good electrical contact from the mounting plate
through the mounting screws to the adjustable frequency driver chassis.
When non-shielded cables are used, some emission requirements are not complied with, although most immunity
requirements are observed.
To reduce the interference level from the entire system (unit+installation), make motor and brake cables as short as
possible. Avoid placing cables with a sensitive signal level alongside motor and brake cables. Radio interference higher than
50 MHz (airborne) is especially generated by the control electronics.

5.2.1 EMC Test Results


The following test results have been obtained using a system with an adjustable frequency drive, a shielded control cable, a
control box with potentiometer, as well as a single motor and screened motor cable (lflex Classic 100 CY) at nominal
switching frequency. Table 5.2 states the maximum motor cable lengths for compliance.

NOTICE!
Conditions may change significantly for other set-ups.

NOTICE!
Consult Table 9.19 for parallel motor cables.

54

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

System Integration

RFI filter type

Conducted emission

Radiated emission

Cable length [m]


Standards and
requirements

EN 55011/CISPR 11

Class B

Class A
Group 1

Class A
Group 2

Class B

Class A
Group 1

Class A
Group 2

EN/IEC 61800-3

Category C1

Category C2

Category C3

Category C1

Category C2

Category C3

050 hp [037 kW]


200240 V

10

50

50

No

Yes

Yes

0100 hp [075 kW]


380480 V

10

50

50

No

Yes

Yes

050 hp [037 kW]


200240 V

50

150

150

No

Yes

Yes

0100 hp [075 kW]


380480 V

50

150

150

No

Yes

Yes

05 hp [03.7 kW]
200240 V

No

No

No

No

Yes

No

No

25

No

No

Yes

No

No

No

No

Yes

No

No

25

No

No

Yes

No

No

25

No

No

Yes

No

No

25

No

No

Yes

02 hp [01.5 kW]
200240 V

2.5

25

25

No

Yes

Yes

02 hp [01.5 kW]
380480 V

2.5

25

25

No

Yes

Yes

1.510 hp [1.17.5 kW]


525690 V

No

100

100

No

Yes

Yes

1530 hp [1122 kW]


525690 V

No

100

100

No

Yes

Yes

No

150

150

No

Yes

Yes

40100 hp [3075 kW]


525690 V

No

150

150

No

Yes

Yes

1100 hp [0.7575 kW]


525600 V

No

No

No

No

No

No

H1
FC 301

FC 302

5 5

H2/H5
FC 301

FC 302

7.550 hp [5.537 kW]


200240 V2)
010 HP (07.5 kW)
380500 V
15100 hp [1175 kW]
380500 V2)
1530 hp [1122 kW]
525690 V2)
40100 hp [3075 kW]
525690 V2)

H3
FC 301

H4
FC 302

1550 hp [1137 kW]


525690 V3

Hx1)
FC 302

Table 5.2 EMC Test Results (Emission) Maximum Motor Cable Length
1)

Hx versions can be used according to EN/IEC 61800-3 category C4.

2)

T5, 3060 hp [2245 kW] and T7, 30100 hp [2275 kW] comply with class A group 1 with 25 m motor cable. Some restrictions for the installation apply (contact Danfoss for details).
Hx, H1, H2, H3, H4 or H5 is defined in the type code pos. 16-17 for EMC filters, see Table 7.1.

3)

IP20

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

55

5 5

System Integration

Design Guide

5.2.2 Emission Requirements


The EMC product standard for adjustable frequency drives defines four categories (C1, C2, C3 and C4) with specified
requirements for emission and immunity. Table 5.3 states the definition of the four categories and the equivalent classification from EN 55011.
Equivalent emission class in EN
55011

Category

Definition

C1

Adjustable frequency drives installed in the first environment (home and


office) with a supply voltage less than 1000 V.

C2

Adjustable frequency drives installed in the first environment (home and


Class A Group 1
office) with a supply voltage less than 1000 V, which are neither plug-in nor
movable and are intended to be installed and commissioned by a professional.

C3

Adjustable frequency drives installed in the second environment (industrial) Class A Group 2
with a supply voltage lower than 1000 V.

C4

Adjustable frequency drives installed in the second environment with a


No limit line.
supply voltage equal to or above 1000 V or rated current equal to or above An EMC plan should be made.
400 A or intended for use in complex systems.

Class B

Table 5.3 Correlation between IEC 61800-3 and EN 55011

When the generic (conducted) emission standards are used, the adjustable frequency drives are required to comply with the
limits in Table 5.4.
Equivalent emission class in EN
55011

Environment

Generic emission standard

First environment
(home and office)

EN/IEC 61000-6-3 Emission standard for residential,


commercial and light industrial environments.

Class B

Second environment
(industrial environment)

EN/IEC 61000-6-4 Emission standard for industrial


environments.

Class A Group 1

Table 5.4 Correlation between Generic Emission Standards and EN 55011

56

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

System Integration

5.2.3 Immunity Requirements


The immunity requirements for adjustable frequency drives depend on the environment where they are installed. The
requirements for the industrial environment are higher than the requirements for the home and office environment. All
Danfoss adjustable frequency drives comply with the requirements for the industrial environment and consequently comply
also with the lower requirements for home and office environment with a large safety margin.
To document immunity against electrical interference from electrical phenomena, the following immunity tests have been
made in accordance with following basic standards:

EN 61000-4-2 (IEC 61000-4-2): Electrostatic discharges (ESD): Simulation of electrostatic discharges from human
beings.

EN 61000-4-3 (IEC 61000-4-3): Incoming electromagnetic field radiation, amplitude modulated simulation of the
effects of radar and radio communication equipment as well as mobile communications equipment.

EN 61000-4-4 (IEC 61000-4-4): Electrical interference: Simulation of interference brought about by switching a
contactor, relay or similar devices.

EN 61000-4-5 (IEC 61000-4-5): Surge transients: Simulation of transients brought about, e.g., by lightning that
strikes near installations.

EN 61000-4-6 (IEC 61000-4-6): RF Common mode: Simulation of the effect from radio-transmission equipment
joined by connection cables.

5 5

See Table 5.5.


Basic standard

Acceptance criterion

Electrical
interference
IEC 61000-4-4

Surge
IEC 61000-4-5

ESD
IEC
61000-4-2

Radiated electromagnetic
field
IEC 61000-4-3

RF common
mode voltage
IEC 61000-4-6

Voltage range: 200240 V, 380500 V, 525600 V, 525690 V


Line

4 kV CM

2 kV/2 DM
4 kV/12 CM

10 VRMS

Motor

4 kV CM

4 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

Brake

4 kV CM

4 kV/2

1)

10 VRMS

Load sharing

4 kV CM

4 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

Control wires

2 kV CM

2 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

Standard bus

2 kV CM

2 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

Relay wires

2 kV CM

2 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

Application and Serial


Communication options

2 kV CM

2 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

LCP cable

2 kV CM

2 kV/2 1)

10 VRMS

2 V CM

0.5 kV/2 DM
1 kV/12 CM

10 VRMS

8 kV AD
6 kV CD

10 V/m

External 24 V DC
Enclosure

Table 5.5 EMC Immunity Form


1)

Injection on cable shield

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

57

5 5

System Integration

Design Guide

5.2.4 Motor Insulation

Standard Mitigation Strategies


1.
Use an insulated bearing.

Modern design of motors for use with adjustable


frequency drives have a high degree of insulation to
account for new generation high-efficiency IGBTs with high
dU/dt. For retrofit in old motors, it is necessary to confirm
the motor insulation or to mitigate with dU/dt filter or if
necessary a sine-wave filter. dU/dt

2.

For motor cable lengths the maximum cable length


listed in chapter 6.2 General Specifications, the motor
insulation ratings listed in Table 5.6 are recommended. If a
motor has lower insulation rating, it is recommended to
use a dU/dt or sine-wave filter.

Apply rigorous installation procedures


2a

Ensure the motor and load motor are


aligned.

2b

Strictly follow the EMC Installation


guideline.

2c

Reinforce the PE so the high frequency


impedance is lower in the PE than the
input power leads.

2d

Provide a good high frequency


connection between the motor and the
adjustable frequency drive for instance
by shielded cable which has a 360
connection in the motor and the
adjustable frequency drive

2e

Make sure that the impedance from


adjustable frequency drive to building
ground is lower that the grounding
impedance of the machine. This can be
difficult for pumps.

2f

Make a direct ground connection


between the motor and load motor.

Nominal AC Line Voltage [V] Motor Insulation [V]


UN 420

Standard ULL = 1300

420 V < UN 500

Reinforced ULL = 1600

500 V < UN 600

Reinforced ULL = 1800

600 V < UN 690

Reinforced ULL = 2000

Table 5.6 Motor Insulation

5.2.5 Motor Bearing Currents


To minimize bearing and shaft currents, ground the
following to the driven machine:

58

3.

Lower the IGBT switching frequency.

4.

Modify the inverter waveform, 60 AVM vs.


SFAVM.

5.

Install a shaft grounding system or use an


isolating coupling.

6.

Apply conductive lubrication.

7.

Use minimum speed settings if possible.

8.

Try to ensure the line voltage is balanced to


ground. This can be difficult for IT, TT, TN-CS or
Grounded leg systems.

9.

Use a dU/dt or sinus filter.

adjustable frequency drive


motor
driven machine
motor

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

System Integration

Design Guide

5.3 Line Power Supply Interference/


Harmonics

5.3.1 The Effect of Harmonics in a Power


Distribution System

An adjustable frequency drive takes up a non-sinusoidal


current from the line power, which increases the input
current IRMS. A non-sinusoidal current is transformed by
means of a Fourier analysis and split up into sine-wave
currents with different frequencies, i.e., different harmonic
currents In with 50 Hz as the basic frequency:

In Figure 5.5, a transformer is connected on the primary


side to a point of common coupling PCC1, on the medium
voltage supply. The transformer has an impedance of Zxfr
and feeds a number of loads. The point of common
coupling where all loads are connected together is PCC2.
Each load is connected through cables that have an
impedance of Z1, Z2, Z3.

Harmonic currents

I1

I5

I7

Hz

50

250

350

Table 5.7 Transformed Non-sinusoidal Current

175HA034.10

The harmonics do not affect the power consumption


directly, but they do increase the heat losses in the installation (transformer, cables). Consequently, in plants with a
high percentage of rectifier load, maintain harmonic
currents at a low level to prevent an overload of the
transformer and high temperature in the cables.

Figure 5.4 Intermediate Circuit Coils


Figure 5.5 Small Distribution System

NOTICE!
Some of the harmonic currents might disturb communication equipment connected to the same transformer or
cause resonance in connection with power-factor
correction units.

Current distortion relates to apparatus performance, which


in turn relates to the individual load. Voltage distortion
relates to system performance. It is not possible to
determine the voltage distortion in the PCC knowing only
the loads harmonic performance. To predict the distortion
in the PCC, the configuration of the distribution system
and relevant impedances must be known.

Input current
IRMS

1.0

I1

0.9

I5

0.4

I7

0.2

I11-49

< 0.1

Harmonic currents drawn by non-linear loads cause


distortion of the voltage because of the voltage drop in
the impedances of the distribution system. Higher
impedances result in higher levels of voltage distortion.

Table 5.8 Harmonic Currents Compared to the RMS Input


Current

To ensure low harmonic currents, the adjustable frequency


drive is equipped with intermediate circuit coils as
standard. DC coils reduce the total harmonic distortion
(THD) to 40%.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

59

5 5

A commonly used term for describing the impedance of a


grid is the short circuit ratio Rsce, defined as the ratio
between the short circuit apparent power of the supply at
the PCC (Ssc) and the rated apparent power of the load
(Sequ).
Rsce =

Sce
Sequ

where

Ssc =

U
Zsupply

and

Sequ = U Iequ

The negative effect of harmonics is two-fold


Harmonic currents contribute to system losses (in
cabling, transformer)

Harmonic voltage distortion causes disturbance


to other loads and increase losses in other loads
130BB541.10

5 5

Design Guide

System Integration

Non-linear

Current

System
Impedance

Voltage

There are various harmonic mitigation standards,


regulations and recommendations. Different standards
apply in different geographical areas and industries. The
following standards are the most common:

IEC61000-3-2
IEC61000-3-12
IEC61000-3-4
IEEE 519
G5/4

See the AHF 005/010 Design Guide for specific details on


each standard.
In Europe, the maximum THVD is 8% if the plant is
connected via the public grid. If the plant has its own
transformer, the limit is 10% THVD. The VLT
AutomationDrive is designed to withstand 10% THVD.

5.3.3 Harmonic Mitigation


Contribution to
system losses

Disturbance to
other users

Figure 5.6 Negative Effects of Harmonics

5.3.2 Harmonic Limitation Standards and


Requirements
The requirements for harmonic limitation can be
application specific requirements

standards that must be observed

The application specific requirements are related to a


specific installation where there are technical reasons for
limiting the harmonics.
Example
A 250 kVA transformer with two 110 kW motors connected
is sufficient if one of the motors is connected directly
online and the other is supplied through an adjustable
frequency drive. However, the transformer is undersized if
both motors are supplied by an adjustable frequency drive.
Using additional means of harmonic reduction within the
installation or selecting low harmonic drive variants makes
it possible for both motors to run with adjustable
frequency drives.

In cases where additional harmonic suppression is


required, Danfoss offers a wide range of mitigation
equipment. These are:

12-pulse drives
AHF filters
Low Harmonic Drives
Active Filters

The choice of the right solution depends on several


factors:
The grid (background distortion, line power
unbalance, resonance and type of supply
(transformer/generator)

Application (load profile, number of loads and


load size)

Local/national requirements/regulations (IEEE519,


IEC, G5/4, etc.)

Total cost of ownership (initial cost, efficiency,


maintenance, etc.)

Always consider harmonic mitigation if the transformer


load has a non-linear contribution of 40% or more.

5.3.4 Harmonic Calculation


Danfoss offers tools for calculation of harmonics, see
chapter 9.6.5 PC Software.

60

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

System Integration

Design Guide

5.4 Galvanic Isolation (PELV)

The functional galvanic isolation (a and b in drawing) is for


the 24 V backup option and for the RS-485 standard bus
interface.

5.4.1 PELV - Protective Extra Low Voltage


PELV offers protection by way of extra low voltage.
Protection against electric shock is ensured when the
electrical supply is of the PELV type and the installation is
made as described in local/national regulations on PELV
supplies.
All control terminals and relay terminals 01-03/04-06
comply with PELV (Protective Extra Low Voltage), with the
exception of the grounded Delta leg above 400 V.
Galvanic (ensured) isolation is obtained by fulfilling
requirements for higher isolation and by providing the
relevant creepage/clearance distances. These requirements
are described in the EN 61800-5-1 standard.
The components that make up the electrical isolation, as
described below, also comply with the requirements for
higher isolation and the relevant test as described in EN
61800-5-1.
The PELV galvanic isolation can be shown in six locations
(see Figure 5.7):

WARNING
Installation at high altitude:
At altitudes above 6,600 ft [2,000 m], contact Danfoss
regarding PELV.

Touching the electrical parts could be fatal - even after


the equipment has been disconnected from line power.
Also make sure that other voltage inputs have been
disconnected, such as load sharing (linkage of DC
intermediate circuit), as well as the motor connection for
kinetic backup.
Before touching any electrical parts, wait at least the
amount of time indicated in Table 2.1.
Shorter time is allowed only if indicated on the
nameplate for the specific unit.

5.5 Brake Functions

To maintain PELV all connections made to the control


terminals must be PELV, e.g., thermistor must be
reinforced/double insulated.

Braking function is applied for braking the load on the


motor shaft, either as dynamic braking or mechanical
braking.

Power supply (SMPS) incl. signal isolation of DC


link.

2.

Gate drive that runs the IGBTs (trigger


transformers/opto-couplers).

5.5.1 Selection of Brake Resistor

3.

Current transducers.

4.

Opto-coupler, brake module.

5.

Internal soft-charge, RFI and temperature


measurement circuits.

The brake resistor ensures that the energy is absorbed in


the brake resistor and not in the adjustable frequency
drive. For more information, see the Brake Resistor Design
Guide.

6.

Custom relays.

7.

Mechanical brake.
130BC968.10

1.

7
6

5 5

WARNING

If the amount of kinetic energy transferred to the resistor


in each braking period is not known, the average power
can be calculated on the basis of the cycle time and
braking time also called intermittent duty cycle. The
resistor intermittent duty cycle is an indication of the duty
cycle at which the resistor is active. Figure 5.8 shows a
typical braking cycle.

NOTICE!
Motor suppliers often use S5 when stating the
permissible load which is an expression of intermittent
duty cycle.

Figure 5.7 Galvanic Isolation

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

61

Design Guide

System Integration

The intermittent duty cycle for the resistor is calculated as


follows:
Duty cycle = tb/T
T = cycle time in s
tb is the braking time in s (of the cycle time)

ED duty cycle =

tb
T cycle

where tb is the braking time in seconds and T cycle is the


total cycle time.

130BA167.10

Load

The max. permissible load on the brake resistor is stated as


a peak power at a given intermittent duty cycle and can
be calculated as:

The brake resistance is calculated as shown:

5 5

Speed

ta

tc

tb

to

ta

tc

tb

to

Rbr =

ta

U2
dc

Ppeak

where

T
Time

Figure 5.8 Typical Braking Cycle

Ppeak = Pmotor x Mbr [%] x motor x VLT[W]

Cycle time (s)

Braking duty
cycle at
100% torque

Braking duty
cycle at over
torque
(150/160%)

PK25-P11K

120

Continuous

40%

P15K-P37K

300

10%

PK37-P75K

120

P90K-P160

600

P200-P800

200240 V

Size

Brake active

Warning before
cut-out

Cut-out
(trip)

10%

FC 301/FC 302
200240 V

390 V

405 V

410 V

Continuous

40%

810 V

820 V

10%

FC 301
380480 V

778 V

Continuous

600

40%

10%

FC 302
380500 V

810 V

840 V

850 V

120

Continuous

40%

FC 302
525600 V

943 V

965 V

975 V

600

40%

10%

FC 302
525690 V

1084 V

1109 V

1130 V

380500 V

525600 V
PK75-P75K
525690 V
P37K-P400

The brake resistance depends on the intermediate circuit


voltage (Udc).
The FC 301 and FC 302 brake function is settled in four
areas of line power.

P500-P560

600

P630-P1M0

600

40%

1)

10%

40%

2)

10%
Table 5.10 Brake Limits [UDC]

Table 5.9 Braking at High Overload Torque Level


1)

650 hp [500 kW] at 86% braking torque/750 hp [560 kW] at 76%

braking torque
2)

650 hp [500 kW] at 130% braking torque/750 hp [560 kW] at 115%

braking torque

Danfoss offers brake resistors with duty cycles of 5%, 10%


and 40%. If a 10% duty cycle is applied, the brake resistors
are able to absorb braking energy for 10% of the cycle
time. The remaining 90% of the cycle time is used on
dissipating excess heat.

NOTICE!
Check that the brake resistor can cope with a voltage of
410 V, 820 V, 850 V, 975 V or 1130 V - unless Danfoss
brake resistors are used.
Danfoss recommends the brake resistance Rrec, i.e., one
that guarantees that the adjustable frequency drive is able
to brake at the highest braking torque (Mbr(%)) of 160%.
The formula can be written as:
U2
dc x 100

NOTICE!

R rec =

Make sure the resistor is designed to handle the


required braking time.

motor is typically at 0.90


DRIVE is typically at 0.98

62

Pmotor x Mbr % x DRIVE x motor

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

System Integration

Design Guide

For 200 V, 480 V, 500 V and 600 V adjustable frequency


drives, Rrec at 160% braking torque is written as:
200V : Rrec =
480V : Rrec =

107780

Pmotor

375300

Pmotor

EMC (twisted cables/shielding)


To meet the specified EMC performance of the adjustable
frequency drive, use shielded cables/wires. If non-shielded
wires are used, it is recommended to twist the wires to
reduce the electrical noise from the wires between the
brake resistor and the adjustable frequency drive.

428914

2
Pmotor
464923
500V : Rrec =

Pmotor
630137
600V : Rrec =

Pmotor
832664
690V : Rrec =

Pmotor
480V : Rrec =

For enhanced EMC performance, use a metal shield.

1)

For adjustable frequency drives 10 hp [7.5 kW] shaft


output
2) For adjustable frequency drives 15100 hp [1175 kW] shaft
output

NOTICE!
The resistor brake circuit resistance selected should not
be higher than that recommended by Danfoss. If a brake
resistor with a higher ohmic value is selected, the 160%
braking torque may not be achieved because there is a
risk that the adjustable frequency drive cuts out for
safety reasons.

NOTICE!
If a short circuit in the brake transistor occurs, power
dissipation in the brake resistor is only prevented by
using a line switch or contactor to disconnect the line
power for the adjustable frequency drive. (The contactor
can be controlled by the adjustable frequency drive).

CAUTION
The brake resistor gets hot during and after braking.

To avoid personal injury, do not touch the


brake resistor.

Place the brake resistor in a secure environment


to avoid fire risk.

CAUTION
Enclosure types D-F adjustable frequency drives contain
more than one brake chopper. Consequently, use one
brake resistor per brake chopper for those enclosure
types.

MG33BF22

5.5.2 Brake Resistor Cabling

5 5

5.5.3 Control with Brake Function


The brake is protected against short-circuiting of the brake
resistor, and the brake transistor is monitored to ensure
that short-circuiting of the transistor is detected. A relay/
digital output can be used for protecting the brake resistor
against overloading in connection with a fault in the
adjustable frequency drive.
In addition, the brake enables reading out the momentary
power and the mean power for the latest 120 s. The brake
can also monitor the power energizing and ensure that it
does not exceed the limit selected in 2-12 Brake Power
Limit (kW). In 2-13 Brake Power Monitoring, select the
function to carry out when the power transmitted to the
brake resistor exceeds the limit set in 2-12 Brake Power
Limit (kW).

NOTICE!
Monitoring the braking energy is not a safety function; a
thermal switch is required for that purpose. The brake
resistor circuit is not protected against ground leakage.
Overvoltage control (OVC) (exclusive brake resistor) can be
selected as an alternative brake function in 2-17 Overvoltage Control. This function is active for all units. The
function ensures that a trip can be avoided, if the DC link
voltage increases. This is done by increasing the output
frequency to limit the voltage from the DC link. It is a
useful function, e.g., if the ramp-down time is too short
since tripping of the adjustable frequency drive is avoided.
In this situation, the ramp-down time is extended.

NOTICE!
OVC cannot be activated when running a PM motor
(when 1-10 Motor Construction is set to [1] PM non salient
SPM).

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

63

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6 Product Specifications
6.1 Electrical Data
6.1.1 Line Power Supply 200240 V
Type Designation

PK25

PK37

PK55

PK75

P1K1

P1K5

P2K2

P3K0

P3K7

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

0.25

0.37

0.55

0.75

1.1

1.5

2.2

3.0

3.7

Enclosure IP20 (FC 301 only)

A1

A1

A1

A1

A1

A1

Enclosure IP20/IP21

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A3

A3

Enclosure IP55, IP66

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A5

A5
16.7

Output current
Continuous (200240 V) [A]

1.8

2.4

3.5

4.6

6.6

7.5

10.6

12.5

Intermittent (200240 V) [A]

2.9

3.8

5.6

7.4

10.6

12.0

17.0

20.0

26.7

Continuous kVA (208 V) [kVA]

0.65

0.86

1.26

1.66

2.38

2.70

3.82

4.50

6.00

Continuous (200240 V) [A]

1.6

2.2

3.2

4.1

5.9

6.8

9.5

11.3

15.0

Intermittent (200240 V) [A]

2.6

3.5

5.1

6.6

9.4

10.9

15.2

18.1

24.0

Max. input current

Additional Specifications
Max. cable cross-section4) for line power,

4,4,4 (12,12,12)
(min. 0.2 (24))

motor, brake and load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])


Max. cable cross-section4) for disconnect

6,4,4 (10,12,12)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp
[W]3)
Efficiency2)

21

29

42

54

63

82

116

155

185

0.94

0.94

0.95

0.95

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

Table 6.1 Line Power Supply 200240 V, PK25-P3K7

64

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation

P5K5

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

5.5

P7K5
NO

HO

7.5

7.5

P11K
NO

HO

11

11

NO
15

Enclosure IP20

B3

B3

B4

Enclosure IP21, IP55, IP66

B1

B1

B2

Output current
Continuous (200240 V) [A]

24.2

30.8

30.8

46.2

46.2

59.4

Intermittent (60 s overload) (200240 V) [A]

38.7

33.9

49.3

50.8

73.9

65.3

Continuous kVA (208 V) [kVA]

8.7

11.1

11.1

16.6

16.6

21.4

Continuous (200240 V) [A]

22.0

28.0

28.0

42.0

42.0

54.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (200240 V) [A]

35.2

30.8

44.8

46.2

67.2

59.4

Max. input current

6 6

Additional Specifications
IP20 max. cable cross-section4) for line power, brake, motor and
load sharing

[mm2]

10,10,- (8,8,-)

10,10,- (8,8,-)

35,-,- (2,-,-)

16,10,16 (6,8,6)

16,10,16 (6,8,6)

35,-,- (2,-,-)

10,10,- (8,8,-)

35,25,25 (2,4,4)

([AWG])

IP21 max. cable cross-section4) for line power, brake and load
sharing [mm2] ([AWG])
IP21 max. cable cross-section4) for motor [mm2] ([AWG])

10,10,- (8,8,-)

Max. cable cross-section4) for Disconnect [mm2] ([AWG])

16,10,10 (6,8,8)

Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp [W]3)

239

310

Efficiency2)

371

0.96

514

463

0.96

602
0.96

Table 6.2 Line Power Supply 200240 V, P5K5-P11K


Type Designation

P15K

P18K

P22K

P30K

P37K

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

NO

HO

NO

HO

NO

HO

NO

HO

NO

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

15

18.5

18.5

22

22

30

30

37

37

45

Enclosure IP20

B4

C3

C3

C4

C4

Enclosure IP21, IP55, IP66

C1

C1

C1

C2

C2

Output current
Continuous (200240 V) [A]

59.4

74.8

74.8

88.0

88.0

115

115

143

143

170

Intermittent (60 s overload) (200240 V) [A]

89.1

82.3

112

96.8

132

127

173

157

215

187

Continuous kVA (208 V) [kVA]

21.4

26.9

26.9

31.7

31.7

41.4

41.4

51.5

51.5

61.2

Continuous (200240 V) [A]

54.0

68.0

68.0

80.0

80.0

104

104

130

130

154

Intermittent (60 s overload) (200240 V) [A]

81.0

74.8

102

88.0

120

114

156

143

195

169

Max. input current

Additional Specifications
IP20 max. cable cross-section for line power,
brake, motor and load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section for line
power and motor [mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section for
brake and load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])

35 (2)

50 (1)

50 (1)

150 (300MCM)

150 (300MCM)

50 (1)

50 (1)

50 (1)

150 (300MCM)

150 (300MCM)

50 (1)

50 (1)

50 (1)

95 (3/0)

95 (3/0)

95, 70, 70
(3/0, 2/0, 2/0)

185, 150, 120


(350MCM,
300MCM, 4/0)

1143

1400

Max. cable cross-section4) for Disconnect

50, 35, 35 (1, 2, 2)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp
[W]3)

624

Efficiency2)

737
0.96

740

845

874

0.97

1140
0.97

0.97

1353

1636

0.97

Table 6.3 Line Power Supply 200240 V, P15K-P37K

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

65

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.1.2 Line Power Supply 380500 V


Type Designation

PK37

PK55

PK75

P1K1

P1K5

P2K2

P3K0

P4K0

P5K5

P7K5

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

0.37

0.55

0.75

1.1

1.5

2.2

3.0

4.0

5.5

7.5

Enclosure IP20 (FC 301 only)

A1

A1

A1

A1

A1

Enclosure IP20/IP21

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A2

A3

A3

Enclosure IP55, IP66

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A4/A5

A5

A5
7.5

Output Current High Overload 160% for 1 min


Shaft output [kW]

0.37

0.55

0.75

1.1

1.5

2.2

5.5

Continuous (380440 V) [A]

1.3

1.8

2.4

3.0

4.1

5.6

7.2

10

13

16

Intermittent (380440 V) [A]

2.1

2.9

3.8

4.8

6.6

9.0

11.5

16

20.8

25.6

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

1.2

1.6

2.1

2.7

3.4

4.8

6.3

8.2

11

14.5

Intermittent (441500 V) [A]

1.9

2.6

3.4

4.3

5.4

7.7

10.1

13.1

17.6

23.2

Continuous kVA (400 V) [kVA]

0.9

1.3

1.7

2.1

2.8

3.9

5.0

6.9

9.0

11

Continuous kVA (460 V) [kVA]

0.9

1.3

1.7

2.4

2.7

3.8

5.0

6.5

8.8

11.6

Max. input current


Continuous (380440 V) [A]

1.2

1.6

2.2

2.7

3.7

5.0

6.5

9.0

11.7

14.4

Intermittent (380440 V) [A]

1.9

2.6

3.5

4.3

5.9

8.0

10.4

14.4

18.7

23

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

1.0

1.4

1.9

2.7

3.1

4.3

5.7

7.4

9.9

13

Intermittent (441500 V) [A]

1.6

2.2

3.0

4.3

5.0

6.9

9.1

11.8

15.8

20.8

Additional Specifications
IP20, IP21 max. cable cross-section4) for line
power, motor, brake and load sharing

4,4,4 (12,12,12)
(min. 0.2(24))

[mm2] ([AWG])
IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section4) for line
power, motor, brake and load sharing

4,4,4 (12,12,12)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Max. cable cross-section4) for disconnect

6,4,4 (10,12,12)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp
[W]3)
Efficiency2)

35

42

46

58

62

88

116

124

187

255

0.93

0.95

0.96

0.96

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

Table 6.4 Line Power Supply 380500 V (FC 302), 380480 V (FC 301), PK37-P7K5

66

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation

P11K

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

Typical Shaft output [kW]

11

P15K
NO

HO

15

15

P18K
NO

HO

18.5

18.5

P22K
NO

HO

22.0

22.0

NO
30.0

Enclosure IP20

B3

B3

B4

B4

Enclosure IP21

B1

B1

B2

B2

Enclosure IP55, IP66

B1

B1

B2

B2

Output current
Continuous (380440 V) [A]

24

32

32

37.5

37.5

44

44

61

38.4

35.2

51.2

41.3

60

48.4

70.4

67.1

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

21

27

27

34

34

40

40

52

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(441500 V) [A]

33.6

29.7

43.2

37.4

54.4

44

64

57.2

Continuous kVA (400 V) [kVA]

16.6

22.2

22.2

26

26

30.5

30.5

42.3

Intermittent (60 s overload) (380440 V) [A]

Continuous kVA (460 V) [kVA]

21.5

27.1

31.9

6 6

41.4

Max. input current


Continuous (380440 V) [A]

22

29

29

34

34

40

40

55

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(380440 V) [A]

35.2

31.9

46.4

37.4

54.4

44

64

60.5

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

19

25

25

31

31

36

36

47

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(441500 V) [A]

30.4

27.5

40

34.1

49.6

39.6

57.6

51.7

Additional specifications
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section4) for
line power, brake and load sharing

16, 10, 16 (6, 8, 6)

16, 10, 16 (6, 8, 6)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

35, 25, 25 (2, 4, 4)

35, 25, 25 (2, 4, 4)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

[mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section4) for
motor [mm2] ([AWG])
IP20 max. cable cross-section4) for line power,
brake, motor and load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])
Max. cable cross-section4) for Disconnect

16, 10, 10 (6, 8, 8)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp
[W]3)
Efficiency2)

291

392
0.98

379

465
0.98

444

525
0.98

547

739
0.98

Table 6.5 Line Power Supply 380500 V (FC 302), 380480 V (FC 301), P11K-P22K

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

67

6 6

Design Guide

Product Specifications

Type Designation

P30K

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

Typical Shaft output [kW]

30

Enclosure IP21

P37K
NO

HO

37

37

P45K
NO

HO

45

45

P55K
NO

HO

55

55

P75K
NO

HO

75

75

NO
90

C1

C1

C1

C2

C2

Enclosure IP20

B4

C3

C3

C4

C4

Enclosure IP55, IP66

C1

C1

C1

C2

C2

Output current
Continuous (380440 V) [A]

61

73

73

90

90

106

106

147

147

177

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(380440 V) [A]

91.5

80.3

110

99

135

117

159

162

221

195

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

52

65

65

80

80

105

105

130

130

160

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(441500 V) [A]

78

71.5

97.5

88

120

116

158

143

195

176

42.3

50.6

50.6

62.4

62.4

73.4

73.4

102

102

123

Continuous kVA (400 V) [kVA]


Continuous kVA (460 V) [kVA]

51.8

63.7

83.7

104

128

Max. input current


Continuous (380440 V) [A]

55

66

66

82

82

96

96

133

133

161

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(380440 V) [A]

82.5

72.6

99

90.2

123

106

144

146

200

177

Continuous (441500 V) [A]

47

59

59

73

73

95

95

118

118

145

Intermittent (60 s overload)


(441500 V) [A]

70.5

64.9

88.5

80.3

110

105

143

130

177

160

Additional specifications
IP20 max. cable cross-section for
line power and motor

35 (2)

50 (1)

50 (1)

150 (300 MCM)

150 (300 MCM)

35 (2)

50 (1)

50 (1)

95 (4/0)

95 (4/0)

50 (1)

50 (1)

50 (1)

150 (300 MCM)

150 (300MCM)

50 (1)

50 (1)

50 (1)

95 (3/0)

95 (3/0)

95, 70, 70
(3/0, 2/0, 2/0)

185, 150, 120


(350 MCM,
300 MCM, 4/0)

1022

1232

[mm2] ([AWG])
IP20 max. cable cross-section for
brake and load sharing
[mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable crosssection for line power and motor
[mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable crosssection for brake and load sharing
[mm2] ([AWG])
Max cable cross-section4) for line

50, 35, 35
(1, 2, 2)

power disconnect [mm2] ([AWG])


Estimated power loss
at rated max. load hp [W]3)
Efficiency2)

570

698
0.98

697

843

891

0.98

1083
0.98

1384
0.98

1474
0.99

Table 6.6 Line Power Supply 380500 V (FC 302), 380480 V (FC 301), P30K-P75K

68

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.1.3 Line Power Supply 525600 V (FC 302 only)


Type Designation

PK75

P1K1

P1K5

P2K2

P3K0

P4K0

P5K5

P7K5

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

0.75

1.1

1.5

2.2

5.5

7.5

Enclosure IP20, IP21

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

Enclosure IP55

A5

A5

A5

A5

A5

A5

A5

A5

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

1.8

2.6

2.9

4.1

5.2

6.4

9.5

11.5

Intermittent (525550 V) [A]

2.9

4.2

4.6

6.6

8.3

10.2

15.2

18.4
11.0

Continuous (551600 V) [A]

1.7

2.4

2.7

3.9

4.9

6.1

9.0

Intermittent (551600 V) [A]

2.7

3.8

4.3

6.2

7.8

9.8

14.4

17.6

Continuous kVA (525 V) [kVA]

1.7

2.5

2.8

3.9

5.0

6.1

9.0

11.0

Continuous kVA (575 V) [kVA]

1.7

2.4

2.7

3.9

4.9

6.1

9.0

11.0

Continuous (525600 V) [A]

1.7

2.4

2.7

4.1

5.2

5.8

8.6

10.4

Intermittent (525600 V) [A]

2.7

3.8

4.3

6.6

8.3

9.3

13.8

16.6

6 6

Max. input current

Additional specifications
Max. cable cross-section4) for line power, motor,
brake and load sharing

[mm2]

4,4,4 (12,12,12)
(min. 0.2 (24))

([AWG])

Max. cable cross-section4) for disconnect

6,4,4 (10,12,12)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp
[W]3)
Efficiency2)

35

50

65

92

122

145

195

261

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

0.97

Table 6.7 Line Power Supply 525600 V (FC 302 only), PK75-P7K5

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

69

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation

P11K

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

11

P15K
NO

HO

15

15

P18K
NO

HO

18.5

18.5

P22K
NO

HO

22

22

P30K
NO

HO

30

30

NO
37

Enclosure IP20

B3

B3

B4

B4

B4

Enclosure IP21, IP55, IP66

B1

B1

B2

B2

C1

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

19

23

23

28

Intermittent (525550 V) [A]

30

25

37

Continuous (551600 V) [A]

18

22

22

Intermittent (551600 V) [A]

28

36

36

43

43

54

31

45

40

58

47

65

59

27

27

34

34

41

41

52

29

24

35

30

43

37

54

45

62

57

Continuous kVA (550 V) [kVA]

18.1

21.9

21.9

26.7

26.7

34.3

34.3

41.0

41.0

51.4

Continuous kVA (575 V) [kVA]

17.9

21.9

21.9

26.9

26.9

33.9

33.9

40.8

40.8

51.8

Continuous at 550 V [A]

17.2

20.9

20.9

25.4

25.4

32.7

32.7

39

39

49

Intermittent at 550 V [A]

28

23

33

28

41

36

52

43

59

54

Continuous at 575 V [A]

16

20

20

24

24

31

31

37

37

47

Intermittent at 575 V [A]

26

22

32

27

39

34

50

41

56

52

Max. input current

Additional specifications
IP20 max. cable cross-section4) for
line power, brake, motor and load

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

35,-,-(2,-,-)

50,-,- (1,-,-)

35, 25, 25 (2, 4, 4)

35, 25, 25 (2, 4, 4)

50,-,- (1,-,-)

sharing [mm2] ([AWG])


IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable crosssection4) for line power, brake and

16, 10, 10 (6, 8, 8) 16, 10, 10 (6, 8, 8)

load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])


IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable crosssection4) for motor [mm2] ([AWG])

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

10, 10,- (8, 8,-)

Max. cable cross-section4) for

16, 10, 10
(6, 8, 8)

Disconnect [mm2] ([AWG])


Estimated power loss
at rated max. load hp [W]3)
Efficiency2)

220

300
0.98

300

370

50, 35, 35
(1, 2, 2)

370

0.98

440
0.98

440

600
0.98

600

740
0.98

Table 6.8 Line Power Supply 525600 V (FC 302 only), P11K-P30K

70

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation
High/Normal Overload1)

P37K
HO

P45K
NO

HO
45

P55K
NO

HO

55

55

P75K
NO

HO

75

75

NO

Typical Shaft Output [kW]

37

45

Enclosure IP20

C3

C3

C3

C4

C4

90

Enclosure IP21, IP55, IP66

C1

C1

C1

C2

C2

54

65

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

65

87

87

105

105

137

Intermittent (525550 V) [A]

81

72

98

96

131

116

158

151

Continuous (551600 V) [A]

52

62

62

83

83

100

100

131

Intermittent (551600 V) [A]

78

68

93

91

125

110

150

144

Continuous kVA (550 V) [kVA]

51.4

61.9

61.9

82.9

82.9

100.0

100.0

130.5

Continuous kVA (575 V) [kVA]

51.8

61.7

61.7

82.7

82.7

99.6

99.6

130.5

Continuous at 550 V [A]

49

59

59

78.9

78.9

95.3

95.3

124.3

Intermittent at 550 V [A]

74

65

89

87

118

105

143

137

Continuous at 575 V [A]

47

56

56

75

75

91

91

119

Intermittent at 575 V [A]

70

62

85

83

113

100

137

131

6 6

Max. input current

Additional specifications
IP20 max. cable cross-section for line power and
motor [mm2] ([AWG])
IP20 max. cable cross-section for brake and load
sharing [mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section for line power
and motor [mm2] ([AWG])
IP21, IP55, IP66 max. cable cross-section for brake and
load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])
Max cable cross-section4) for line power disconnect

Efficiency2)

150 (300 MCM)

50 (1)

95 (4/0)

50 (1)

150 (300 MCM)

50 (1)

95 (4/0)

50, 35, 35
(1, 2, 2)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp [W]3)

50 (1)

740

900
0.98

900

1100
0.98

95, 70, 70
(3/0, 2/0, 2/0)

185, 150, 120


(350MCM,
300MCM, 4/0)

1100

1500

1500
0.98

1800
0.98

Table 6.9 Line Power Supply 525600 V (FC 302 only), P37K-P75K

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

71

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.1.4 Line Power Supply 525690 V (FC 302 only)


Type Designation

P1K1

P1K5

P2K2

P3K0

P4K0

P5K5

P7K5

HO/NO

HO/NO

HO/NO

HO/NO

HO/NO

HO/NO

HO/NO

Typical Shaft output (kW)

1.1

1.5

2.2

3.0

4.0

5.5

7.5

Enclosure IP20

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3

A3
11.0

High/Normal Overload1)

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

2.1

2.7

3.9

4.9

6.1

9.0

Intermittent (525550 V) [A]

3.4

4.3

6.2

7.8

9.8

14.4

17.6

Continuous (551690 V) [A]

1.6

2.2

3.2

4.5

5.5

7.5

10.0

Intermittent (551690 V) [A]

2.6

3.5

5.1

7.2

8.8

12.0

16.0

Continuous KVA 525 V

1.9

2.5

3.5

4.5

5.5

8.2

10.0

Continuous KVA 690 V

1.9

2.6

3.8

5.4

6.6

9.0

12.0

Continuous (525550 V) [A]

1.9

2.4

3.5

4.4

5.5

8.1

9.9

Intermittent (525550 V) [A]

3.0

3.9

5.6

7.0

8.8

12.9

15.8

Continuous (551690 V) [A]

1.4

2.0

2.9

4.0

4.9

6.7

9.0

Intermittent (551690 V) [A]

2.3

3.2

4.6

6.5

7.9

10.8

14.4

Max. input current

Additional specifications
Max. cable cross-section4) for line power, motor, brake

4, 4, 4 (12, 12, 12) (min. 0.2 (24)

and load sharing [mm2] ([AWG])


Max. Cable cross-section4) for disconnect

6, 4, 4 (10, 12, 12)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp (W)3)
Efficiency2)

44

60

88

120

160

220

300

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

0.96

Table 6.10 A3 Enclosure, Line Power Supply 525690 V IP20/Protected Chassis, P1K1-P7K5

72

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation

P11K

P15K

High/Normal Overload1)

HO

NO

HO

Typical Shaft output at 550 V [kW]

7.5

11

11

Typical Shaft output at 690 V [kW]

11

15

15

P18K
NO

P22K

HO

NO

HO

NO

15

15

18.5

18.5

22

18.5

18.5

22

22

30

Enclosure IP20

B4

B4

B4

B4

Enclosure IP21, IP55

B2

B2

B2

B2

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

14.0

19.0

19.0

23.0

23.0

28.0

28.0

36.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (525550 V) [A]

22.4

20.9

30.4

25.3

36.8

30.8

44.8

39.6

Continuous (551690 V) [A]

13.0

18.0

18.0

22.0

22.0

27.0

27.0

34.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (551-690V) [A]

20.8

19.8

28.8

24.2

35.2

29.7

43.2

37.4

continuous KVA (at 550 V) [KVA]

13.3

18.1

18.1

21.9

21.9

26.7

26.7

34.3

continuous KVA (at 690 V) [KVA]

15.5

21.5

21.5

26.3

26.3

32.3

32.3

40.6

Continuous (at 550 V) (A)

15.0

19.5

19.5

24.0

24.0

29.0

29.0

36.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (at 550 V) (A)

23.2

21.5

31.2

26.4

38.4

31.9

46.4

39.6

Continuous (at 690 V) (A)

14.5

19.5

19.5

24.0

24.0

29.0

29.0

36.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (at 690 V) (A)

23.2

21.5

31.2

26.4

38.4

31.9

46.4

39.6

370

370

6 6

Max. input current

Additional specifications
Max. cable cross-section4) for line power/motor,

35, 25, 25 (2, 4, 4)

load share and brake [mm2] ([AWG])


Max cable cross-section4) for line power disconnect

16,10,10 (6, 8, 8)

[mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss at rated max. load hp (W)3)
Efficiency2)

150

220
0.98

220

300
0.98

300
0.98

440
0.98

Table 6.11 B2/B4 Enclosure, Line Power Supply 525690 V IP20/IP21/IP55 - Chassis/NEMA 1/NEMA 12 (FC 302 only), P11K-P22K

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

73

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Type Designation
High/Normal Overload1)

P30K
HO

P37K
NO

HO

P45K
NO

HO

P55K
NO

HO

P75K
NO

HO

NO

Typical Shaft output at 550 V hp [kW]

22

30

30

37

37

45

45

55

50

75

Typical Shaft output at 690 V [kW]

30

37

37

45

45

55

55

75

75

90

Enclosure IP20

B4

C3

C3

D3h

D3h

Enclosure IP21, IP55

C2

C2

C2

C2

C2

Output current
Continuous (525550 V) [A]

36.0

43.0

43.0

54.0

54.0

65.0

65.0

87.0

87.0

105

Intermittent (60 s overload) (525550 V)


[A]

54.0

47.3

64.5

59.4

81.0

71.5

97.5

95.7

130.5

115.5

Continuous (551690 V) [A]

34.0

41.0

41.0

52.0

52.0

62.0

62.0

83.0

83.0

100

Intermittent (60 s overload) (551-690V) [A]

51.0

45.1

61.5

57.2

78.0

68.2

93.0

91.3

124.5

110

continuous KVA (at 550 V) [KVA]

34.3

41.0

41.0

51.4

51.4

61.9

61.9

82.9

82.9

100

continuous KVA (at 690 V) [KVA]

40.6

49.0

49.0

62.1

62.1

74.1

74.1

99.2

99.2

119.5

Continuous (at 550 V) [A]

36.0

49.0

49.0

59.0

59.0

71.0

71.0

87.0

87.0

99.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (at 550 V) [A]

54.0

53.9

72.0

64.9

87.0

78.1

105.0

95.7

129

108.9

Continuous (at 690 V) [A]

36.0

48.0

48.0

58.0

58.0

70.0

70.0

86.0

Intermittent (60 s overload) (at 690 V) [A]

54.0

52.8

72.0

63.8

87.0

77.0

105

94.6

Max. input current

Additional specifications
Max. cable - cross-section for line power

150 (300 MCM)

and motor [mm2] ([AWG])


Max. cable - cross-section for load share

95 (3/0)

and brake [mm2] ([AWG])


Max cable cross-section4) for line power
disconnect [mm2] ([AWG])
Estimated power loss
at rated max. load hp [W]3)
Efficiency2)

185, 150, 120


(350 MCM, 300
MCM, 4/0)

95, 70, 70
(3/0, 2/0, 2/0)
600

740
0.98

740

900
0.98

900

1100
0.98

1100

1500

1500

0.98

1800
0.98

Table 6.12 B4, C2, C3 Enclosure, Line Power Supply 525690 V IP20/IP21/IP55 - Chassis/NEMA1/NEMA 12 (FC 302 only), P30K-P75K
For fuse ratings, see chapter 9.3.1 Fuses and Circuit Breakers.
1)

High overload=150% or 160% torque during 60 s. Normal overload=110% torque during 60 s.

2)

Measured using 16.5 ft. [5 m] shielded motor cables at rated load and rated frequency.

The typical power loss is at nominal load conditions and expected to be within 15% (tolerance relates to variety in voltage and
cable conditions).
Values are based on a typical motor efficiency (eff2/eff3 border line). Motors with lower efficiency also add to the power loss in the
adjustable frequency drive and opposite.
If the switching frequency is increased compared to the default setting, the power losses may rise significantly.
LCP and typical control card power consumption values are included. Further options and customer load may add up to 30 W to the
losses. (Though typical only 4 W extra for a fully loaded control card, or options for slot A or slot B, each).

3)

Although measurements are made with state of the art equipment, some measurement inaccuracy must be allowed for ( 5%).
4)

74

The three values for the max. cable cross-section are for single core, flexible wire and flexible wire with sleeve, respectively.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.2 General Specifications


6.2.1 Line Power Supply
Line power supply
Supply Terminals (6-pulse)
Supply voltage
Supply voltage
Supply voltage
Supply voltage

L1, L2, L3
200240 V 10%
FC 301: 380480 V/FC 302: 380500 V 10%
FC 302: 525600 V 10%
FC 302: 525690 V 10%

AC line voltage low/line drop-out:


During low AC line voltage or a line drop-out, the adjustable frequency drive continues until the intermediate circuit voltage
drops below the minimum stop level, which corresponds typically to 15% below the adjustable frequency drive's lowest rated
supply voltage. Power-up and full torque cannot be expected at AC line voltage lower than 10% below the adjustable frequency
drive's lowest rated supply voltage.
50/60 Hz 5%
3.0% of rated supply voltage
0.9 nominal at rated load
near unity (> 0.98)
maximum 2 times/min.
maximum 1 time/min.
Maximum 1 time/2 min.
Overvoltage category III/pollution degree 2

Supply frequency
Max. temporary imbalance between line phases
True Power Factor ()
Displacement Power Factor (cos )
Switching on input supply L1, L2, L3 (power-ups) 10 hp [7.5 kW]
Switching on input supply L1, L2, L3 (power-ups) 1175 kW
Switching on input supply L1, L2, L3 (power-ups) 90 kW
Environment according to EN60664-1

The unit is suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical Amperes,
240/500/600/690 V maximum.

6.2.2 Motor Output and Motor Data


Motor output (U, V, W)
Output voltage
Output frequency
Output frequency in flux mode
Switching on output
Ramp times
Torque characteristics
Starting torque (constant torque)
Starting/overload torque (variable torque)
Torque rise time in FLUX (for 5 kHz fsw)
Torque rise time in VVCplus (independent of fsw)

0100% of supply voltage


0590 Hz3)
0300 Hz
Unlimited
0.013600 s

maximum 160% for 60 s1) once in 10 min.


maximum 110% up to 0.5 s1) once in 10 min.
1 ms
10 ms

1)

Percentage relates to the nominal torque.


The torque response time depends on application and load but as a general rule, the torque step from 0 to reference is 45 x
torque rise time.
3) Special customer versions with output frequency 01000 Hz are available.

2)

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

75

6 6

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.2.3 Ambient Conditions


Environment
Enclosure
IP20/Chassis, IP21/Type 1, IP55/ Type 12, IP66/ Type 4X
Vibration test
1.0 g
Max. THVD
10%
Max. relative humidity
5%93% (IEC 721-3-3; Class 3K3 (non-condensing) during operation
Aggressive environment (IEC 60068-2-43) H2S test
class Kd
Ambient temperature
Max. 122F [50C] (24-hour average maximum 113F [45C])
Minimum ambient temperature during full-scale operation
32F [0C]
Minimum ambient temperature at reduced performance
14F [10C]
Temperature during storage/transport
-13+149/158F [-25+65/70 C]
Maximum altitude above sea level without derating
3,300 ft [1,000 m]
EMC standards, Emission
EN 61800-3, EN 550111)
EMC standards, Immunity
EN61800-3, EN 61000-6-1/2
1)

See chapter 5.2.1 EMC Test Results

6.2.4 Cable Specifications


Cable lengths and cross-sections for control cables1)
Max. motor cable length, shielded
Max. motor cable length, non-shielded
Maximum cross-section to control terminals, flexible/rigid wire without cable end sleeves
Maximum cross-section to control terminals, flexible wire with cable end sleeves
Maximum cross-section to control terminals, flexible wire with cable end sleeves with collar
Minimum cross-section to control terminals
1)

76

500 ft [150 m]
1,000 ft [300 m]
1.5 mm2/16 AWG
1 mm2/18 AWG
0.5 mm2/20 AWG
0.25 mm2/24 AWG

For power cables, see electrical tables in chapter 6.1 Electrical Data.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.2.5 Control Input/Output and Control Data


6.2.5.1 Digital Inputs
Digital inputs
Programmable digital inputs
Terminal number
Logic
Voltage level
Voltage level, logic'0' PNP
Voltage level, logic'1' PNP
Voltage level, logic '0' NPN2)
Voltage level, logic '1' NPN2)
Maximum voltage on input
Pulse frequency ranges
(Duty cycle) Min. pulse width
Input resistance, Ri

FC 301: 4 (5)1)/FC 302: 4 (6)1)


18, 19, 271), 291), 32, 33
PNP or NPN
024 V DC
< 5 V DC
> 10 V DC
> 19 V DC
< 14 V DC
28 V DC
0110 kHz
4.5 ms
Approx. 4 k

Safe stop Terminal 373, 4) (Terminal 37 is fixed PNP logic)


Voltage level
Voltage level, logic'0' PNP
Voltage level, logic'1' PNP
Maximum voltage on input
Typical input current at 24 V
Typical input current at 20 V
Input capacitance

024 V DC
<4 V DC
>20 V DC
28 V DC
50 mA rms
60 mA rms
400 nF

All digital inputs are galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.
1) Terminals 27 and 29 can also be programmed as output.
2) Except safe stop input Terminal 37.
3) See VLT Adjustable Frequency Drives - Safe Torque Off Instruction Manual for further information about terminal 37 and Safe
Stop.
4) When using a contactor with a DC coil inside in combination with Safe Stop, it is important to make a return way for the
current from the coil when turning it off. This can be done by using a freewheel diode (or, alternatively, a 30 or 50 V MOV for
quicker response time) across the coil. Typical contactors can be bought with this diode.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

77

6 6

Design Guide

Analog inputs
Number of analog inputs
Terminal number
Modes
Mode select
Voltage mode
Voltage level
Input resistance, Ri
Max. voltage
Current mode
Current level
Input resistance, Ri
Max. current
Resolution for analog inputs
Accuracy of analog inputs
Bandwidth

2
53, 54
Voltage or current
Switch S201 and switch S202
Switch S201/switch S202 = OFF (U)
-10 to +10 V (scaleable)
approx. 10 k
20 V
Switch S201/switch S202 = ON (I)
0/4 to 20 mA (scaleable)
approx. 200
30 mA
10 bit (+ sign)
Max. error 0.5% of full scale
100 Hz

The analog inputs are galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.
PELV isolation
+24V
18

37

Control

Mains

High
voltage

130BA117.10

6 6

Product Specifications

Motor

Functional
isolation
RS485

DC-Bus

Figure 6.1 PELV Isolation

Pulse/encoder inputs
Programmable pulse/encoder inputs
Terminal number pulse/encoder
Max. frequency at terminal 29, 32, 33
Max. frequency at terminal 29, 32, 33
Min. frequency at terminal 29, 32, 33
Voltage level
Maximum voltage on input
Input resistance, Ri
Pulse input accuracy (0.11 kHz)
Encoder input accuracy (111 kHz)

2/1
/
333)
110 kHz (push-pull driven)
5 kHz (open collector)
4 Hz
see section on Digital input
28 V DC
approx. 4 k
Max. error: 0.1% of full scale
Max. error: 0.05% of full scale
291),

332)

323),

The pulse and encoder inputs (terminals 29, 32, 33) are galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other highvoltage terminals.
1) FC 302 only
2) Pulse inputs are 29 and 33
3) Encoder inputs: 32 = A, and 33 = B

78

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Digital output
Programmable digital/pulse outputs
Terminal number
Voltage level at digital/frequency output
Max. output current (sink or source)
Max. load at frequency output
Max. capacitive load at frequency output
Minimum output frequency at frequency output
Maximum output frequency at frequency output
Accuracy of frequency output
Resolution of frequency outputs

2
27, 291)
024 V
40 mA
1 k
10 nF
0 Hz
32 kHz
Max. error: 0.1% of full scale
12 bit

1)

Terminal 27 and 29 can also be programmed as input.


The digital output is galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.

Analog output
Number of programmable analog outputs
Terminal number
Current range at analog output
Max. load GND - analog output less than
Accuracy on analog output
Resolution on analog output

6 6

1
42
0/4 to 20 mA
500
Max. error: 0.5% of full scale
12 bit

The analog output is galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.
Control card, 24 V DC output
Terminal number
Output voltage
Max. load

12, 13
24 V +1, -3 V
200 mA

The 24 V DC supply is galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV), but has the same potential as the analog and digital
inputs and outputs.
Control card, 10 V DC output
Terminal number
Output voltage
Max. load

50
10.5 V 0.5 V
15 mA

The 10 V DC supply is galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.
Control card, RS-485 serial communication
Terminal number
Terminal number 61

68 (P,TX+, RX+), 69 (N,TX-, RX-)


Common for terminals 68 and 69

The RS-485 serial communication circuit is functionally separated from other central circuits and galvanically isolated from the
supply voltage (PELV).
Control card, USB serial communication
USB standard
USB plug

1.1 (Full speed)


USB type B device plug

Connection to PC is carried out via a standard host/device USB cable.


The USB connection is galvanically isolated from the supply voltage (PELV) and other high-voltage terminals.
The USB ground connection is not galvanically isolated from protection ground. Use only an isolated laptop as PC connection to
the USB connector on the adjustable frequency drive.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

79

6 6

Product Specifications

Design Guide

Relay outputs
Programmable relay outputs
Relay 01 Terminal number
Max. terminal load (AC-1)1) on 1-3 (NC), 1-2 (NO) (Resistive load)
Max. terminal load (AC-15)1) (Inductive load @ cos 0.4)
Max. terminal load (DC-1)1) on 1-2 (NO), 1-3 (NC) (Resistive load)
Max. terminal load (DC-13)1) (Inductive load)
Relay 02 (FC 302 only) Terminal number
Max. terminal load (AC-1)1) on 4-5 (NO) (Resistive load)2)3) Overvoltage cat. II
Max. terminal load (AC-15)1) on 4-5 (NO) (Inductive load @ cos 0.4)
Max. terminal load (DC-1)1) on 4-5 (NO) (Resistive load)
Max. terminal load (DC-13)1) on 4-5 (NO) (Inductive load)
Max. terminal load (AC-1)1) on 4-6 (NC) (Resistive load)
Max. terminal load (AC-15)1) on 4-6 (NC) (Inductive load @ cos 0.4)
Max. terminal load (DC-1)1) on 4-6 (NC) (Resistive load)
Max. terminal load (DC-13)1) on 4-6 (NC) (Inductive load)
Min. terminal load on 1-3 (NC), 1-2 (NO), 4-6 (NC), 4-5 (NO)
Environment according to EN 60664-1

FC 301 all kW: 1/FC 302 all kW: 2


1-3 (break), 1-2 (make)
240 V AC, 2 A
240 V AC, 0.2 A
60 V DC, 1 A
24 V DC, 0.1 A
4-6 (break), 4-5 (make)
400 V AC, 2 A
240 V AC, 0.2 A
80 V DC, 2 A
24 V DC, 0.1 A
240 V AC, 2 A
240 V AC, 0.2 A
50 V DC, 2 A
24 V DC, 0.1 A
24 V DC 10 mA, 24 V AC 20 mA
Overvoltage category III/pollution degree 2

1)

IEC 60947 part 4 and 5


The relay contacts are galvanically isolated from the rest of the circuit by reinforced isolation (PELV).
2) Overvoltage Category II
3) UL applications 300 V AC 2A

Control card performance


Scan interval

1 ms

Control characteristics
Resolution of output frequency at 0590 Hz
Repeat accuracy of Precise start/stop (terminals 18, 19)
System response time (terminals 18, 19, 27, 29, 32, 33)
Speed control range (open-loop)
Speed control range (closed-loop)
Speed accuracy (open-loop)
Speed accuracy (closed-loop), depending on resolution of feedback device
Torque control accuracy (speed feedback)

0.003 Hz
0.1 ms
2 ms
1:100 of synchronous speed
1:1000 of synchronous speed
304000 rpm: error 8 rpm
06000 rpm: error 0.15 rpm
max error 5% of rated torque

All control characteristics are based on a 4-pole asynchronous motor.

80

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.2.6 Derating for Ambient Temperature

130BA393.10

80%

A1-A3 45C, A4-A5 40C


A1-A3 50C, A4-A5 45C
A1-A3 55C, A4-A5 50C

40%
20%
0

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

Figure 6.2 Derating of Iout for Different TAMB, MAX for

130BD639.10

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation


Iout (%)

80%
60%
40%

20%
fsw (kHz)

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.5 Derating of Iout for Different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosures Type A, using SFAVM and maximum 33 ft [10 m]
motor cable

Enclosure B, T2, T4 and T5


For the enclosure types B and C, the derating also depends
on the overload mode selected in 1-04 Overload Mode
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation
Iout (%)
HO

110%
100%

A1-A3 45C, A4-A5 40C


A1-A3 50C, A4-A5 45C
A1-A3 55C, A4-A5 50C

80%

fsw (kHz)

40%

B1
B2
45C

60%

50C

20%
0

10

12

14

6 6

6.2.6.2 Derating for Ambient Temperature,


Enclosure Types B

16

Enclosure Type A, using 60 AVM

110%
100%

A1-A3 45C, A4-A5 40C


A1-A3 50C, A4-A5 45C
A1-A3 55C, A4-A5 50C

60%

16

130BA402.10

Iout (%)

60%

80%

40%

60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation


110%
100%

Iout (%)

110%
100%

6.2.6.1 Derating for Ambient Temperature,


Enclosure Type A

130BD640.10

SFAVM

55C

20%

Figure 6.3 Derating of Iout for Different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosures Type A, using SFAVM

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.6 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

110%
100%

130BA394.10

60 AVM
Iout (%)

80%

A1-A3 45C, A4-A5 40C


A1-A3 50C, A4-A5 45C
A1-A3 55C, A4-A5 50C

60%
40%

fsw (kHz)

110%
100%

B1
B2

80%
60%

45C
50C

40%

10

12

14

16

55C
fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.7 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

Figure 6.4 Derating of Iout for Different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosures Type A, using 60 AVM and maximum 33 ft [10 m]
motor cable

MG33BF22

Iout (%)
NO

20%

20%
0 0

Enclosure Types B1 and B2, using 60 AVM in High


overload mode (160% overtorque)

130BA401.11

When using only 33 ft [10 m] motor cable or less in


enclosure size A, less derating is necessary. This is due to
the fact that the length of the motor cable has a relatively
high impact on the recommended derating.

Enclosure Types B1 and B2, using 60 AVM in Normal


overload mode (110% overtorque)

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

81

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B3 & B4

45 C

60%

Iout (%)
NO

110%
100%

B1

80%

B2

60%

45C
50C

40%

55C

50 C

40%

20%
0

20%
0

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

130BA403.11

130BB830.10

Design Guide

fsw (kHz)
2

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.11 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosure Types B1 and B2, using SFAVM in Normal
overload mode (110% overtorque)

16

Figure 6.8 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B3
B4

110%
100%
90%
80%

B3
B4
o

45 C

60%

50 C

40%

45 C

60%

20%

50 C

40%

55 C

20%
0

lout(%)
HO

130BB834.10

130BB828.10

Enclosure Types B3 and B4, using 60 AVM in High overload


mode (160% overtorque)

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.12 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosure Types B3 and B4, using SFAVM in High overload
mode (160% overtorque)

16

Figure 6.9 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosure Types B3 and B4, using 60 AVM in Normal
overload mode (110% overtorque)

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation


Iout (%)
HO

110%
100%

B1
B2

80%

130BA404.10

6 6

Product Specifications

45C
60%

55C

B3
B4

60%

45 C
o

50 C

40%
20%
0

20%
fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.10 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosure Types B1 and B2, using SFAVM in High overload
mode (160% overtorque)

82

110%
100%
90%
80%

50C

40%

130BB832.10

lout(%)
NO

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.13 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


Enclosure Types B3 and B4, using SFAVM in Normal
overload mode (110% overtorque)

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Product Specifications

Design Guide

130BB820.10

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B1 & B2

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B1 & B2

60%

45 C

60%

45 C
50 C

40%

50 C

40%

20%

20%
0

130BB826.10

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation

Enclosures B, T6
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation

fsw (kHz)
0

10

fsw (kHz)
0

6 6

10

Figure 6.16 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable
frequency drives, enclosure type B; SFAVM, NO

Figure 6.14 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B1 & B2

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

B1 & B2

45 C

60%

50 C

40%

45 C

60%

50 C

40%
20%

20%
0

130BB824.10

130BB822.10

frequency drives, enclosure type B, 60 AVM, NO

fsw (kHz)
0

10

Figure 6.15 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable

fsw (kHz)
0

10

Figure 6.17 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable
frequency drives, enclosure type B; SFAVM, HO

frequency drives, enclosure type B, 60 AVM, HO

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

83

Product Specifications

Design Guide

6.2.6.3 Derating for Ambient Temperature,


Enclosure Types C
Enclosures C, T2, T4 and T5
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation

34
30.6
27.2

45C

110%
100%

20.4

50C

80%

13.6

55C

Iout (%)
HO
C1 & C2
45C

60%

50C

40%
20%

fsw (kHz)
1

10

Figure 6.18 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for enclosure types B2

130BB212.10

100
90
80
70
60

all options

20

55C

10

12

14

16

Iout (%)
NO

110%
100%

C1 & C2

80%
60%

45C
50C
55C

40%

50C

20%

45C

40

Figure 6.20 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation


B2

enclosure types C1 and C2, using 60 AVM in High


overload mode (160% overtorque)

and B4, 60 AVM. Note: The graph is drawn with the


current as absolute value and is valid for both high and
normal overload.

Iout (A)

fsw (kHz)
0

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.21 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


fsw (kHz)
1

enclosure types C1 and C2, using 60 AVM in Normal


overload mode (110% overtorque)

10

Figure 6.19 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for enclosure types B2
and B4, SFAVM. Note: The graph is drawn with the current
as absolute value and is valid for both high and normal
overload.

110%
100%
90%
80%

lout(%)
HO
C3 & C4

130BB831.10

6 6

55C

130BA397.10

all options

130BA398.10

B2

Iout (A)

130BB211.10

Enclosures B, T7
Enclosures B2 and B4, 525690 V
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation

45 C

60%

50 C

40%
20%

fsw (kHz)
2

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.22 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


enclosure types C3 and C4, using 60 AVM in High overload
mode (160% overtorque)

84

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

C3 & C4

130BB835.10

Design Guide

130BB829.10

Product Specifications

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

C3 & C4

45 C

60%

45 C

60%

50 C

50 C

40%

40%

55 C

20%

20%
fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

16

14

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.23 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

Figure 6.26 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

enclosure types C3 and C4, using 60 AVM in Normal


overload mode (110% overtorque)

enclosure types C3 and C4, using SFAVM in High overload


mode (160% overtorque)

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation


110%
100%

130BA400.10

Iout (%)
HO
C1 & C2

80%
45C

60%

C3 & C4

50C

60%

55C

40%

45 C
o

50 C

40%

20%
0

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

6 6
130BB833.10

fsw (kHz)
0

10

12

14

20%

16

fsw (kHz)

Figure 6.24 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

enclosure types C1 and C2, using SFAVM in High


overload mode (160% overtorque)

10

12

14

16

C1 & C2

130BA399.10

Figure 6.27 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for

Iout (%)
NO

110%
100%

enclosure types C3 and C4, using SFAVM in Normal overload


mode (110% overtorque)

80%
60%

45C
50C

40%

55C
20%
0

fsw (kHz)

10

12

14

16

Figure 6.25 Derating of Iout for different TAMB, MAX for


enclosure types C1 and C2, using SFAVM in Normal
overload mode (110% overtorque)

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

85

Product Specifications

Design Guide

130BB821.10

110%
100%
90%
80%

lout(%)
NO

C1 & C2

45 C
o

50 C

40%

50 C
40%

20%

20%

fsw (kHz)
0

C1 & C2

60%

lout(%)
NO

110%
100%
90%
80%

45 C

60%

6 6

130BB827.10

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation

Enclosure Types C, T6
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation

10

fsw (kHz)
0

10

Figure 6.30 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable
frequency drives, enclosure types C; SFAVM, NO

Figure 6.28 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

C1 & C2
o

45 C

lout(%)
HO

110%
100%
90%
80%

C1 & C2
o

45 C

60%
o

60%

50 C

50 C

40%

40%

20%

20%
0

130BB825.10

130BB823.10

frequency drives, enclosure type C, 60 AVM, NO

fsw (kHz)
0

10

Figure 6.29 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable

fsw (kHz)
0

10

Figure 6.31 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for 600 V adjustable
frequency drives, enclosure types C; SFAVM, HO

frequency drives, enclosure types C, 60 AVM, HO

86

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Product Specifications

6.2.7 Measured Values for dU/dt Testing

Iout (A)

C2

all options

34
28.9
27.2

45C

20.4

50C

13.6

55C

130BB213.11

Enclosure Type C, T7
60 AVM - Pulse Width Modulation

To avoid damage to motors without phase insulation


paper or other insulation reinforcement designed for
operation of the adjustable frequency drive, it is strongly
recommend to install a dU/dt filter or LC filter on the
output of the adjustable frequency drive.
When a transistor in the inverter bridge switches, the
voltage across the motor increases by a dU/dt ratio
depending on:

fsw (kHz)
1

10

Figure 6.32 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for enclosure type C2,

all options

100
86.6
80
66.6
60

45C

40

50C

20

55C

130BB214.10

SFAVM - Stator Frequency Asyncron Vector Modulation


C2

With short motor cables (several feet or meters), the rise


time and peak voltage are lower. The rise time and peak
voltage increase with cable length (330 ft [100 m]).

200240 V (T2)

10

130BD597.10

Figure 6.33 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for enclosure type C2,
SFAVM. Note: The graph is drawn with the current as absolute
value and is valid for both high and normal overload.

Iout (%)

110%
100%

Peak voltage on the motor terminals is caused by the


switching of the IGBTs. The rise time and the peak voltage
affect the service life of the motor. If the peak voltage is
too high, motors without phase coil insulation can be
adversely affected over time.

The adjustable frequency drive complies with IEC 60034-25


and IEC 60034-17 for motor design.

fsw (kHz)
1

Motor cable (type, cross-section, length, shielded,


or non-shielded)

The natural induction causes an overshoot voltage peak in


the motor voltage before it stabilizes. The level depends
on the voltage in the DC link.

60 AVM. Note: The graph is drawn with the current as


absolute value and is valid for both high and normal
overload.

Iout (A)

Motor inductance

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

240

0.13

0.510

3.090

50

240

0.23

100

240

0.54

0.580

0.865

150

240

0.66

0.560

0.674

[kV/s]
2.034

Table 6.13 P5K5T2

60%

ILOAD at TAMB max

Cable
length
[m]

40%

ILOAD at TAMB max +5 C

36

240

0.264

0.624

1.890

ILOAD at TAMB max +5 C

136

240

0.536

0.596

0.889

150

240

0.568

0.568

0.800

80%

20%
0

fsw (kHz)
0

10

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

[kV/s]

Table 6.14 P7K5T2

Figure 6.34 Output current derating with switching


frequency and ambient temperature for enclosure type C3

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

87

6 6

6 6

Design Guide

Product Specifications

380500 V (T4)

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

30

dU/dt

[s]

Upeak
[kV]

240

0.556

0.650

0.935

100

240

0.592

0.594

0.802

150

240

0.708

0.587

0.663

[kV/s]

Table 6.15 P11KT2

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

480

0.640

0.690

0.862

50

480

0.470

0.985

0.985

150

480

0.760

1.045

0.947

[kV/s]

Table 6.21 P1K5T4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

240

0.244

0.608

1.993

136

240

0.568

0.580

0.816

150

240

0.720

0.574

0.637

[kV/s]

Table 6.16 P15KT2

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

480

0.172

0.890

4.156

50

480

0.310

150

480

0.370

1.190

1.770

[kV/s]
2.564

Table 6.22 P4K0T4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

240

0.244

0.608

1.993

136

240

0.568

0.580

0.816

150

240

0.720

0.574

0.637

[kV/s]

Table 6.17 P18KT2

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

480

0.04755

0.739

8.035

50

480

0.207

150

480

0.6742

1.030

2.828

[kV/s]
4.548

Table 6.23 P7K5T4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

15

dU/dt

[s]

Upeak
[kV]

240

0.194

0.626

2.581

50

240

0.252

0.574

1.822

150

240

0.488

0.538

0.882

[kV/s]

Table 6.18 P22KT2

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

480

0.396

1.210

2.444

100

480

0.844

1.230

1.165

150

480

0.696

1.160

1.333

[kV/s]

Table 6.24 P11KT4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

30

240

0.300

0.598

1.594

100

240

0.536

0.566

0.844

150

240

0.776

0.546

0.562

[kV/s]

Table 6.19 P30KT2

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

480

0.396

1.210

2.444

100

480

0.844

1.230

1.165

150

480

0.696

1.160

1.333

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[kV/s]

Table 6.25 P15KT4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

30

240

0.300

0.598

1.594

100

240

0.536

0.566

0.844

150

240

0.776

0.546

0.562

Table 6.20 P37KT2

Cable
length
[m]

[kV/s]

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

36

480

0.312

100

480

0.556

1.250

1.798

150

480

0.608

1.230

1.618

[s]

[kV/s]
2.846

Table 6.26 P18KT4

88

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Product Specifications

600 V (T6)

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

15

480

0.288

100

480

0.492

1.230

2.000

150

480

0.468

1.190

2.034

[s]

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt
[kV/s]
3.083

Table 6.27 P22KT4


Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

480

50

dU/dt

[s]

Upeak
[kV]

0.368

1.270

2.853

480

0.536

1.260

1.978

100

480

0.680

1.240

1.426

150

480

0.712

1.200

1.334

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

480

0.368

1.270

2.853

50

480

0.536

1.260

1.978

100

480

0.680

1.240

0.712

1.200

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

600

0.304

1.560

4.105

50

600

0.300

1.550

4.133

100

600

0.536

1.640

2.448

150

600

0.576

1.640

2.278

[kV/s]

[kV/s]

Cable
length
[m]

480

AC line
voltage
[V]

Table 6.33 P15KT6

Table 6.28 P30KT4

150

Cable
length
[m]

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

36

600

0.084

1.560

7.962

50

600

0.120

1.540

5.467

100

600

0.165

1.472

3.976

150

600

0.190

1.530

3.432

6 6

[kV/s]

Table 6.34 P30KT6

[kV/s]
AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time
[s]

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

1.426

Cable
length
[m]

1.334

15

600

0.276

1.184

4.290

[kV/s]

Table 6.35 P75KT6

Table 6.29 P37KT4

525690 V (T7)

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

15

480

0.256

1.230

3.847

50

480

0.328

1.200

2.957

100

480

0.456

1.200

2.127

150

480

0.960

1.150

1.052

[kV/s]

Table 6.30 P45KT4

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

80

690

0.58

1.728

2369

130

690

0.93

1.824

1569

180

690

0.925

1.818

1570

[kV/s]

Table 6.36 P7K5T7

380500 V (T5)

dU/dt

[s]

Upeak
[kV]

Cable
length
[m]

[kV/s]

690

0.238

1416

4739

0.371

1.170

2.523

50

690

0.358

1764

3922

150

690

0.465

1872

3252

Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

480

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

[kV/s]

Table 6.31 P55KT5


Table 6.37 P45KT7
Cable
length
[m]

AC line
voltage
[V]

Rise time

Upeak
[kV]

dU/dt

[s]

480

0.371

1.170

2.523

[kV/s]

Table 6.32 P75KT5

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

89

6.2.8 Efficiency
Efficiency of the adjustable frequency drive
The load on the adjustable frequency drive has little effect
on its efficiency.

The influence from the U/f characteristic on small


motors is marginal. However, in motors from
15 hp [11 kW] and up, the efficiency advantage is
significant.

The switching frequency does not affect the


efficiency of small motors. Motors from 15 hp [11
kW] and up have their efficiency improved 12%.
This is because the sine shape of the motor
current is almost perfect at high switching
frequency.

This also means that the adjustable frequency drive


efficiency does not change when other U/f characteristics
are chosen. However, the U/f characteristics do influence
the efficiency of the motor.
The efficiency declines a little when the switching
frequency is set to a value above 5 kHz. The efficiency is
also slightly reduced when the motor cable is longer than
100 ft [30 m].
Efficiency calculation
Calculate the efficiency of the adjustable frequency drive at
different loads based on Figure 6.35. Multiply the factor in
this graph with the specific efficiency factor listed in
chapter 6.2 General Specifications.
130BB252.11

1.01
1.0
Relative Efficiency

6 6

Design Guide

Product Specifications

0.99
0.98
0.97
0.96
0.95

System efficiency
To calculate the system efficiency, the efficiency of the
adjustable frequency drive is multiplied by the efficiency of
the motor.

6.2.9 Acoustic Noise


Acoustic noise from the adjustable frequency drive comes
from three sources

DC link (intermediate circuit) coils


RFI filter choke
Internal fans

See Table 6.38 for acoustic noise ratings.

0.94
0.93
0.92

0%

50%
100% load

100%
% Speed
75% load

150%
50% load

Enclosure type

50% fan speed


[dBA]

Full fan speed


[dBA]

A1

51

60

200%
25% load

Figure 6.35 Typical Efficiency Curves

Example: Assume a 75 hp [55 kW], 380480 V AC


adjustable frequency drive with 25% load at 50% speed.
The graph is showing 0.97 rated efficiency for a 75 hp
[55 kW] adjustable frequency drive is 0.98. The actual
efficiency is then: 0.97 x 0.98=0.95.
Motor efficiency
The efficiency of a motor connected to the adjustable
frequency drive depends on magnetizing level. The
efficiency of the motor depends on the type of motor.

90

In the range of 75100% of the rated torque, the


efficiency of the motor is practically constant,
both when it is controlled by the adjustable
frequency drive, and when it runs directly on line
power.

A2

51

60

A3

51

60

A4

51

60

A5

54

63

B1

61

67

B2

58

70

B4

52

62

C1

52

62

C2

55

65

C4

56

71

D3h

58

71

Table 6.38 Acoustic Noise Ratings


Values are measured 3.3 ft [1 m] from the unit.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

7 How to Order

10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39

130BB836.10

7.1 Drive Configurator

Figure 7.1 Type Code Example

Configure the right adjustable frequency drive for the right application from the Internet based Drive Configurator and
generate the type code string. The Drive Configurator automatically generates an 8-digit sales number to be delivered to
the local sales office.
Furthermore, it is possible to establish a project list with several products and send it to a Danfoss sales representative.

7 7

The Drive Configurator can be found on the global Internet site: www.danfoss.com/drives.

7.1.1 Type Code


An example of the type code is:
FC-302PK75T5E20H1BGCXXXSXXXXA0BXCXXXXD0
The meaning of the characters in the string can be found in Table 7.1 and Table 7.2. In the example above, a Profibus DP V1
and a 24 V backup option is built-in.
Description

Pos

Possible choices

Product group 1-3

FC 30x

Drive series

4-6

301: FC 301
302: FC 302

Power rating

8-10

0.2575 kW

Phases

11

Three phases (T)

AC line
voltage

11-12

T2:
T4:
T5:
T6:
T7:

Enclosure

13-15

E20: IP20
E55: IP 55/NEMA Type 12
P20: IP20 (with backplate)
P21: IP21/ NEMA Type 1 (with backplate)
P55: IP55/ NEMA Type 12 (with backplate)

200240
380480
380500
525600
525690

V
V
V
V
V

Z20: IP 201)
E66: IP 66

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

91

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

Description

Pos

Possible choices

RFI filter

16-17

Hx: No EMC filters built in the adjustable frequency drive (600 V units only)
H1: Integrated EMC filter. Fulfill EN 55011 Class A1/B and EN/IEC 61800-3 Category 1/2
H2: No additional EMC filter. Fulfill EN 55011 Class A2 and EN/IEC 61800-3 Category 3
H3:
H3 - Integrated EMC filter. Fulfil EN 55011 class A1/B and EN/IEC 61800-3 Category 1/2
(Enclosure type A1 only)1)
H4: Integrated EMC filter. Fulfill EN 55011 class A1 and EN/IEC 61800-3 Category 2
H5: Marine versions. Fulfill same emissions levels as H2 versions

Brake

18

B: Brake chopper included


X: No brake chopper included
T: Safe Stop No brake1)
U: Safe stop brake chopper1)

Display

19

G: Graphical Local Control Panel (LCP)


N: Numerical Local Control Panel (LCP)
X: No Local Control Panel

Coating PCB

20

C: Coated PCB
R: Ruggedized
X: No coated PCB

Line power
option

21

X: No line power option


1: Line power disconnect
3: Line power disconnect and Fuse2)
5: Line power disconnect, fuse and load sharing2,3)
7: Fuse2)
8: Line power disconnect and load sharing3)
A: Fuse and load sharing 2,3)
D: Load sharing3)

Adaptation

22

X: Standard cable entries


O: European metric thread in cable entries (A4, A5, B1, B2, C1, C2 only)
S: Imperial cable entries (A5, B1, B2, C1 and C2 only)

Adaptation

23

X: No adaptation

Software

24-27

SXXX: Latest release - standard software

28

X: Not used

release
Software
language
1):

FC 301/enclosure type A1 only

2)

US Market only

3):

A and B3 frames have load sharing built-in by default

Table 7.1 Ordering Type Code Enclosure types A, B and C

92

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

Description

Pos

Possible choices

A options

29-30

AX: No A option
A0: MCA 101 Profibus DP V1 (standard)
A4: MCA 104 DeviceNet (standard)
A6: CANOpen MCA 105 (standard)
AN: MCA 121 Ethernet IP
AL: MCA 120 ProfiNet
AQ: MCA 122 Modbus TCP
AT: MCA 113 Profibus Drive VLT 3000
AU: MCA 114 Profibus Drive VLT 5000
AY: MCA 123 Powerlink
A8: MCA 124 EtherCAT

B options

31-32

BX: No option
BK: MCB 101 General purpose I/O option
BR: MCB 102 Encoder option
BU: MCB 103 Resolver option
BP: MCB 105 Relay option
BZ: MCB 108 Safety PLC Interface
B2: MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card
B4: MCB 114 VLT Sensor Input
B6: MCB 150 Safe Option TTL
B7: MCB 151 Safe Option HTL

C0 options

33-34

CX: No option
C4: MCO 305, Programmable Motion Controller

C1 options

35

X: No option
R: MCB 113 Ext. Relay Card
Z: MCA 140 Modbus RTU OEM option

C option
software/E1
options

36-37

XX: Standard controller


10: MCO 350 Synchronizing control
11: MCO 351 Positioning control

D options

38-39

DX: No option
D0: MCB 107 Ext. 24 V DC backup

7 7

Table 7.2 Ordering Type Code, Options

NOTICE!
For power sizes over 100 hp [75 kW], see the VLT AutomationDrive FC 300 901400 kW Design Guide.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

93

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

7.1.2 Language
Adjustable Frequency Drives are automatically delivered
with a language package relevant to the region from
which it is ordered. Four regional language packages cover
the following languages:
Language
package 1

Language
package 2

Language
package 3

Language
package 4

English

English

English

English

German

German

German

German

French

Chinese

Slovenian

Spanish

Danish

Korean

Bulgarian

English US

Dutch

Japanese

Serbian

Greek

Spanish

Thai

Romanian

Brazilian
Portuguese

Swedish

Traditional
Chinese

Hungarian

Turkish

Italian

Bahasa
Indonesian

Czech

Polish

Finnish

Russian

Table 7.3 Language Packages

To order adjustable frequency drives with a different


language package, contact the local sales office.

94

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2 Ordering Numbers


7.2.1 Options and Accessories
Description

Ordering no.
Uncoated

Coated

Miscellaneous hardware
VLT Panel through kit enclosure type A5

130B1028

VLT

130B1046

Panel through kit enclosure type B1

VLT Panel through kit enclosure type B2

130B1047

VLT Panel through kit enclosure type C1

130B1048

VLT Panel through kit enclosure type C2

130B1049

VLT Mounting brackets for enclosure type A5

130B1080

VLT Mounting brackets for enclosure type B1

130B1081

VLT

Mounting brackets for enclosure type B2

130B1082

VLT Mounting brackets for enclosure type C1

130B1083

VLT Mounting brackets for enclosure type C2

130B1084

VLT IP 21/Type 1 Kit, enclosure type A1

130B1121

VLT

IP 21/Type 1 Kit, enclosure type A2

130B1122

VLT IP 21/Type 1 Kit, enclosure type A3

130B1123

VLT IP 21/Type 1 Top Kit, enclosure type A2

130B1132

VLT

130B1133

IP 21/Type 1 Top Kit, enclosure type A3

VLT Backplate IP55/Type12, enclosure type A5

130B1098

VLT Backplate IP21/Type 1, IP55/Type 12, enclosure type B1

130B3383

VLT

Backplate IP21/Type 1, IP55/Type 12, enclosure type B2

130B3397

VLT Backplate IP20/Type 1, enclosure type B4

130B4172

VLT Backplate IP21/Type 1, IP55/Type 12, enclosure type C1

130B3910

VLT Backplate IP21/Type 1, IP55/Type 12, enclosure type C2

130B3911

VLT

130B4170

Backplate IP20/Type 1, enclosure type C3

VLT Backplate IP20/Type 1, enclosure type C4

130B4171

VLT Backplate IP66/Type 4X, enclosure type A5

130B3242

VLT Backplate in stainless steel IP66/Type 4X, enclosure type B1

130B3434

VLT Backplate in stainless steel IP66/Type 4X, enclosure type B2

130B3465

VLT Backplate in stainless steel IP66/Type 4X, enclosure type C1

130B3468

VLT

Backplate in stainless steel IP66/Type 4X, enclosure type C2

130B3491

VLT Profibus Adapter Sub-D9 Connector

130B1112

Profibus shield plate kit for IP20, enclosure types A1, A2 and A3

130B0524

Terminal block for DC link connection on enclosure types A2/A3

130B1064

VLT Screw terminals

130B1116

VLT USB extension, 350 mm cable

130B1155

VLT

7 7

USB extension, 650 mm cable

130B1156

VLT Back frame A2 for 1 brake resistor

175U0085

VLT Back frame A3 for 1 brake resistor

175U0088

VLT Back frame A2 for 2 brake resistors

175U0087

VLT Back A3 for 2 brake resistors

175U0086

Local Control Panel


VLT LCP 101 Numeric Local Control Pad

130B1124

VLT LCP 102 Graphical Local Control Pad

130B1107

VLT Cable for LCP 2, 3 m

175Z0929

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

95

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

Description

Ordering no.

VLT

130B1170

Uncoated
Panel Mounting Kit for all LCP types

VLT Panel Mounting Kit, graphical LCP

130B1113

VLT Panel Mounting Kit, numerical LCP

130B1114

VLT LCP Mounting Kit, w/ no LCP

130B1117

VLT LCP Mounting Kit Blind Cover IP55/66, 8 m

130B1129

VLT

130B1078

Control Panel LCP 102, graphical

VLT Blindcover, w/ Danfoss logo, IP55/66

Coated

130B1077

Options for slot A


VLT Profibus DP V1 MCA 101
VLT

130B1100

130B1200

DeviceNet MCA 104

130B1102

130B1202

VLT CAN Open MCA 105

130B1103

130B1205

VLT PROFIBUS Drive MCA 113

130B1245

VLT PROFIBUS Drive MCA 114


VLT

130B1246
130B1135

PROFINET MCA 120

130B1235

VLT EtherNet/IP MCA 121

130B1119

130B1219

VLT Modbus TCP MCA 122

130B1196

130B1296

POWERLINK

130B1489

130B1490

EtherCAT

130B5546

130B5646

VLT DeviceNet MCA 104

130B1102

130B1202

VLT General Purpose I/O MCB 101

130B1125

130B1212

VLT

Options for slot B


Encoder Input MCB 102

130B1115

130B1203

VLT

Resolver Input MCB 103

130B1127

130B1227

VLT

Relay Option MCB 105

130B1110

130B1210

VLT Safe PLC I/O MCB 108

130B1120

130B1220

VLT PTC Thermistor Card MCB 112


VLT
VLT

130B1137

Safe Option MCB 140

130B6443

Safe Option MCB 141

130B6447

VLT Safe option MCB 150

130B3280

VLT Safe option MCB 151

130B3290

Mounting Kits for C options


VLT Mounting Kit for C Option, 40 mm, enclosure types A2/A3

130B7530

VLT Mounting Kit for C Option, 60 mm, enclosure types A2/A3

130B7531

VLT Mounting Kit for C Option, enclosure type A5

130B7532

VLT

Mounting Kit for C Option, enclosure types B/C/D/E/F (except B3)

130B7533

VLT Mounting Kit for C Option, 40 mm, enclosure type B3

130B1413

VLT Mounting Kit for C Option, 60 mm, enclosure type B3

130B1414

Options for Slot C


VLT Motion Control MCO 305
VLT

130B1134

130B1234

130B1152

130B1252

VLT Position. Controller MCO 351

130B1153

120B1253

Center Winder Controller

130B1165

130B1166

VLT

130B1164

Synchronizing Contr. MCO 350

Extended Relay Card MCB 113

VLT C Option Adapter MCF 106

130B1264
130B1230

Option for Slot D


VLT 24 V DC Supply MCB 107

96

130B1108

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

130B1208

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

Description

Ordering no.

VLT

175N2584

Uncoated
EtherNet/IP MCA 121

VLT Leakage Current Monitor Kit, enclosure types A2/A3

130B5645

VLT Leakage Current Monitor Kit, enclosure type B3

130B5764

VLT Leakage Current Monitor Kit, enclosure type B4

130B5765

VLT Leakage Current Monitor Kit, enclosure type C3

130B6226

VLT

130B5647

Leakage Current Monitor Kit, enclosure type C4

Coated

PC Software
VLT Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 1 license

130B1000

VLT

130B1001

Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 5 licenses

VLT Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 10 licenses

130B1002

VLT Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 25 licenses

130B1003

VLT Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 50 licenses

130B1004

VLT Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, 100 licenses

130B1005

VLT

130B1006

Motion Ctrl Tool MCT 10, >100 licenses

7 7

Options can be ordered as factory built-in options, see ordering information, chapter 7.1 Drive Configurator.
Table 7.4 Ordering Numbers for Options and Accessories

7.2.2 Spare Parts


Consult the VLT shop or the configurator for spare parts available for your specification, VLTShop.danfoss.com.

7.2.3 Accessory Bags


Type

Description

Ordering no.

Accessory Bags
Accessory bag A1

Accessory bag, enclosure type A1

130B1021

Accessory bag A2/A3

Accessory bag, enclosure type A2/A3

130B1022

Accessory bag A5

Accessory bag, enclosure type A5

130B1023

Accessory bag A1A5

Accessory bag, enclosure type A1-A5 Brake and load sharing connector

130B0633

Accessory bag B1

Accessory bag, enclosure type B1

130B2060

Accessory bag B2

Accessory bag, enclosure type B2

130B2061

Accessory bag B3

Accessory bag, enclosure type B3

130B0980

Accessory bag B4

Accessory bag, enclosure type B4, 18.522 kW

130B1300

Accessory bag B4

Accessory bag, enclosure type B4, 30 kW

130B1301

Accessory bag C1

Accessory bag, enclosure type C1

130B0046

Accessory bag C2

Accessory bag, enclosure type C2

130B0047

Accessory bag C3

Accessory bag, enclosure type C3

130B0981

Accessory bag C4

Accessory bag, enclosure type C4, 55 kW

130B0982

Accessory bag C4

Accessory bag, enclosure type C4, 75 kW

130B0983

Table 7.5 Ordering Numbers for Accessory Bags

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

97

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2.4 VLT AutomationDrive FC 301


T2, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle
FC 301

Horizontal braking 10% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Line
power
type

7 7

Pm

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Cable
crosssection

Thermo
relay
[A]

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

175u3004

1.5

0.5

0.100

175u3006

1.5

0.6

200

0.100

175u3011

1.5

0.7

138.4

145

0.100

175u3016

1.5

0.8

81.0

92.0

100

0.100

175u3021

1.5

0.9

58.5

66.5

70

0.200

175u3026

1.5

1.6

3 [2.2]

40.2

44.6

48

0.200

175u3031

1.5

1.9

T2

4 [3]

29.1

32.3

35

0.300

175u3325

1.5

2.7

T2

5 [3.7]

22.5

25.9

27

0.360

175u3326

175u3477

175u3478

1.5

3.5

T2

7.5 [5.5]

17.7

19.7

18

0.570

175u3327

175u3442

175u3441

1.5

5.3

T2

10 [7.5]

12.6

14.3

13

0.680

175u3328

175u3059

175u3060

1.5

6.8

T2

15 [11]

8.7

9.7

1.130

175u3329

175u3068

175u3069

2.5

10.5

T2

20 [15]

5.3

7.5

5.7

1.400

175u3330

175u3073

175u3074

15

T2

25 [18.5]

5.1

6.0

5.7

1.700

175u3331

175u3483

175u3484

16

T2

30 [22]

3.2

5.0

3.5

2.200

175u3332

175u3080

175u3081

24

T2

40 [30]

3.0

3.7

3.5

2.800

175u3333

175u3448

175u3447

10

27

T2

50 [37]

2.4

3.0

2.8

3.200

175u3334

175u3086

175u3087

16

32

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

T2

0.34
[0.25]

368

415.9

410

0.100

T2

0.5
[0.37]

248

280.7

300

T2

0.75
[0.55]

166

188.7

T2

1.0
[0.75]

121

T2

1.5 [1.1]

T2

2 [1.5]

T2

(hp
[kW])

Wire IP54

[mm2]

Table 7.6 T2, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle

98

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 301

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T2

0.37
[0.25]

368

415.9

410

0.100

175u3004

1.5

0.5

T2

0.5 [0.37]

248

280.7

300

0.200

175u3096

1.5

0.8

T2

0.75
[0.55]

166

188.7

200

0.200

175u3008

1.5

0.9

T2

1.0 [0.75]

121

138.4

145

0.300

175u3300

1.5

1.3

T2

1.5 [1.1]

81.0

92.0

100

0.450

175u3301

175u3402

175u3401

1.5

T2

2 [1.5]

58.5

66.5

70

0.570

175u3302

175u3404

175u3403

1.5

2.7

T2

3 [2.2]

40.2

44.6

48

0.960

175u3303

175u3406

175u3405

1.5

4.2

T2

4 [3]

29.1

32.3

35

1.130

175u3304

175u3408

175u3407

1.5

5.4

T2

5 [3.7]

22.5

25.9

27

1.400

175u3305

175u3410

175u3409

1.5

6.8

T2

7.5 [5.5]

17.7

19.7

18

2.200

175u3306

175u3412

175u3411

1.5

10.4

T2

10 [7.5]

12.6

14.3

13

3.200

175u3307

175u3414

175u3413

2.5

14.7

T2

15 [11]

8.7

9.7

5.500

175u3176

175u3177

23

T2

20 [15]

5.3

7.5

5.7

6.000

175u3233

10

33

T2

25 [18.5]

5.1

6.0

5.7

8.000

175u3234

10

38

T2

30 [22]

3.2

5.0

3.5

9.000

175u3235

16

51

T2

40 [30]

3.0

3.7

3.5

14.000

175u3224

25

63

T2

50 [37]

2.4

3.0

2.8

17.000

175u3227

35

78

7 7

Table 7.7 T2, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

99

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 301

Horizontal braking 10% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Line
power
type

Pm
(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T4

0.5
[0.37]

1000

1121.4

1200

0.100

175u3000

1.5

0.3

T4

0.75
[0.55]

620

749.8

850

0.100

175u3001

1.5

0.4

T4

1.0
[0.75]

485

547.6

630

0.100

175u3002

1.5

0.4

T4

1.5 [1.1]

329

365.3

410

0.100

175u3004

1.5

0.5

T4

2 [1.5]

240

263.0

270

0.200

175u3007

1.5

0.8

T4

3 [2.2]

161

176.5

200

0.200

175u3008

1.5

0.9

T4

4 [3]

117

127.9

145

0.300

175u3300

1.5

1.3

T4

5 [4]

86.9

94.6

110

0.450

175u3335

175u3450

175u3449

1.5

1.9

T4

7.5 [5.5]

62.5

68.2

80

0.570

175u3336

175u3452

175u3451

1.5

2.5

T4

10 [7.5]

45.3

49.6

56

0.680

175u3337

175u3027

175u3028

1.5

3.3

T4

15 [11]

34.9

38.0

38

1.130

175u3338

175u3034

175u3035

1.5

5.2

T4

20 [15]

25.3

27.7

28

1.400

175u3339

175u3039

175u3040

1.5

6.7

T4

25 [18.5]

20.3

22.3

22

1.700

175u3340

175u3047

175u3048

1.5

8.3

T4

30 [22]

16.9

18.7

19

2.200

175u3357

175u3049

175u3050

1.5

10.1

T4

40 [30]

13.2

14.5

14

2.800

175u3341

175u3055

175u3056

2.5

13.3

T4

50 [37]

10.6

11.7

12

3.200

175u3359

175u3061

175u3062

2.5

15.3

T4

60 [45]

8.7

9.6

9.5

4.200

175u3065

175u3066

20

T4

75 [55]

6.6

7.8

7.0

5.500

175u3070

175u3071

26

T4

100 [75]

4.2

5.7

5.5

7.000

175u3231

10

36

Table 7.8 T4, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle

100

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 301

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

T4

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection

Thermo
relay
[A]

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

0.5 [0.37]

1000

1121.4

1200

0.200

175u3101

1.5

0.4

T4

0.75
[0.55]

620

749.8

850

0.200

175u3308

1.5

0.5

T4

1.0 [0.75]

485

547.6

630

0.300

175u3309

1.5

0.7

T4

1.5 [1.1]

329

365.3

410

0.450

175u3310

175u3416

175u3415

1.5

T4

2 [1.5]

240

263.0

270

0.570

175u3311

175u3418

175u3417

1.5

1.4

T4

3 [2.2]

161

176.5

200

0.960

175u3312

175u3420

175u3419

1.5

2.1

T4

4 [3]

117

127.9

145

1.130

175u3313

175u3422

175u3421

1.5

2.7

T4

5 [4]

86.9

94.6

110

1.700

175u3314

175u3424

175u3423

1.5

3.7

T4

7.5 [5.5]

62.5

68.2

80

2.200

175u3315

175u3138

175u3139

1.5

T4

10 [7.5]

45.3

49.6

56

3.200

175u3316

175u3428

175u3427

1.5

7.1

Wire IP54

[mm2]

T4

15 [11]

34.9

38.0

38

5.000

175u3236

1.5

11.5

T4

20 [15]

25.3

27.7

28

6.000

175u3237

2.5

14.7

T4

25 [18.5]

20.3

22.3

22

8.000

175u3238

19

T4

30 [22]

16.9

18.7

19

10.000

175u3203

23

T4

40 [30]

13.2

14.5

14

14.000

175u3206

10

32

T4

50 [37]

10.6

11.7

12

17.000

175u3210

10

38

T4

60 [45]

8.7

9.6

9.5

21.000

175u3213

16

47

T4

75 [55]

6.6

7.8

7.0

26.000

175u3216

25

61

T4

100 [75]

4.2

5.7

5.5

36.000

175u3219

35

81

7 7

Table 7.9 T4, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

101

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2.5 Brake Resistors for FC 302


FC 302

Horizontal braking 10% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Line
power
type

Pm

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Cable
crosssection

Thermo
relay
[A]

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

175u3004

1.5

0.5

0.100

175u3006

1.5

0.6

200

0.100

175u3011

1.5

0.7

158.1

145

0.100

175u3016

1.5

0.8

81.0

105.1

100

0.100

175u3021

1.5

0.9

58.5

76.0

70

0.200

175u3026

1.5

1.6

3 [2.2]

45.0

51.0

48

0.200

175u3031

1.5

1.9

T2

4 [3]

31.5

37.0

35

0.300

175u3325

1.5

2.7

T2

5 [3.7]

22.5

29.7

27

0.360

175u3326

175u3477

175u3478

1.5

3.5

T2

7.5 [5.5]

17.7

19.7

18

0.570

175u3327

175u3442

175u3441

1.5

5.3

T2

10 [7.5]

12.6

14.3

13.0

0.680

175u3328

175u3059

175u3060

1.5

6.8

T2

15 [11]

8.7

9.7

9.0

1.130

175u3329

175u3068

175u3069

2.5

10.5

T2

20 [15]

5.3

7.5

5.7

1.400

175u3330

175u3073

175u3074

14.7

T2

25 [18.5]

5.1

6.0

5.7

1.700

175u3331

175u3483

175u3484

16

T2

30 [22]

3.2

5.0

3.5

2.200

175u3332

175u3080

175u3081

24

T2

40 [30]

3.0

3.7

3.5

2.800

175u3333

175u3448

175u3447

10

27

T2

50 [37]

2.4

3.0

2.8

3.200

175u3334

175u3086

175u3087

16

32

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

T2

0.34
[0.25]

380

475.3

410

0.100

T2

0.5
[0.37]

275

320.8

300

T2

0.75
[0.55]

188

215.7

T2

1.0
[0.75]

130

T2

1.5 [1.1]

T2

2 [1.5]

T2

(hp
[kW])

Wire IP54

[mm2]

Table 7.10 T2, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle

102

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 302

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T2

0.34
[0.25]

380

475.3

410

0.100

175u3004

1.5

0.5

T2

0.5
[0.37]

275

320.8

300

0.200

175u3096

1.5

0.8

T2

0.75
[0.55]

188

215.7

200

0.200

175u3008

1.5

0.9

T2

1.0
[0.75]

130

158.1

145

0.300

175u3300

1.5

1.3

T2

1.5 [1.1]

81.0

105.1

100

0.450

175u3301

175u3402

175u3401

1.5

T2

2 [1.5]

58.5

76.0

70

0.570

175u3302

175u3404

175u3403

1.5

2.7

T2

3 [2.2]

45.0

51.0

48

0.960

175u3303

175u3406

175u3405

1.5

4.2

T2

4 [3]

31.5

37.0

35

1.130

175u3304

175u3408

175u3407

1.5

5.4

T2

5 [3.7]

22.5

29.7

27

1.400

175u3305

175u3410

175u3409

1.5

6.8

T2

7.5 [5.5]

17.7

19.7

18

2.200

175u3306

175u3412

175u3411

1.5

10.4

T2

10 [7.5]

12.6

14.3

13.0

3.200

175u3307

175u3414

175u3413

2.5

14.7

T2

15 [11]

8.7

9.7

9.0

5.500

175u3176

175u3177

23

T2

20 [15]

5.3

7.5

5.7

6.000

175u3233

10

33

T2

25 [18.5]

5.1

6.0

5.7

8.000

175u3234

10

38

T2

30 [22]

3.2

5.0

3.5

9.000

175u3235

16

51

T2

40 [30]

3.0

3.7

3.5

14.000

175u3224

25

63

T2

50 [37]

2.4

3.0

2.8

17.000

175u3227

35

78

7 7

Table 7.11 T2, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

103

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 302

Horizontal braking 10% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Line
power
type

Pm
(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T5

0.5
[0.37]

1000

1389.2

1200

0.100

175u3000

1.5

0.3

T5

0.75
[0.55]

620

928.8

850

0.100

175u3001

1.5

0.4

T5

1.0
[0.75]

558

678.3

630

0.100

175u3002

1.5

0.4

T5

1.5 [1.1]

382

452.5

410

0.100

175u3004

1.5

0.5

T5

2 [1.5]

260

325.9

270

0.200

175u3007

1.5

0.8

T5

3 [2.2]

189

218.6

200

0.200

175u3008

1.5

0.9

T5

4 [3]

135

158.5

145

0.300

175u3300

1.5

1.3

T5

5 [4]

99.0

117.2

110

0.450

175u3335

175u3450

175u3449

1.5

1.9

T5

7.5 [5.5]

72.0

84.4

80

0.570

175u3336

175u3452

175u3451

1.5

2.5

T5

10 [7.5]

50.0

61.4

56

0.680

175u3337

175u3027

175u3028

1.5

3.3

T5

15 [11]

36.0

41.2

38

1.130

175u3338

175u3034

175u3035

1.5

5.2

T5

20 [15]

27.0

30.0

28

1.400

175u3339

175u3039

175u3040

1.5

6.7

T5

25 [18.5]

20.3

24.2

22

1.700

175u3340

175u3047

175u3048

1.5

8.3

T5

30 [22]

18.0

20.3

19

2.200

175u3357

175u3049

175u3050

1.5

10.1

T5

40 [30]

13.4

15.8

14

2.800

175u3341

175u3055

175u3056

2.5

13.3

T5

50 [37]

10.8

12.7

12

3.200

175u3359

175u3061

175u3062

2.5

15.3

T5

60 [45]

8.8

10.4

9.5

4.200

175u3065

175u3066

20

T5

75 [55]

6.5

8.5

7.0

5.500

175u3070

175u3071

26

T5

100 [75]

4.2

6.2

5.5

7.000

175u3231

10

36

Table 7.12 T5, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle

104

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 302

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T5

0.5
[0.37]

1000

1389.2

1200

0.200

175u3101

1.5

0.4

T5

0.75
[0.55]

620

928.8

850

0.200

175u3308

1.5

0.5

T5

1.0
[0.75]

558

678.3

630

0.300

175u3309

1.5

0.7

T5

1.5 [1.1]

382

452.5

410

0.450

175u3310

175u3416

175u3415

1.5

T5

2 [1.5]

260

325.9

270

0.570

175u3311

175u3418

175u3417

1.5

1.4

T5

3 [2.2]

189

218.6

200

0.960

175u3312

175u3420

175u3419

1.5

2.1

T5

4 [3]

135

158.5

145

1.130

175u3313

175u3422

175u3421

1.5

2.7

T5

5 [4]

99.0

117.2

110

1.700

175u3314

175u3424

175u3423

1.5

3.7

T5

7.5 [5.5]

72.0

84.4

80

2.200

175u3315

175u3138

175u3139

1.5

T5

10 [7.5]

50.0

61.4

56

3.200

175u3316

175u3428

175u3427

1.5

7.1

T5

15 [11]

36.0

41.2

38

5.000

175u3236

1.5

11.5

T5

20 [15]

27.0

30.0

28

6.000

175u3237

2.5

14.7

T5

25 [18.5]

20.3

24.2

22

8.000

175u3238

19

T5

30 [22]

18.0

20.3

19

10.000

175u3203

23

T5

40 [30]

13.4

15.8

14

14.000

175u3206

10

32

T5

50 [37]

10.8

12.7

12

17.000

175u3210

10

38

T5

60 [45]

8.8

10.4

9.5

21.000

175u3213

16

47

T5

75 [55]

6.5

8.5

7.0

26.000

175u3216

25

61

T5

100 [75]

4.2

6.2

5.5

36.000

175u3219

35

81

7 7

Table 7.13 T5, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

105

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 302

Horizontal braking 10% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Line
power
type

Pm
(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

620

914.2

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T6

1.0
[0.75]

T6

1.5 [1.1]

550

611.3

570

0.100

175u3003

1.5

0.4

T6

2 [1.5]

380

441.9

415

0.200

175u3005

1.5

0.7

T6

3 [2.2]

260

296.4

270

0.200

175u3007

1.5

0.8

T6

4 [3]

189

214.8

200

0.300

175u3342

1.5

1.1

T6

5 [4]

135

159.2

145

0.450

175u3343

175u3012

175u3013

1.5

1.7

T6

7.5 [5.5]

99.0

114.5

100

0.570

175u3344

175u3136

175u3137

1.5

2.3

T6

10 [7.5]

69.0

83.2

72

0.680

175u3345

175u3456

175u3455

1.5

2.9

T6

15 [11]

48.6

56.1

52

1.130

175u3346

175u3458

175u3457

1.5

4.4

T6

20 [15]

35.1

40.8

38

1.400

175u3347

175u3460

175u3459

1.5

5.7

T6

25 [18.5]

27.0

32.9

31

1.700

175u3348

175u3037

175u3038

1.5

T6

30 [22]

22.5

27.6

27

2.200

175u3349

175u3043

175u3044

1.5

8.5

T6

40 [30]

17.1

21.4

19

2.800

175u3350

175u3462

175u3461

2.5

11.4

T6

50 [37]

13.5

17.3

14

3.200

175u3358

175u3464

175u3463

2.5

14.2

T6

60 [45]

10.8

14.2

13.5

4.200

175u3057

175u3058

17

T6

75 [55]

8.8

11.6

11

5.500

175u3063

175u3064

21

T6

100 [75]

6.6

8.4

7.0

7.000

175u3245

10

32

850

0.100

175u3001

1.5

0.4

Table 7.14 T6, Horizontal Braking 10% Duty Cycle

106

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

FC 302

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Wire IP54

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection
[mm2]

Thermo
relay
[A]

T6

1.0
[0.75]

620

914.2

850

0.280

175u3317

175u3104

175u3105

1.5

0.6

T6

1.5 [1.1]

550

611.3

570

0.450

175u3318

175u3430

175u3429

1.5

0.9

T6

2 [1.5]

380

441.9

415

0.570

175u3319

175u3432

175u3431

1.5

1.1

T6

3 [2.2]

260

296.4

270

0.960

175u3320

175u3434

175u3433

1.5

1.8

T6

4 [3]

189

214.8

200

1.130

175u3321

175u3436

175u3435

1.5

2.3

T6

5 [4]

135

159.2

145

1.700

175u3322

175u3126

175u3127

1.5

3.3

T6

7.5 [5.5]

99.0

114.5

100

2.200

175u3323

175u3438

175u3437

1.5

4.4

T6

10 [7.5]

69.0

83.2

72

3.200

175u3324

175u3440

175u3439

1.5

6.3

T6

15 [11]

48.6

56.1

52

5.500

175u3148

175u3149

1.5

9.7

T6

20 [15]

35.1

40.8

38

6.000

175u3239

2.5

12.6

T6

25 [18.5]

27.0

32.9

31

8.000

175u3240

16

T6

30 [22]

22.5

27.6

27

10.000

175u3200

19

T6

40 [30]

17.1

21.4

19

14.000

175u3204

10

27

T6

50 [37]

13.5

17.3

14

17.000

175u3207

10

35

T6

60 [45]

10.8

14.2

13.5

21.000

175u3208

16

40

T6

75 [55]

8.8

11.6

11

26.000

175u3211

25

49

T6

100 [75]

6.6

8.4

7.0

30.000

175u3241

35

66

7 7

Table 7.15 T6, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

107

Design Guide

FC 302

Vertical braking 40% duty cycle


Brake resistor data

Adjustable frequency drive data


Pm

Line
power
type

(hp
[kW])

T7
T7

Installation

Danfoss part number


Rrec

Pbr.cont.

[]

[kW]

Screw
terminal
IP21

Screw
terminal
IP65

Bolt
connection
IP20

Cable
crosssection

Thermo
relay
[A]

Rmin

Rbr.nom

[]

[]

1.5 [1.1]

620

830

630

0.360

175u3108

175u3109

1.5

2 [1.5]

513

600

570

0.570

175u3110

175u3111

1.5

T7

3 [2.2]

340

403

415

0.790

175u3112

175u3113

1.5

1.3

T7

4 [3]

243

292

270

1.130

175u3118

175u3119

1.5

T7

5 [4]

180

216

200

1.700

175u3122

175u3123

1.5

2.8

T7

7.5 [5.5]

130

156

145

2.200

175u3106

175u3107

1.5

3.7

T7

10 [7.5]

94

113

105

3.200

175u3132

175u3133

1.5

5.2

T7

15 [11]

69.7

76.2

72

4.200

175u3142

175u3143

1.5

7.2

T7

20 [15]

46.8

55.5

52

6.000

175u3242

2.5

10.8

T7

25 [18.5]

36.0

44.7

42

8.000

175u3243

2.5

13.9

T7

30 [22]

29.0

37.5

31

10.000

175u3244

18

T7

40 [30]

22.5

29.1

27

14.000

175u3201

10

23

T7

50 [37]

18.0

23.5

22

17.000

175u3202

10

28

T7

60 [45]

13.5

19.3

15.5

21.000

175u3205

16

37

T7

75 [55]

13.5

15.7

13.5

26.000

175u3209

16

44

T7

100 [75]

8.8

11.5

11

36.000

175u3212

25

57

Wire IP54

[mm2]

0.8

Table 7.16 T7, Vertical Braking 40% Duty Cycle


Horizontal braking: Duty cycle 10% and maximum 120 s repetition rates according the reference brake profile. Average power corresponds to 6%.
Vertical braking: Duty cycle 40% and maximum 120 s repetition rates according the reference brake profile. Average power corresponds to 27%.
Cable cross-section: Recommended min. value based upon PVC-insulated copper cable, 86F [30C] ambient temperature with normal heat
dissipation.
All cabling must comply with national and local regulations on cable cross-sections and ambient temperature.
Thermal relay: Brake current setting of external thermal relay. All resistors have a built-in thermal relay switch N.C.
The IP54 is equipped with a 39 in [1,000 mm] fixed non-shielded cable. Vertical and horizontal mounting. Derating required by horizontal
mounting.
IP21 & IP65 are with screw terminal for cable termination. Vertical and horizontal mounting. Derating required by horizontal mounting.
The IP20 is with bolt connection for cable termination. Floor mounting.
175UA067.10

150/160%

Figure 7.2 Horizontal Loads

150/160%
100%

175UA068.10

7 7

How to Order

Figure 7.3 Vertical Loads

108

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2.6 Other Flat Pack Brake Resistors


Flat pack IP65 for horizontal conveyors
FC 301

Pm

Rmin

Rbr, nom

Rrec per item

Duty cycle

Ordering no.

T2

(hp [kW])

[]

[]

[//W]

[%]

175Uxxxx

PK25

0.37 [0.25]

368

416

430/100

40

1002

PK37

0.5 [0.37]

248

281

330/100 or 310/200

27 or 55

1003 or 0984

PK55

0.75 [0.55]

166

189

220/100 or 210/200

20 or 37

1004 or 0987

PK75

1.0 [0.75]

121

138

150/100 or 150/200

14 or 27

1005 or 0989

P1K1

1.5 [1.1]

81.0

92

100/100 or 100/200

10 or 19

1006 or 0991

P1K5

2 [1.5]

58.5

66.5

72/200

14

0992

P2K2

3 [2.2]

40.2

44.6

50/200

10

0993

P3K0

4 [3]

29.1

32.3

35/200 or 72/200

7 14

0994 or 2 x 0992

P3K7

5 [3.7]

22.5

25.9

60/200

11

2 x 0996

7 7

Table 7.17 Other Flat Packs for Adjustable Frequency Drives with Line Power Supply
FC 301 Line Power: 200240 V (T2)

Flat pack IP65 for horizontal conveyors


FC 302

Pm

Rmin

Rbr. nom

Rrec per item

Duty cycle

Ordering no.

T2

(hp [kW])

[]

[]

[/W]

[%]

175Uxxxx

PK25

0.37 [0.25]

380

475

430/100

40

1002

PK37

5 [0.37]

275

321

330/100 or 310/200

27 or 55

1003 or 0984

PK55

0.75 [0.55]

188

216

220/100 or 210/200

20 or 37

1004 or 0987

PK75

1 [0.75]

130

158

150/100 or 150/200

14 or 27

1005 or 0989

P1K1

1.5 [1.1]

81.0

105.1

100/100 or 100/200

10 or 19

1006 or 0991

P1K5

2 [1.5]

58.5

76.0

72/200

14

0992

P2K2

3 [2.2]

45.0

51.0

50/200

10

0993

P3K0

4 [3]

31.5

37.0

35/200 or 72/200

7 or 14

0994 or 2 x 0992

P3K7

5 [3.7]

22.5

29.7

60/200

11

2 x 0996

Table 7.18 Other Flat Packs for Adjustable Frequency Drives with Line Power Supply
FC 302 Line Power: 200240 V (T2)

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

109

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

Flat pack IP65 for horizontal conveyors


FC 301

Pm

Rmin

Rbr. nom

Rrec per item

Duty cycle

Ordering no.

T4

(hp [kW])

[]

[]

[/W]

[%]

175Uxxxx

PK37

0.37

620

1121

830/100

30

1000

PK55

0.75 [0.55]

620

750

830/100

20

1000

PK75

1 [0.75]

485

548

620/100 or 620/200

14 or 27

1001 or 0982

P1K1

1.5 [1.1]

329

365

430/100 or 430/200

10 or 20

1002 or 0983

P1K5

2 [1.5]

240.0

263.0

310/200

14

0984

P2K2

3 [2.2]

161.0

176.5

210/200

10

0987

P3K0

4 [3]

117.0

127.9

150/200 or 300/200

7 or 14

0989 or 2 x 0985

P4K0

5 [4]

87

95

240/200

10

2 x 0986

P5K5

7.5 [5.5]

63

68

160/200

2 x 0988

P7K5

10 [7.5]

45

50

130/200

2 x 0990

P11K

15 [11]

34.9

38.0

80/240

2 x 0090

P15K

20 [15]

25.3

27.7

72/240

2 x 0091

Table 7.19 Other Flat Packs for Adjustable Frequency Drives with Line Power Supply
FC 301 Line Power: 380480 V (T4)

Flat pack IP65 for horizontal conveyors


FC 302

Pm

Rmin

Rbr. nom

Rrec per item

Duty cycle

Ordering no.

T5

(hp [kW])

[]

[]

[/W]

[%]

175Uxxxx

PK37

5 [0.37]

620

1389

830/100

30

1000

PK55

0.75 [0.55]

620

929

830/100

20

1000

PK75

1 [0.75]

558

678

620/100 or 620/200

14 or 27

1001 or 0982

P1K1

1.5 [1.1]

382

453

430/100 or 430/200

10 or 20

1002 or 0983

P1K5

2 [1.5]

260.0

325.9

310/200

14

0984

P2K2

3 [2.2]

189.0

218.6

210/200

10

0987

P3K0

4 [3]

135.0

158.5

150/200 or 300/200

7 or 14

0989 or 2 x 0985

P4K0

5 [4]

99

117

240/200

10

2 x 0986

P5K5

7.5 [5.5]

72

84

160/200

2 x 0988

P7K5

10 [7.5]

50

61

130/200

2 x 0990

P11K

15 [11]

36.0

41.2

80/240

2 x 0090

P15K

20 [15]

27.0

30.0

72/240

2 x 0091

Table 7.20 Other Flat Packs for Adjustable Frequency Drives with Line Power Supply
FC 302 Line Power: 380500 V (T5)
IP65 is a flat-pack type with fixed cable.

110

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2.7 Harmonic Filters


Harmonic filters are used to reduce line harmonics.

AHF 010: 10% current distortion


AHF 005: 5% current distortion

Cooling and ventilation


IP20: Cooled by natural convection or with built-in fans. IP00: Additional forced cooling is required. Secure sufficient airflow
through the filter during installation to prevent overheating of the filter. Airflow of minimum 2 m/s is required through the
filter.
Power and current
ratings

Typical
motor

Filter current rating

(hp [kW])

Ordering no. AHF 005

Ordering no. AHF 010

[A]

IP00

IP20

IP00

IP20

50 Hz

[kW]

[A]

PK37-P4K0

1.29

4 [3]

10

130B1392

130B1229

130B1262

130B1027

P5K5-P7K5

14.4

10 [7.5]

14

130B1393

130B1231

130B1263

130B1058

P11K

22

15 [11]

22

130B1394

130B1232

130B1268

130B1059

P15K

29

20 [15]

29

130B1395

130B1233

130B1270

130B1089

P18K

34

25 [18.5]

34

130B1396

130B1238

130B1273

130B1094

P22K

40

30 [22]

40

130B1397

130B1239

130B1274

130B1111

P30K

55

40 [30]

55

130B1398

130B1240

130B1275

130B1176

P37K

66

50 [37]

66

130B1399

130B1241

130B1281

130B1180

P45K

82

60 [45]

82

130B1442

130B1247

130B1291

130B1201

P55K

96

75 [55]

96

130B1443

130B1248

130B1292

130B1204

P75K

133

100 [75]

133

130B1444

130B1249

130B1293

130B1207

7 7

Table 7.21 Harmonic Filters for 380415 V, 50 Hz


Power and current
ratings

Typical
motor

Filter current rating


60 Hz

Ordering no. AHF 005

Ordering no. AHF 010

[kW]

[A]

(hp [kW])

[A]

IP00

IP20

IP00

IP20

PK37-P4K0

1.29

4 [3]

10

130B3095

130B2857

130B2874

130B2262

P5K5-P7K5

14.4

10 [7.5]

14

130B3096

130B2858

130B2875

130B2265

P11K

22

15 [11]

22

130B3097

130B2859

130B2876

130B2268

P15K

29

20 [15]

29

130B3098

130B2860

130B2877

130B2294

P18K

34

25 [18.5]

34

130B3099

130B2861

130B3000

130B2297

P22K

40

30 [22]

40

130B3124

130B2862

130B3083

130B2303

P30K

55

40 [30]

55

130B3125

130B2863

130B3084

130B2445

P37K

66

50 [37]

66

130B3026

130B2864

130B3085

130B2459

P45K

82

60 [45]

82

130B3127

130B2865

130B3086

130B2488

P55K

96

75 [55]

96

130B3128

130B2866

130B3087

130B2489

P75K

133

100 [75]

133

130B3129

130B2867

130B3088

130B2498

Table 7.22 Harmonic Filters for 380415 V, 60 Hz

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

111

7 7

Design Guide

How to Order

Power and current

Typical

Filter current rating

ratings

motor

60 Hz

(hp [kW])

[kW]

[A]

Ordering no. AHF 005

Ordering no. AHF 010

[A]

IP00

IP20

IP00

IP20

PK37-P4K0

17.4

4 [3]

10

130B1787

130B1752

130B1770

130B1482

P5K5-P7K5

9.9+13

10 [7.5]

14

130B1788

130B1753

130B1771

130B1483

P11K

19

15 [11]

19

130B1789

130B1754

130B1772

130B1484

P15K

25

20 [15]

25

130B1790

130B1755

130B1773

130B1485

P18K

31

25 [18.5]

31

130B1791

130B1756

130B1774

130B1486

P22K

36

30 [22]

36

130B1792

130B1757

130B1775

130B1487

P30K

47

40 [30]

48

130B1793

130B1758

130B1776

130B1488

P37K

59

50 [37]

60

130B1794

130B1759

130B1777

130B1491

P45K

73

60 [45]

73

130B1795

130B1760

130B1778

130B1492

P55K

95

75 [55]

95

130B1796

130B1761

130B1779

130B1493

P75K

118

100 [75]

118

130B1797

130B1762

130B1780

130B1494

Table 7.23 Harmonic Filters for 440480 V, 60 Hz


Power and current
ratings

Typical
motor

Filter current rating


60 Hz

Ordering no. AHF 005

Ordering no. AHF 010

[kW]

[A]

(hp [kW])

[A]

IP00

IP20

IP00

IP20

P11K

15

13.5 [10]

15

130B5261

130B5246

130B5229

130B5212

P15K

19

22 [16.4]

20

130B5262

130B5247

130B5230

130B5213

P18K

24

27 [20]

24

130B5263

130B5248

130B5231

130B5214

P22K

29

32 [24]

29

130B5263

130B5248

130B5231

130B5214

P30K

36

44 [33]

36

130B5265

130B5250

130B5233

130B5216

P37K

49

54 [40]

50

130B5266

130B5251

130B5234

130B5217

P45K

58

67 [50]

58

130B5267

130B5252

130B5235

130B5218

P55K

74

80 [60]

77

130B5268

130B5253

130B5236

130B5219

P75K

85

100 [75]

87

130B5269

130B5254

130B5237

130B5220

Table 7.24 Harmonic Filters for 600 V, 60 Hz


Power and
current ratings
500550 V

Typical
motor

Power and Current


Ratings
551690 V

Typical
motor

Filter current
rating

Ordering no. AHF 005

Ordering no. AHF 010

50 Hz

[kW]

[A]

(hp [kW])

[kW]

[A]

(hp [kW])

[A]

IP00

IP20

IP00

IP20

P11K

15

10 [7.5]

P15K

16

20 [15]

15

130B5000

130B5088

130B5297

130B5280

P15K

19.5

15 [11]

P18K

20

25 [18.5]

20

130B5017

130B5089

130B5298

130B5281

P18K

24

20 [15]

P22K

25

30 [22]

24

130B5018

130B5090

130B5299

130B5282

P22K

29

25 [18.5]

P30K

31

40 [30]

29

130B5019

130B5092

130B5302

130B5283

P30K

36

30 [22]

P37K

38

50 [37]

36

130B5021

130B5125

130B5404

130B5284

P37K

49

40 [30]

P45K

48

60 [45]

50

130B5022

130B5144

130B5310

130B5285

P45K

59

50 [37]

P55K

57

75 [55]

58

130B5023

130B5168

130B5324

130B5286

P55K

71

60 [45]

P75K

76

100 [75]

77

130B5024

130B5169

130B5325

130B5287

P75K

89

75 [55]

87

130B5025

130B5170

130B5326

130B5288

Table 7.25 Harmonic Filters for 500690 V, 50 Hz

112

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

How to Order

Design Guide

7.2.8 Sine-Wave Filters


Adjustable frequency drive power and current ratings
200240 V

380440 V

441500 V

(hp
[kW])

[A]

(hp
[kW])

[A]

(hp
[kW])

[A]

0.5
[0.37]

1.3

0.5
[0.37]

1.1

0.34
[0.25]

1.8

0.75
[0.55]

1.8

0.75
[0.55]

1.6

0.5
[0.37]

2.4

1 [0.75]

2.4

1 [0.75]

2.1

1.5 [1.1]

1.5 [1.1]

3.5

2 [1.5]

4.1

2 [1.5]

3.4

0.75
[0.55]
1 [0.75]

4.6

3 [2.2]

5.6

3 [2.2]

4.8

1.5 [1.1]

6.6

4 [3]

7.2

4 [3]

6.3

2 [1.5]

7.5

5 [4]

10

5 [4]

8.2

3 [2.2]

10.6

7.5 [5.5]

13

7.5 [5.5]

11

Switching
frequency

Filter current rating

Ordering no.
IP00

IP20/231)

130B2404

130B2439

3.5

130B2406

130B2441

7.5

5.5

130B2408

130B2443

10

9.5

7.5

130B2409

130B2444

17

16

13

130B2411

130B2446

24

23

18

130B2412

130B2447

38

36

28.5

130B2413

130B2448

50 Hz

60 Hz

100 Hz

[A]

[A]

[A]

[kHz]

2.5

2.5

4.5

7 7

4 [3]

12.5

10 [7.5]

16

10 [7.5]

14.5

5 [3.7]

16.7

7.5 [5.5]

24.2

15 [11]

24

15 [11]

21

20 [15]

32

20 [15]

27

10 [7.5]

30.8

25
[18.5]

37.5

25
[18.5]

34

15 [11]

46.2

30 [22]

44

30 [22]

40

48

45.5

36

130B2281

130B2307

20 [15]

59.4

40 [30]

61

40 [30]

52

62

59

46.5

130B2282

130B2308

25
[18.5]

74.8

50 [37]

73

50 [37]

65

75

71

56

130B2283

130B2309

115

109

86

130B3179

130B3181*

180

170

135

130B3182

130B3183*

30 [22]

88

60 [45]

90

75 [55]

80

40 [30]

115

75 [55]

106

100 [75]

105

50 [37]

143

100 [75]

147

60 [45]

170

125 [90]

177

125 [90]

130

Table 7.26 Sine-Wave Filters for Adjustable Frequency Drives with 380500 V
1)

Ordering numbers marked with * are IP23.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

113

7 7

How to Order

Design Guide

Adjustable frequency drive power and current ratings


525600 V
(hp [kW])

690 V

[A]

(hp
[kW])

Filter current rating

525550 V
[A]

1 [0.75]

1.7

1.5 [1.1]

1.6

1.5 [1.1]

2.4

2 [1.5]

2.2

2 [1.5]

2.7

3 [2.2]

3.2

3 [2.2]

3.9

4 [3.0]

4.5

50 Hz

60 Hz

100 Hz

Switching
frequency

Ordering no.
IP00

IP20/231)

(hp
[kW])

[A]

[A]

[A]

[A]

kHz

4.5

130B7335

130B7356

10

130B7289

130B7324

13

12

130B3195

130B3196

28

26

21

130B4112

130B4113

45

42

33

130B4114

130B4115

76

72

57

130B4116

130B4117*

115

109

86

130B4118

130B4119*

165

156

124

130B4121

130B4124*

4 [3]

4.9

5 [4.0]

5.5

5 [4]

6.1

7.5 [5.5]

7.5

7.5 [5.5]

10 [7.5]

10

10 [7.5]

11

15 [11]

13

10 [7.5]

14

15 [11]

18

20 [15]

18

15 [11]

19

20 [15]

22

25 [18.5]

22

20 [15]

23

25 [18.5]

27

30 [22]

27

24 [18]

28

30 [22]

34

40 [30]

34

30 [22]

36

40 [30]

41

50 [37]

41

40 [30]

48

50 [37]

52

60 [45]

52

50 [37]

54

60 [45]

62

75 [55]

62

60 [45]

65

75 [55]

83

60 [45]

83

75 [55]

87

100 [75]

100

125 [90]

100

100 [75]

105

125 [90]

131

125 [90]

137

Table 7.27 Sine-Wave Filters for Adjustable Frequency Drives with 525690 V
1) Ordering numbers marked with * are IP23.
Parameter

Setting

14-00 Switching Pattern

[1] SFAVM

14-01 Switching Frequency

Set according the individual filter. Listed at filter product label and in output filter manual. Sine-wave
filters do not allow lower switching frequency than specified by the individual filter.

14-55 Output Filter

[2] Sine-Wave Filter Fixed

14-56 Capacitance Output


Filter

Set according to the individual filter. Listed at filter product label and in output filter manual (only
required for FLUX operation).

14-57 Inductance Output Filter Set according to the individual filter. Listed at filter product label and in output filter manual (only
required for FLUX operation).
Table 7.28 Parameter Settings for Sine-Wave Filter Operation

114

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

74.8

88

115

143

170

25
[18.5]

30 [22]

40 [30]

50 [37]

45

40 [30]

125 [90]

75 [55]

75 [55]

60 [45]

50 [37]

177

147

106

90

73

61

44

37.5

25
[18.5]

30 [22]

32

24

20 [15]

15 [11]

16

13

[A]

125 [90]

100 [75]

7.5 [55]

50 [37]

40 [30]

30 [22]

25
[18.5]

20 [15]

15 [11]

10 [7.5]

7.5 [5.5]

(hp
[kW])

130

105

80

65

52

40

34

27

21

14.5

11

[A]

441500

125 [90]

75 [55]

75 [55]

60 [45]

50 [37]

137

113

87

65

54

43

28

25
[18.5]
40 [30]

23

19

14

11.5

9.5

[A]

20 [15]

15 [11]

10 [7.5]

10 [7.5]

7.5 [5.5]

(hp
[kW])

525550

4.5
5.5
7.5
10

5 [4]
7.5 [5.5]
10 [7.5]

125 [90]

75 [55]

75 [55]

60 [45]

50 [37]

40 [30]

30 [22]

25
[18.5]

20 [15]

108

83

62

52

41

34

27

22

18

13

3.2

4 [3]

15 [11]

2.2

3 [2.2]

1.6

[A]

2 [1.5]

1.5 [1.1]

(hp
[kW])

551690

177

106

90

44

17

[A]

380@60 Hz
200400/
440@50 Hz

160

105

80

40

15

[A]

460/480
@60 Hz
500/525
@50 Hz

131

94

58

32

13

[A]

575/600
@60 Hz

Filter current rating [V]

N/A

130B2835

130B2838

103B2841

130B2844

27

54

86

108

IP00

10

[A]

690
@50 Hz

Table 7.29 dU/dt Filters for 200690 V

* Dedicated A3 enclosure types supporting foot print mounting and book style mounting. Fixed shielded cable connection to adjustable frequency drive.

46.2

59.4

15 [11]

20 [15]

30.8

10 [7.5]

24.2

16

7.5 [5.5]

7.5 [5.5]

12.5

4 [3]

5 [3.7]

10 [7.5]

(hp
[kW])

380440

[A]

(hp
[kW])

200240

Adjustable frequency drive ratings [V]

130B2845

103B2842

130B2839

130B2836

130B7367*

IP20*

Ordering no.

130B2846

103B2843

130B2840

130B2837

N/A

IP54

How to Order
Design Guide

7.2.9 dU/dt Filters

7 7

115

Design Guide

How to Order

Parameter

Setting

14-01 Switching Frequency

Higher operating switching frequency than specified by the individual filter is not recommended.

14-55 Output Filter

[0] No Filter

14-56 Capacitance Output Filter

Not used

14-57 Inductance Output Filter

Not used

Table 7.30 Parameter Settings for dU/dt Filter Operation

7 7

116

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Mechanical Installation

Design Guide

8 Mechanical Installation
8.1 Safety
See chapter 2 Safety for general safety instructions.

WARNING
Pay attention to the requirements that apply to
integration and the field mounting kit. Observe the
information in the list to avoid serious injury or
equipment damage, especially when installing large
units.

NOTICE!
The adjustable frequency drive is cooled by air
circulation.
To protect the unit from overheating, it must be ensured
that the ambient temperature does NOT exceed the
maximum temperature stated for the adjustable
frequency drive and that the 24-hour average
temperature is NOT exceeded. Locate the maximum
temperature in chapter 6.2.3 Ambient Conditions.
The 24-hour average temperature 9F is [5C] below the
maximum temperature.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

8 8

117

8 8

Mechanical Installation

Design Guide

8.2 Mechanical Dimensions


A3
33.7

A4
0.252.2

A5
0.253.7

B1
5.57.5

B2
11

B3
5.57.5

B4
1115

0.371.5

0.374.0

5.57.5

0.374

0.377.5

1115

18.522

1115

18.530

0.757.5

1115

18.522
1122

1115

18.530
1130

Height (in [mm])


Height of
backplate
Height with
decoupling plate
for serial
communication
bus cables
Distance between
mounting holes
Width (in [mm])
Width of backplate
Width of backplate
with one C option
Width of backplate
with two C options
Distance between
mounting holes
Depth (in [mm])
Depth without
option A/B
With option A/B

130BA826.10

130BA812.10

130BB458.10

130BA809.10

130BA870.10

IP
NEMA

130BA810.10

0.757.5
1.17.5

130BA827.10

A2
0.252.2

130BA813.10

A1
0.251.5

130BA811.10

Enclosure Type
Power 200240 V
[kW] 380480/
500 V
525600 V
525690 V
Figures

20
Chassis

20
Chassis

21
Type 1

20
Chassis

21
Type 1

55/66
Type
12/4X

55/66
Type
12/4X

21/55/66
Type
1/12/4X

21/55/66
Type
1/12/4X

20
Chassis

20
Chassis

7.87
[200]

10.55
[268]

14.76
[375]

10.55
[268]

14.76
[375]

15.35
[390]

16.54
[420]

18.9 [480]

15.59
[650]

15.71
[399]

20.47
[520]

12.44
[316]

14.72
[374]

14.72
[374]

16.54
[420]

23.43
[595]

7.48
[190]

10.12
[257]

13.78
[350]

10.12
[257]

13.78
[350]

15.79
[401]

15.83
[402]

17.87
[454]

24.57
[624]

14.96
[380]

19.49
[495]

5.12
[130]
6.69
[170]
7.48
[190]
4.33
[110]

5.12
[130]
6.69
[170]
7.48
[190]
4.33
[110]

B 2.95 [75]
B

b 2.36 [60]

C
C

3.54
[90]
5.12
[130]
5.91
[150]
2.76
[70]

3.54 [90]
5.12
[130]
5.91
[150]
2.76 [70]

8.15
[207]
8.74
[222]

8.07
[205]
8.66
[220]

8.15
[207]
8.74
[222]

8.07
[205]
8.66
[220]

8.15
[207]
8.74
[222]

0.24
[6.0]
0.32
[8]
0.2
[5]

0.32
[8.0]
0.43
[11]
0.22
[5.5]

0.32
[8.0]
0.43
[11]
0.22
[5.5]

0.32
[8.0]
0.43
[11]
0.22
[5.5]
0.26
[6.5]

0.32
[8.0]
0.43
[11]
0.22
[5.5]
0.26
[6.5]

7.87 [200] 9.53 [242] 9.53 [242] 9.53 [242] 6.5 [165]
-

9.53 [242] 9.53 [242] 9.53 [242]

9.53 [242] 9.53 [242] 9.53 [242]

6.73 [171] 8.47 [215] 8.27 [210] 8.27 [210]

6.89 [175] 7.87 [200]


6.89 [175] 7.87 [200]

10.24
[260]
10.24
[260]

10.24
[260]
10.24
[260]

0.47 [12]

0.47 [12]

0.75
[19]

0.75
[19]
0.35
[9]

8.07
[205]
8.86
[225]
5.51
[140]

9.06
[230]
9.06
[230]
9.06
[230]
7.87
[200]

10.32
[262]

9.53
[242]
9.53
[242]

0.32 [8]

0.47 [12]

9.8 [249]

Screw holes (in [mm])


c
d
e
f
Max weight (lbs [kg])

118

0.2 [5]
6 [2.7]

0.35 [9] 0.35 [9]


10.8
[4.9]

11.7
[5.3]

14.6
[6.6]

15.4
[7.0]

0.33 [8.25]
0.47
[12]
0.26
[6.5]

0.33
[8.25]
0.47
[12]
0.26
[6.5]

0.35 [9]

0.27
[6.8]
0.31
[7.9]

0.24 [6]

0.35 [9]

0.35 [9]

0.35 [9]

21.4 [9.7]

29.8/31.3
[13.5/
14.2]

50.7 [23]

59.5 [27] 26.5 [12]

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

0.34 [8.5]
0.59 [15]
51.8
[23.5]

MG33BF22

Mechanical Installation

Design Guide

A3
33.7

A4
0.252.2

A5
0.253.7

B1
5.57.5

B2
11

B3
5.57.5

B4
1115

0.374.0

5.57.5

0.374

0.377.5

1115

18.522

1115

18.530

0.757.5

1115

18.522
1122

1115

18.530
1130

1.5

Click
2.2

Click
2.2

Click
-

Click
-

0.757.5
1.17.5
Click
-

Click
-

1.5

130BA715.12

A2
0.252.2

130BA648.12

Enclosure Type
A1
Power 200240 V
0.251.5
[kW] 380480/
0.371.5
500 V
525600 V
525690 V
Front cover tightening torque [Nm]
Plastic cover (low IP)
Click
Metal cover (IP55/66)
-

c
A

a
d
e
a

8 8

Figure 8.1 Top and Bottom Mounting Holes (B4,


C3 and C4 only)

Table 8.1 Mechanical Dimensions, Enclosure Types A and B

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

119

Design Guide

C1
1522
3045
3045

C2
3037
5575
5590
3075

C4
3037
5575
5590

D3h
5575
130BA829.10

130BA828.10

21/55/66
Type 1/12/4X

21/55/66
Type 1/12/4X

20
Chassis

20
Chassis

20
Chassis

26.77 [680]

30.32 [770]

21.65 [550]

25.98 [660]

35.79 [909]

24.8 [630]

31.5 [800]

25.5 [648]

29.1 [739]

20.51 [521]

24.84 [631]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

9.84 [250]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

12.13 [308]

14.57 [370]

10.71 [272]

13.15 [334]

10.63 [270]

13 [330]

C
C

13 [310]
13 [310]

13.19 [335]
13.19 [335]

13.11 [333]
13.11 [333]

13.11 [333]
13.11 [333]

10.83 [275]
10.83 [275]

c
d
e
f

0.49 [12.5]
0.75 [19]
0.35 [9]
0.39 [9.8]
99.2 [45]

0.49 [12.5]
0.75 [19]
0.35 [9]
0.39 [9.8]
143.3 [65]

0.34 [8.5]
0.67 [17]
77.2 [35]

0.34 [8.5]
0.67 [17]
110.2 [50]

136.7 [62]

Click
2.2

Click
2.2

2.0
2.0

2.0
2.0

130BA715.12

Max weight (lbs [kg])


Front cover tightening torque [Nm]
Plastic cover (low IP)
Metal cover (IP55/66)

130BA815.10

130BA814.10

IP
NEMA
Height (in [mm])
Height of backplate
Height with decoupling plate for
serial communication bus cables
Distance between mounting holes
Width (in [mm])
Width of backplate
Width of backplate with one C
option
Width of backplate with two C
options
Distance between mounting holes
Depth (in [mm])
Depth without option A/B
With option A/B
Screw holes (in [mm])

C3
18.522
3745
3745
3745

130BC512.10

Enclosure Type
Power
200240 V
[kW]
380480/500 V
525600 V
525690 V
Figures

130BA648.12

8 8

Mechanical Installation

c
A

d
e
a

Figure 8.1 Top and Bottom Mounting Holes (B4, C3 and


C4 only)

Table 8.2 Mechanical Dimensions, Enclosure Types C and D

NOTICE!
Accessory bags containing necessary brackets, screws and connectors are shipped with the adjustable frequency drives
upon delivery.

120

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Mechanical Installation

8.2.1.1 Clearance

130BA419.10

8.2.1 Mechanical Mounting


a

All enclosure types allow side-by-side installation except


when an IP21/IP4X/TYPE 1 enclosure kit is used (see
chapter 11 Options and Accessories).

130BD389.11

Side-by-side mounting
IP20 A and B enclosure types can be arranged side-by-side
with no clearance required between them, but the
mounting order is important. Figure 8.1 shows how to
mount the frames correctly.

8 8
Figure 8.2 Clearance

A2

A2
B3

Enclosure Type

A1*/A2/A3/A4/
A5/B1

B2/B3/B4/
C1/C3

C2/C4

a (ins [mm])

3.94 [100]

7.87 [200]

8.86 [225]

b (ins [mm])

3.94 [100]

7.87 [200]

8.86 [225]

Table 8.3 Air Passage for Different Enclosure Types

8.2.1.2 Wall Mounting

B3

Figure 8.1 Correct Side-by-side Mounting

If the IP21 enclosure kit is used on enclosure types A1, A2


or A3, there must be a clearance between the adjustable
frequency drives of min. 2 in [50 mm].
For optimal cooling conditions allow a free air passage
above and below the adjustable frequency drive. See
Table 8.3.

When mounting on a solid back wall, the installation is


straight forward.
1.

Drill holes in accordance with the measurements


given.

2.

Provide screws suitable for the surface for


mounting the adjustable frequency drive.
Retighten all four screws.

If the adjustable frequency drive is to be mounted on a


non-solid back wall, provide the adjustable frequency drive
with a backplate, 1, due to insufficient cooling air over
the heatsink.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

121

8 8

Mechanical Installation

Design Guide

130BA392.11

NOTICE!
The backplate is relevant for A4, A5, B1, B2, C1 and C2
only.
130BA219.11

1
4
1
1

Backplate

Figure 8.3 Mounting on a non-solid backwall requires a


backplate

For adjustable frequency drives with IP66, take extra care


to maintain the corrosive-resistant surface. A fiber washer
or a nylon washer may be used to protect the epoxy
coating.

122

Backplate

IP66 adjustable frequency drive

Base plate

Fiber washer

Figure 8.4 Mounting on a Non-solid Back Wall

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

9 Electrical Installation
9.1 Safety

For electrical safety

See chapter 2 Safety for general safety instructions.

WARNING
INDUCED VOLTAGE
Induced voltage from output motor cables that run
together can charge equipment capacitors even with the
equipment turned off and locked out. Failure to run
output motor cables separately or use shielded cables or
metal conduits could result in death or serious injury.

run output motor cables separately, or


use shielded cables or metal conduits

CAUTION
The adjustable frequency drive can cause a DC current in
the PE conductor.
When a residual current-operated protective
device (RCD) is used for protection against
electrical shock, only an RCD of Type B is
permitted on the supply side.

Failure to follow the recommendation means the RCD


may not provide the intended protection.

WARNING

Use a dedicated ground wire for input power,


motor power and control wiring.

Do not ground one adjustable frequency drive to


another in a daisy chain fashion.

Keep the ground wire connections as short as


possible.

Follow the motor manufacturer wiring


requirements.

Minimum cable cross-section: 10 mm2 (or 2 rated


ground wires terminated separately).

Establish electrical contact between cable shield


and adjustable frequency drive enclosure by
using metal cable connectors or by using the
clamps provided on the equipment (see
chapter 9.4 Motor Connection).

Use high-strand wire to reduce electrical


interference.

Do not use pigtails.


NOTICE!
POTENTIAL EQUALIZATION

LEAKAGE CURRENT HAZARD


Leakage currents exceed 3.5 mA. Failure to ground the
adjustable frequency drive properly could result in death
or serious injury.

Ground the adjustable frequency drive in


accordance with applicable standards and
directives.

For EMC-compliant installation

SHOCK HAZARD

Ensure correct grounding of the equipment by


a certified electrical installer.

Risk of electrical interference, when the ground potential


between the adjustable frequency drive and the system
is different. Install equalizing cables between the system
components. Recommended cable cross-section: 16 mm2.

WARNING
LEAKAGE CURRENT HAZARD
Leakage currents exceed 3.5 mA. Failure to ground the
adjustable frequency drive properly could result in death
or serious injury.

MG33BF22

Ensure correct grounding of the equipment by


a certified electrical installer.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

123

9 9

9 9

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

9.2 Cables

NOTICE!
Cables General
All cabling must comply with national and local regulations on cable cross-sections and ambient temperature. Copper
(167 F [75 C]) conductors are recommended.
Aluminum Conductors
Terminals can accept aluminum conductors, but the conductor surface must be clean, and the oxidation must be removed
and sealed by neutral acid-free Vaseline grease before the conductor is connected.
Furthermore, the terminal screw must be retightened after two days due to softness of the aluminum. It is crucial to keep
the connection a gas-tight joint; otherwise, the aluminum surface will oxidize again.

9.2.1 Tightening Torque


Enclosure 200240 V
Type
(hp [kW])
0.342
A1
[0.251.5]
0.343
A2
[0.252.2]
45
A3
[33.7]
0.343
A4
[0.252.2]
45
A5
[33.7]
B1

7.510
[5.57.5]

380500 V
[kW]
0.52 [0.37
1.5]
0.55
[0.374]
7.510
[5.57.5]
0.55
[0.374]
7.510
[5.57.5]
1520
[1115]

525690 V Cable for


(hp [kW])

Tightening-up torque
[Nm]

1.510
[1.17.5]

Line power, brake resistor, load sharing, motor cables

0.50.6

Line power, brake resistor,


Relay
Ground
Line power, brake resistor,
Motor cables
Relay
Ground
Line power, brake resistor,
Relay
Ground
Line power, brake resistor,
Relay
Ground
Line power, brake resistor,
Motor cables
Relay
Ground
Line power, motor cables

1.8
0.50.6
23
4.5
4.5
0.50.6
23
1.8
0.50.6
23
4.5
0.50.6
23
10
10
0.50.6
23
14 (up to 95 mm2)
24 (over 95 mm2)
14
0.50.6
23
10
0.50.6
23
14 (up to 95 mm2)
24 (over 95 mm2)
14
0.50.6
23

B2

11

18.522

1122

B3

7.510
[5.57.5]

1520
[1115]

B4

1520
[1115]

2540
[18.530]

1540
[1130]

C1

2030
[1522]

4060
[3045]

C2

4050
[3037]

75100
[5575]

40100
[3075]

C3

2530
[18.522]

4050
[3037]

5060
[3745]

C4

5060
[3745]

75100
[5575]

load sharing, motor cables

load sharing cables

load sharing, motor cables

load sharing, motor cables

load sharing cables

Load sharing, brake cables


Relay
Ground
Line power, brake resistor, load sharing, motor cables
Relay
Ground
Line power, motor cables
Load sharing, brake cables
Relay
Ground

Table 9.1 Tightening Torque for Cables

124

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

1.

130BB657.10

9.2.2 Entry Holes


Remove the cable entry from the adjustable
frequency drive (this prevents foreign parts from
falling into the adjustable frequency drive when
removing knockouts).

[4]
[5]

2.

Cable entry has to be supported around the


knockout to be removed.

[6]

3.

The knockout can now be removed with a strong


mandrel and a hammer.

[3]
[2]

4.

Remove burrs from the hole.

5.

Mount the cable entry on the adjustable


frequency drive.

[1]

[4]
[5]

130BB656.10

The suggested use of the holes are recommendations, but


other solutions are possible. Unused cable entry holes can
be sealed with rubber grommets (for IP21).

Hole number and

Dimensions1)

recommended use

UL [in] [mm]

Nearest
metric

1) Line power

3/4

28.4

M25

2) Motor

3/4

28.4

M25

3) Brake/load sharing

3/4

28.4

M25

4) Control cable

1/2

22.5

M20

5) Control cable

1/2

22.5

M20

6) Control cable

1/2

22.5

M20

1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

9 9

Figure 9.2 A3 - IP21

[1]

[2]

[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]

130BB663.10

[3]

[1]

Hole number and

Dimensions1)

recommended use

UL [in] [mm]

Nearest
metric

Hole number
and
recommended
use

Dimensions1)
UL [in]

[mm]

Nearest metric

1) Line power

3/4

28.4

M25

1) Line power

3/4

28.4

M25

2) Motor

3/4

28.4

M25

2) Motor

3/4

28.4

M25

3) Brake/load sharing

3/4

28.4

M25

3/4

28.4

M25

4) Control cable

1/2

22.5

M20

3) Brake/load
sharing

5) Control cable

1/2

22.5

M20

4) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

5) Removed
Figure 9.1 A2 - IP21

1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

Figure 9.3 A4 - IP55

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

125

[4]

[4]

[2]

[5]

[3]

[3]

[5]
[1]

[6]

130BB666.10

130BB665.10

Design Guide

[2]
[1]

Hole number and recommended use

Nearest metric

1) Line power

M25

Hole number and recommended use

Nearest metric

2) Motor

M25

1) Line power

M25

3) Brake/load sharing

M25

2) Motor

M25

4) Control cable

M16

3) Brake/load sharing

1.12 in [28.4 mm]1)

5) Control cable

M20

4) Control cable

M25

5) Control cable

M25

6) Control cable

M25

Figure 9.4 A4 - IP55 Threaded Connector Holes

[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]

130BB664.10

1)

Knockout hole

Figure 9.6 A5- IP55 Threaded Connector Holes

[1]

[2]

[4]

[1]

Hole number
and
recommended
use

[5]
[3]

Dimensions1)

[2]

Nearest metric

UL [in]

[mm]

1) Line power

3/4

28.4

M25

2) Motor

3/4

28.4

M25

3) Brake/load
sharing

3/4

28.4

M25

4) Control
cable

3/4

28.4

M25

5) Control

3/4

28.4

M25
M25

cable2)
6) Control
cable2)
1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

2)

Knockout hole

Figure 9.5 A5 - IP55

3/4

28.4

130BB659.10

9 9

Electrical Installation

Hole number
and
recommended
use

Dimensions1)
Nearest metric

UL [in]

[mm]

1) Line power

34.7

M32

2) Motor

34.7

M32

3) Brake/load
sharing

34.7

M32

4) Control
cable

34.7

M32

5) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

Figure 9.7 B1 - IP21

126

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

[5]
[4]
[3]
[6]

Hole number
and
recommended
use

[1]
[4]

[2]

[5]
[3]

[1]

[2]

130BB660.10

Design Guide

130BB667.10

Electrical Installation

Dimensions1)

1) Line power

34.7

M32

Hole number
and
recommended
use

2) Motor

34.7

M32

1) Line power

1 1/4

44.2

M40

3) Brake/load
sharing

34.7

M32

2) Motor

1 1/4

44.2

M40

34.7

M32

UL [in]

Nearest metric

[mm]

Dimensions1)
UL [in]

[mm]

Nearest metric

4) Control
cable

3/4

28.4

M25

3) Brake/load
sharing

28.4

M25

1/2

22.5

M20

4) Control
cable

3/4

5) Control
cable

22.5

M20

1/2

22.5

M20

5) Control
cable

1/2

5) Control
cable2)
1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

2)

Knockout hole

1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

9 9

Figure 9.10 B2 - IP21

[5]
[3]

[4]

130BB669.10

[6]

[3]

130BB668.10

Figure 9.8 B1 - IP55

[5]
[2]

[2]

[1]

[4]
[1]

Hole number and recommended use

Nearest metric

1) Line power

M32

Hole number
and
recommended
use

2) Motor

M32

[mm]

1) Line power

1 1/4

44.2

M40

1 1/4

44.2

M40

34.7

M32

4) Control
cable

3/4

28.4

M25

5) Control

1/2

22.5

M20

3) Brake/load sharing

M32

2) Motor

M25

5) Control cable

M25

3) Brake/load
sharing

6) Control cable

22.5 mm1)

Knockout hole

Figure 9.9 B1 - IP55 Threaded Connector Holes

Nearest metric

UL [in]

4) Control cable

1)

Dimensions1)

cable2)
1)

Tolerance 0.2 mm

2)

Knockout hole

Figure 9.11 B2 - IP55

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

127

[4]
[3]
[2]

[5]
[4]
[2]
[3]
[1]

[5]

130BB661.10

Design Guide

130BB670.10

Electrical Installation

[1]

Hole number and recommended use

Nearest metric

1) Line power

M40

2) Motor

M40

3) Brake/load sharing

M32

Hole number
and
recommended
use

4) Control cable

M25

1) Line power

63.3

M63

5) Control cable

M20

2) Motor

63.3

M63

1 1/2

50.2

M50

4) Control
cable

3/4

28.4

M25

5) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

UL [in]

[mm]

3) Brake/load
sharing

[3]
[2]

130BB658.10

Figure 9.12 B2 - IP55 Threaded Connector Holes

[4]
[1]

9 9

Dimensions1)

1)

Nearest metric

Tolerance 0.2 mm

Figure 9.14 C1 - IP21

[5]

[5]
[6]

Hole number
and
recommended
use

[2]
[3]
[4]
[1]

Dimensions1)
UL [in]

[mm]

Nearest metric

1) Line power

34.7

M32

Hole number

2) Motor

34.7

M32

3) Brake/load
sharing

34.7

M32

and
recommended
use

UL [in]

[mm]

4) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

1) Line power

63.3

M63

2) Motor

63.3

M63

5) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

3) Brake/load
sharing

1 1/2

50.2

M50

6) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

4) Control
cable

3/4

28.4

M25

Tolerance 0.2 mm

5) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

Figure 9.13 B3 - IP21

6) Control
cable

1/2

22.5

M20

1)

1)

130BB662.10

[6]

Dimensions1)
Nearest metric

Tolerance 0.2 mm

Figure 9.15 C2 - IP21

128

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

NOTICE!

9.2.3 Tightening of the Cover after


Connections are Made
Enclosure
Type
A1

Exceeding 480 V RMS

IP20

IP21

IP55

IP66

A2

A3

A4/A5

B1

2.2

2.2

B2

2.2

2.2

B3

B4

C1

2.2

2.2

C2

2.2

2.2

C3

C4

* = No screws to tighten
- = Does not exist

RISK OF DAMAGE TO THE ADJUSTABLE


FREQUENCY DRIVE WITH RFI FILTER INSTALLED
When installed on a delta-grounded grid or an IT grid
(including ground fault condition), line input voltage in
the range of 380500 V (T4,T5) must not exceed 480 V
RMS between line power and ground.
For some enclosures, the mounting is different if the
adjustable frequency drive is configured from factory with
a line power switch. The various scenarios are illustrated in
the following.
AC line input connection for enclosures A1, A2 and A3:

NOTICE!

The power plug connector can be used on adjustable


frequency drives up to 7.5 kW.

Table 9.2 Tightening of the Cover (Nm)

1.

9.3 AC line input connections

Fit the two screws in the de-coupling plate, slide


it into place and tighten the screws.

2.

Make sure the adjustable frequency drive is


properly grounded. Connect to ground
connection (terminal 95). Use screw from the
accessory bag.

3.

Place plug connector 91 (L1), 92 (L2), 93 (L3) from


the accessory bag onto the terminals labeled
MAINS at the bottom of the adjustable frequency
drive.

4.

Attach the line wires to the line power plug


connector.

5.

Support the cable with the enclosed supporting


brackets.

It is mandatory to ground the AC line input connection


properly using terminal 95 of the adjustable frequency
drive, see chapter 9.1.1 Grounding.
The ground connection cable cross-section must be at
least 10 mm2 or 2 x rated line power wires terminated
separately according to EN 50178.
Use non-shielded cable.

Figure 9.16 AC line input connections

NOTICE!
Using fuses and/or circuit breakers on the supply side is
mandatory to ensure compliance with IEC 60364 for CE
or NEC 2009 for UL, see chapter 9.3.1.4 UL Compliance.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

129

9 9

130BA263.10

130BA261.10

Design Guide

I N

DC

BR

L1

91

-B

R+

95

95

-D
C+

L2

92

RELAY 1

RELAY 1 RELAY 2

RELAY 2

L3

93

+D

- LC +

BR
- B
R+

99

Figure 9.17 Support Plate

RELAY 1

130BA264.10

L1
91 L2 L3
92
93

RELAY 2

130BA262.10

Figure 9.19 Mounting Line Power Plug and Tightening Wires

+D

BR
- B
R+

- LC -

99

M
I

RELAY 2

95

Figure 9.20 Tighten Support Bracket

RELAY 1

9 9

Electrical Installation

+D

BR
-

BR
+
U
V
W

Figure 9.18 Tightening the Ground Cable

130

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

130BT336.10

130BT332.10

AC line input connector enclosures A4/A5

L3
L2
L 1 2 93
9
91

Figure 9.21 Connecting to Line Power and Grounding without

9 9

Figure 9.23 AC Line Input Connection Enclosures B1 and B2

130BA725.10

130BT335.10

Disconnector

Figure 9.22 Connecting to Line Power and Grounding with


Disconnector

adjustable frequency driveWhen disconnector is used


(enclosures A4/A5), mount the PE on the left side of the
adjustable frequency drive.

Figure 9.24 AC Line Input Connection Enclosure B3

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

131

Design Guide

L1 91

L2 92

130BA389.10

130BA714.10

Electrical Installation

L3 93

91
L1

92
L2

93
L3

95

L1 91

L2 92

L3 93

95

U 96
V 97 W
98

DC-88

DC+89

99

9 9

R-81

R+82

Figure 9.25 AC Line Input Connection Enclosure B4

Figure 9.26 AC Line Input Connection Enclosures C1 and C2


(IP21/NEMA Type 1 and IP55/66/NEMA Type 12).

132

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

130BA718.10

Electrical Installation

91 9
2 93

9.3.1 Fuses and Circuit Breakers


9.3.1.1 Fuses
It is recommended to use fuses and/or circuit breakers on
the supply side as protection in case of component breakdown inside the adjustable frequency drive (first fault).

NOTICE!
Using fuses and/or circuit breakers on the supply side is
mandatory to ensure compliance with IEC 60364 for CE
or NEC 2009 for UL.
95
91 9
2 93
96
97 9
8

88 8
9

81 8
2

Branch Circuit Protection


To protect the installation against electrical and fire hazard,
all branch circuits in an installation, switch gear, machines,
etc., must be protected against short-circuit and
overcurrent according to national/international regulations.

99

NOTICE!
The recommendations given do not cover branch circuit
protection for UL.

L1

91

130BA719.10

Figure 9.27 AC Line Input Connection Enclosures C3 (IP20).

L2

92

L1 L2
L3

91 9
2 93

L3

Short-circuit protection
Danfoss recommends using the fuses/circuit breakers
mentioned below to protect service personnel and
property in case of component breakdown in the
adjustable frequency drive.

9.3.1.2 Recommendations
93

The tables in chapter 9.3.1 Fuses and Circuit Breakers list the
recommended rated current. Recommended fuses are of
the type gG for small to medium power sizes. For larger
power sizes, aR fuses are recommended. For circuit
breakers, Moeller types are recommended. Other types of
circuit breakers may be used provided they limit the
energy into the adjustable frequency drive to a level equal
to or lower than the Moeller types.
95 U
99 96

W D
C-DC+
R-

If fuses/circuit breakers according to recommendations are


selected, possible damage on the adjustable frequency
drive is mainly limited to damages inside the unit.

R+

97 9
8 88
89 81
82

For further information see Application Note Fuses and


Circuit Breakers, MN90T.

Figure 9.28 AC Line Input Connection Enclosures C4 (IP20).

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

133

9 9

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

9.3.1.3 CE Compliance
Fuses or circuit breakers are mandatory to comply with IEC 60364. Danfoss recommend using a selection of the following.
The fuses below are suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering 100,000 Arms (symmetrical), 240 V, 500 V, 600 V, or
690 V depending on the adjustable frequency drive voltage rating. With the proper fusing the adjustable frequency drive
short circuit current rating (SCCR) is 100,000 Arms.
The following UL-listed fuses are suitable:
UL248-4 class CC fuses

UL248-8 class J fuses


UL248-12 class R fuses (RK1)
UL248-15 class T fuses

The following max. fuse size and type have been tested:
Enclosure

Power (hp [kW])

Recommended
fuse size

Recommended
max. fuse

Recommended circuit
breaker
Moeller

Max trip level [A]

A1

0.342 [0.251.5]

gG-10

gG-25

PKZM0-10

10

A2

0.343 [0.252.2]

gG-10 (0.251.5)
gG-16 (2.2)

gG-25

PKZM0-16

16

A3

45 [3.03.7]

gG-16 (3)
gG-20 (3.7)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

A4

0.343 [0.252.2]

gG-10 (0.251.5)
gG-16 (2.2)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

A5

0.345 [0.253.7]

gG-10 (0.251.5)
gG-16 (2.23)
gG-20 (3.7)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

B1

7.510 [5.57.5]

gG-25 (5.5)
gG-32 (7.5)

gG-80

PKZM4-63

63

B2

15 [11]

gG-50

gG-100

NZMB1-A100

100

9 9

B3

7.5 [5.5]

gG-25

gG-63

PKZM4-50

50

B4

1020 [7.515]

gG-32 (7.5)
gG-50 (11)
gG-63 (15)

gG-125

NZMB1-A100

100

C1

2030 [152]

gG-63 (15)
gG-80 (18.5)
gG-100 (22)

gG-160 (1518.5)
aR-160 (22)

NZMB2-A200

160

C2

4050 [3037]

aR-160 (30)
aR-200 (37)

aR-200 (30)
aR-250 (37)

NZMB2-A250

250

C3

2530 [18.522]

gG-80 (18.5)
aR-125 (22)

gG-150 (18.5)
aR-160 (22)

NZMB2-A200

150

C4

4050 [3037]

aR-160 (30)
aR-200 (37)

aR-200 (30)
aR-250 (37)

NZMB2-A250

250

Table 9.3 200240 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

134

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

Enclosure

Power (hp [kW])

Recommended
fuse size

Recommended
max. fuse

Recommended circuit
breaker Moeller

Max trip level [A]

A1
A2

0.371.5

gG-10

gG-25

PKZM0-10

10

0.374.0

gG-10 (0.373)
gG-16 (4)

gG-25

PKZM0-16

16

A3

7.510 [5.57.5]

gG-16

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

A4

0.54 [0.374]

gG-10 (0.373)
gG-16 (4)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

A5

0.510 [0.377.5]

gG-10 (0.373)
gG-16 (47.5)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

B1

1520 [1115]

gG-40

gG-80

PKZM4-63

63

B2

2530 [18.522]

gG-50 (18.5)
gG-63 (22)

gG-100

NZMB1-A100

100

B3

1520 [1115]

gG-40

gG-63

PKZM4-50

50

B4

2540 [18.530]

gG-50 (18.5)
gG-63 (22)
gG-80 (30)

gG-125

NZMB1-A100

100

C1

4060 [3045]

gG-80 (30)
gG-100 (37)
gG-160 (45)

gG-160

NZMB2-A200

160

C2

75100 [5575]

aR-200 (55)
aR-250 (75)

aR-250

NZMB2-A250

250

C3

4060 [3745]

gG-100 (37)
gG-160 (45)

gG-150 (37)
gG-160 (45)

NZMB2-A200

150

C4

75100 [5575]

aR-200 (55)
aR-250 (75)

aR-250

NZMB2-A250

250

9 9

Table 9.4 380500 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

135

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

Enclosure

9 9

Power (hp [kW])

Recommended
fuse size

Recommended
max. fuse

Recommended circuit
breaker
Moeller

Max trip level [A]

A2

15 [0.754.0]

gG-10

gG-25

PKZM0-16

16

A3

7.510 [5.57.5]

gG-10 (5.5)
gG-16 (7.5)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

A5

110 [0.757.5]

gG-10 (0.755.5)
gG-16 (7.5)

gG-32

PKZM0-25

25

B1

1524 [1118]

gG-25 (11)
gG-32 (15)
gG-40 (18.5)

gG-80

PKZM4-63

63

B2

3040 [2230]

gG-50 (22)
gG-63 (30)

gG-100

NZMB1-A100

100

B3

1520 [1115]

gG-25 (11)
gG-32 (15)

gG-63

PKZM4-50

50

B4

2540 [18.530]

gG-40 (18.5)
gG-50 (22)
gG-63 (30)

gG-125

NZMB1-A100

100

C1

5075 [3755]

gG-63 (37)
gG-100 (45)
aR-160 (55)

gG-160 (3745)
aR-250 (55)

NZMB2-A200

160

C2

100 [75]

aR-200 (75)

aR-250

NZMB2-A250

250

C3

5060 [3745]

gG-63 (37)
gG-100 (45)

gG-150

NZMB2-A200

150

C4

75100 [5575]

aR-160 (55)
aR-200 (75)

aR-250

NZMB2-A250

250

Table 9.5 525600 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


Enclosure

Power (hp [kW])

Recommended
fuse size

Recommended
max. fuse

Recommended circuit
breaker
Moeller

Max trip level [A]

A3

1.5 [1.1]

gG-6

gG-25

PKZM0-16

16

20 [1.5]
3 [2.2]
4 [3]
5 [4]
7.5 [5.5]
10 [7.5]

gG-6
gG-6
gG-10
gG-10
gG-16
gG-16

gG-25
gG-25
gG-25
gG-25
gG-25
gG-25
gG-63

B2/B4

15
20
24
30

[11]
[15]
[18]
[22]

gG-25
gG-32
gG-32
gG-40

(11)
(15)
(18)
(22)

B4/C2

40 [30]

gG-63 (30)

gG-80 (30)

C2/C3

50 [37]
60 [45]

gG-63 (37)
gG-80 (45)

gG-100 (37)
gG-125 (45)

C2

75 [55]
100 [75]

gG-100 (55)
gG-125 (75)

gG-160 (5575)

Table 9.6 525690 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

136

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

9.3.1.4 UL Compliance
The fuses below are suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering 100,000 Arms (symmetrical), 240 V, or 500 V, or 600 V
depending on the adjustable frequency drive voltage rating. With the proper fusing, the adjustable frequency drive Short
Circuit Current Rating (SCCR) is 100,000 Arms.
Fuses or circuit breakers are mandatory to comply with NEC 2009. Danfoss recommends using a selection of the following:
Recommended max. fuse
Power
[kW]
0.340.5

Bussmann
Type RK11)

Bussmann
Type J

Bussmann
Type T

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

KTN-R-05

JKS-05

JJN-05

FNQ-R-5

KTK-R-5

LP-CC-5

0.751.5
[0.551.1]

KTN-R-10

JKS-10

JJN-10

FNQ-R-10

KTK-R-10

LP-CC-10

2 [1.5]

KTN-R-15

JKS-15

JJN-15

FNQ-R-15

KTK-R-15

LP-CC-15

3 [2.2]

KTN-R-20

JKS-20

JJN-20

FNQ-R-20

KTK-R-20

LP-CC-20

4 [3.0]

KTN-R-25

JKS-25

JJN-25

FNQ-R-25

KTK-R-25

LP-CC-25

[0.250.37]

5 [3.7]

KTN-R-30

JKS-30

JJN-30

FNQ-R-30

KTK-R-30

LP-CC-30

7.5 [5.5]

KTN-R-50

KS-50

JJN-50

10 [7.5]

KTN-R-60

JKS-60

JJN-60

15 [11]

KTN-R-80

JKS-80

JJN-80

2025
[1518.5]

KTN-R-125

JKS-125

JJN-125

30 [22]

KTN-R-150

JKS-150

JJN-150

40 [30]

KTN-R-200

JKS-200

JJN-200

50 [37]

KTN-R-250

JKS-250

JJN-250

9 9

Table 9.7 200240 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


Recommended max. fuse
FerrazShawmut

Power
[kW]

SIBA
Type RK1

Littelfuse
Type RK1

FerrazShawmut
Type CC

Type RK13)

0.340.5
[0.250.37]

5017906-005

KLN-R-05

ATM-R-05

A2K-05-R

0.751.5
[0.551.1]

5017906-010

KLN-R-10

ATM-R-10

A2K-10-R

2 [1.5]

5017906-016

KLN-R-15

ATM-R-15

A2K-15-R

3 [2.2]

5017906-020

KLN-R-20

ATM-R-20

A2K-20-R

4 [3.0]

5017906-025

KLN-R-25

ATM-R-25

A2K-25-R

5 [3.7]

5012406-032

KLN-R-30

ATM-R-30

A2K-30-R

7.5 [5.5]

5014006-050

KLN-R-50

A2K-50-R

10 [7.5]

5014006-063

KLN-R-60

A2K-60-R

15 [11]

5014006-080

KLN-R-80

A2K-80-R

2025
[1518.5]

2028220-125

KLN-R-125

A2K-125-R

30 [22]

2028220-150

KLN-R-150

A2K-150-R

40 [30]

2028220-200

KLN-R-200

A2K-200-R

50 [37]

2028220-250

KLN-R-250

A2K-250-R

Table 9.8 200240 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

137

9 9

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

Recommended max. fuse


Power
[kW]

Bussmann

FerrazShawmut

Type JFHR22)

Littelfuse
JFHR2

FerrazShawmut J

0.340.5
[0.250.37]

FWX-5

HSJ-6

0.751.5
[0.551.1]

FWX-10

HSJ-10

2 [1.5]

FWX-15

HSJ-15

3 [2.2]

FWX-20

HSJ-20

4 [3.0]

FWX-25

HSJ-25

JFHR24)

5 [3.7]

FWX-30

HSJ-30

7.5 [5.5]

FWX-50

HSJ-50

10 [7.5]

FWX-60

HSJ-60

15 [11]

FWX-80

HSJ-80

2025
[1518.5]

FWX-125

HSJ-125

30 [22]

FWX-150

L25S-150

A25X-150

HSJ-150

40 [30]

FWX-200

L25S-200

A25X-200

HSJ-200

50 [37]

FWX-250

L25S-250

A25X-250

HSJ-250

Table 9.9 200240 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


1)

KTS fuses from Bussmann may substitute KTN for 240 V adjustable frequency drives.

2)

FWH fuses from Bussmann may substitute FWX for 240 V adjustable frequency drives.

3)

A6KR fuses from FERRAZ SHAWMUT may substitute A2KR for 240 V adjustable frequency drives.

4)

A50X fuses from FERRAZ SHAWMUT may substitute A25X for 240 V adjustable frequency drives.
Recommended max. fuse
Power
[kW]

Bussmann
Type RK1

Bussmann
Type J

Bussmann
Type T

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

0.51.5
[0.371.1]

KTS-R-6

JKS-6

JJS-6

FNQ-R-6

KTK-R-6

LP-CC-6

23
[1.52.2]

KTS-R-10

JKS-10

JJS-10

FNQ-R-10

KTK-R-10

LP-CC-10

4 [3]

KTS-R-15

JKS-15

JJS-15

FNQ-R-15

KTK-R-15

LP-CC-15

5 [4]

KTS-R-20

JKS-20

JJS-20

FNQ-R-20

KTK-R-20

LP-CC-20

7.5 [5.5]

KTS-R-25

JKS-25

JJS-25

FNQ-R-25

KTK-R-25

LP-CC-25

10 [7.5]

KTS-R-30

JKS-30

JJS-30

FNQ-R-30

KTK-R-30

LP-CC-30

15 [11]

KTS-R-40

JKS-40

JJS-40

20 [15]

KTS-R-50

JKS-50

JJS-50

24 [18]

KTS-R-60

JKS-60

JJS-60

30 [22]

KTS-R-80

JKS-80

JJS-80

40 [30]

KTS-R-100

JKS-100

JJS-100

50 [37]

KTS-R-125

JKS-125

JJS-125

60 [45]

KTS-R-150

JKS-150

JJS-150

75 [55]

KTS-R-200

JKS-200

JJS-200

100 [75]

KTS-R-250

JKS-250

JJS-250

Table 9.10 380500 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

138

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

Recommended max. fuse


Power
[kW]

SIBA
Type RK1

Littelfuse
Type RK1

FerrazShawmut
Type CC

FerrazShawmut
Type RK1

0.51.5
[0.371.1]

5017906-006

KLS-R-6

ATM-R-6

A6K-6-R

23
[1.52.2]

5017906-010

KLS-R-10

ATM-R-10

A6K-10-R

4 [3]

5017906-016

KLS-R-15

ATM-R-15

A6K-15-R

5 [4]

5017906-020

KLS-R-20

ATM-R-20

A6K-20-R

7.5 [5.5]

5017906-025

KLS-R-25

ATM-R-25

A6K-25-R

10 [7.5]

5012406-032

KLS-R-30

ATM-R-30

A6K-30-R

15 [11]

5014006-040

KLS-R-40

A6K-40-R

20 [15]

5014006-050

KLS-R-50

A6K-50-R

24 [18]

5014006-063

KLS-R-60

A6K-60-R

30 [22]

2028220-100

KLS-R-80

A6K-80-R

40 [30]

2028220-125

KLS-R-100

A6K-100-R

50 [37]

2028220-125

KLS-R-125

A6K-125-R

60 [45]

2028220-160

KLS-R-150

A6K-150-R

75 [55]

2028220-200

KLS-R-200

A6K-200-R

100 [75]

2028220-250

KLS-R-250

A6K-250-R

9 9

Table 9.11 380500 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


Recommended max. fuse
Ferraz- Shawmut

Power
[kW]

Bussmann
JFHR2

Ferraz- Shawmut J

JFHR21)

Littelfuse
JFHR2

0.51.5
[0.371.1]

FWH-6

HSJ-6

23
[1.52.2]

FWH-10

HSJ-10

4 [3]

FWH-15

HSJ-15

5 [4]

FWH-20

HSJ-20

7.5 [5.5]

FWH-25

HSJ-25

10 [7.5]

FWH-30

HSJ-30

15 [11]

FWH-40

HSJ-40

20 [15]

FWH-50

HSJ-50

24 [18]

FWH-60

HSJ-60

30 [22]

FWH-80

HSJ-80

40 [30]

FWH-100

HSJ-100

50 [37]

FWH-125

HSJ-125

60 [45]

FWH-150

HSJ-150

75 [55]

FWH-200

HSJ-200

A50-P-225

L50-S-225

100 [75]

FWH-250

HSJ-250

A50-P-250

L50-S-250

Table 9.12 380500 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


1)

Ferraz-Shawmut A50QS fuses may substitute for A50P fuses.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

139

9 9

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

Recommended max. fuse


Power
[kW]

Bussmann
Type RK1

Bussmann
Type J

Bussmann
Type T

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

11.5
[0.751.1]

KTS-R-5

JKS-5

JJS-6

FNQ-R-5

KTK-R-5

LP-CC-5

23
[1.52.2]

KTS-R-10

JKS-10

JJS-10

FNQ-R-10

KTK-R-10

LP-CC-10

4 [3]

KTS-R15

JKS-15

JJS-15

FNQ-R-15

KTK-R-15

LP-CC-15

5 [4]

KTS-R20

JKS-20

JJS-20

FNQ-R-20

KTK-R-20

LP-CC-20

7.5 [5.5]

KTS-R-25

JKS-25

JJS-25

FNQ-R-25

KTK-R-25

LP-CC-25

10 [7.5]

KTS-R-30

JKS-30

JJS-30

FNQ-R-30

KTK-R-30

LP-CC-30

15 [11]

KTS-R-35

JKS-35

JJS-35

20 [15]

KTS-R-45

JKS-45

JJS-45

24 [18]

KTS-R-50

JKS-50

JJS-50

30 [22]

KTS-R-60

JKS-60

JJS-60

40 [30]

KTS-R-80

JKS-80

JJS-80

50 [37]

KTS-R-100

JKS-100

JJS-100

60 [45]

KTS-R-125

JKS-125

JJS-125

75 [55]

KTS-R-150

JKS-150

JJS-150

100 [75]

KTS-R-175

JKS-175

JJS-175

Table 9.13 525600 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


Recommended max. fuse
SIBA
Type RK1

Littelfuse
Type RK1

FerrazShawmut
Type RK1

FerrazShawmut J

11.5
[0.751.1]

5017906-005

KLS-R-005

A6K-5-R

HSJ-6

23
[1.52.2]

5017906-010

KLS-R-010

A6K-10-R

HSJ-10

4 [3]

5017906-016

KLS-R-015

A6K-15-R

HSJ-15

5 [4]

5017906-020

KLS-R-020

A6K-20-R

HSJ-20

7.5 [5.5]

5017906-025

KLS-R-025

A6K-25-R

HSJ-25

10 [7.5]

5017906-030

KLS-R-030

A6K-30-R

HSJ-30

15 [11]

5014006-040

KLS-R-035

A6K-35-R

HSJ-35

20 [15]

5014006-050

KLS-R-045

A6K-45-R

HSJ-45

24 [18]

5014006-050

KLS-R-050

A6K-50-R

HSJ-50

30 [22]

5014006-063

KLS-R-060

A6K-60-R

HSJ-60

40 [30]

5014006-080

KLS-R-075

A6K-80-R

HSJ-80

50 [37]

5014006-100

KLS-R-100

A6K-100-R

HSJ-100

60 [45]

2028220-125

KLS-R-125

A6K-125-R

HSJ-125

75 [55]

2028220-150

KLS-R-150

A6K-150-R

HSJ-150

100 [75]

2028220-200

KLS-R-175

A6K-175-R

HSJ-175

Power [kW]

Table 9.14 525600 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C

140

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

Recommended max. fuse


Power
[kW]

Bussmann
Type RK1

Bussmann
Type J

Bussmann
Type T

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

Bussmann
Type CC

(hp [kW])
1.5 [1.1]

KTS-R-5

JKS-5

JJS-6

FNQ-R-5

KTK-R-5

LP-CC-5

23
[1.52.2]

KTS-R-10

JKS-10

JJS-10

FNQ-R-10

KTK-R-10

LP-CC-10

4 [3]

KTS-R15

JKS-15

JJS-15

FNQ-R-15

KTK-R-15

LP-CC-15

5 [4]

KTS-R20

JKS-20

JJS-20

FNQ-R-20

KTK-R-20

LP-CC-20

7.5 [5.5]

KTS-R-25

JKS-25

JJS-25

FNQ-R-25

KTK-R-25

LP-CC-25

10 [7.5]

KTS-R-30

JKS-30

JJS-30

FNQ-R-30

KTK-R-30

LP-CC-30

15 [11]

KTS-R-35

JKS-35

JJS-35

20 [15]

KTS-R-45

JKS-45

JJS-45

24 [18]

KTS-R-50

JKS-50

JJS-50

30 [22]

KTS-R-60

JKS-60

JJS-60

40 [30]

KTS-R-80

JKS-80

JJS-80

50 [37]

KTS-R-100

JKS-100

JJS-100

60 [45]

KTS-R-125

JKS-125

JJS-125

75 [55]

KTS-R-150

JKS-150

JJS-150

100 [75]

KTS-R-175

JKS-175

JJS-175

9 9

Table 9.15 525690 V, Enclosure Types A, B and C


Recommended max. fuse
Max.
prefuse

Bussmann
E52273
RK1/JDDZ

15 [11]

30 A

2025 [15
18.5]

45 A

Power
[kW]

Littelfuse
E81895
RK1/JDDZ

FerrazShawmut
E163267/E2137
RK1/JDDZ

FerrazShawmut
E2137
J/HSJ

Bussmann
E4273
J/JDDZ

Bussmann
E4273
T/JDDZ

SIBA
E180276
RK1/JDDZ

KTS-R-30

JKS-30

JKJS-30

5017906-030

KLS-R-030

A6K-30-R

HST-30

KTS-R-45

JKS-45

JJS-45

5014006-050

KLS-R-045

A6K-45-R

HST-45

30 [22]

60 A

KTS-R-60

JKS-60

JJS-60

5014006-063

KLS-R-060

A6K-60-R

HST-60

40 [30]

80 A

KTS-R-80

JKS-80

JJS-80

5014006-080

KLS-R-075

A6K-80-R

HST-80

50 [37]

90 A

KTS-R-90

JKS-90

JJS-90

5014006-100

KLS-R-090

A6K-90-R

HST-90

60 [45]

100 A

KTS-R-100

JKS-100

JJS-100

5014006-100

KLS-R-100

A6K-100-R

HST-100

75 [55]

125 A

KTS-R-125

JKS-125

JJS-125

2028220-125

KLS-150

A6K-125-R

HST-125

100 [75]

150 A

KTS-R-150

JKS-150

JJS-150

2028220-150

KLS-175

A6K-150-R

HST-150

Table 9.16 525690 V, Enclosure Types B and C

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

141

NOTICE!

9.4 Motor Connection

WARNING
INDUCED VOLTAGE
Induced voltage from output motor cables that run
together can charge equipment capacitors even with the
equipment turned off and locked out. Failure to run
output motor cables separately or use shielded cables or
metal conduits could result in death or serious injury.

run output motor cables separately, or


use shielded cables or metal conduits

NOTICE!

To comply with EMC emission specifications, shielded/


armored cables are required. For more information, see
chapter 5.2.1 EMC Test Results and Figure 3.3.

98

99

PE1) Motor voltage 0100% of AC line


voltage.
3 wires out of motor

U1 V1 W1
W2 U2

V2

U1 V1 W1

PE1)
PE1)

Delta-connected
6 wires out of motor
Star-connected U2, V2, W2
U2, V2 and W2 to be interconnected separately.

Table 9.17 Terminal Descriptions


1)

Protected Ground Connection

Motor
U2

V2

W2

Motor
U2

U1

V1

W1

U1

V2

V1

W2

W1

FC

FC
96

97

Shielding of cables
Avoid installation with twisted shield ends (pigtails). They
spoil the shielding effect at higher frequencies. If it is
necessary to break the shield to install a motor isolator or
motor contactor, the shield must be continued at the
lowest possible HF impedance.

98

96

97

Strip a piece of the motor cable to expose the shield


behind the cable clamp AND connect the ground
connection to terminal 99.
Connect the motor cable shield to both the decoupling
plate on the adjustable frequency drive and to the metal
housing on the motor.
Make the shield connections with the largest possible
surface area (cable clamp). This is done by using the
supplied installation devices in the adjustable frequency
drive.
If it is necessary to split the shield to install a motor
isolator or motor relay, the shield must be continued with
the lowest possible HF impedance.

See chapter 6.2 General Specifications for correct


dimensioning of motor cable cross-section and length.
Term. 96 97
no.

In motors without phase insulation paper or other


insulation reinforcement suitable for operation with
voltage supply (such as an adjustable frequency drive),
fit a sine-wave filter on the output of the adjustable
frequency drive.

NOTICE!

Motor Connection

175ZA114.11

9 9

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

Cable length and cross-section


The adjustable frequency drive has been tested with a
given length of cable and a given cross-section of that
cable. If the cross-section is increased, the cable
capacitance - and thus the leakage current - may increase,
thereby requiring that the cable length is reduced
accordingly. Keep the motor cable as short as possible to
reduce the noise level and leakage currents.
Switching frequency
When adjustable frequency drives are used with sine-wave
filters to reduce the acoustic noise from a motor, the
switching frequency must be set according to the sinewave filter instruction in 14-01 Switching Frequency.
1.

Fasten a decoupling plate to the bottom of the


adjustable frequency drive with screws and
washers from the accessory bag.

2.

Attach motor cable to terminals 96 (U), 97 (V), 98


(W).

3.

Connect to ground connection (terminal 99) on


decoupling plate with screws from the accessory
bag.

98

Figure 9.29 Star and Delta Connections

142

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

4.

Insert plug connectors 96 (U), 97 (V), 98 (W) (up


to 10 hp [7.5 kW]) and motor cable to terminals
labeled MOTOR.

5.

Fasten shielded cable to the decoupling plate


with screws and washers from the accessory bag.

V
U

96

97

98

130BT302.12

All types of three-phase asynchronous standard motors can


be connected to the adjustable frequency drive. Normally,
small motors are star-connected (230/400 V, Y). Large
motors are normally delta-connected (400/690 V, ). Refer
to the motor nameplate for correct connection mode and
voltage.

130BT337.10

Electrical Installation

MOTOR

MOTO
R
UVW

130BT333.10

99

Figure 9.31 Motor Connection for Enclosures A4/A5

Figure 9.30 Motor Connection for Enclosures A1, A2 and A3

Figure 9.32 Motor Connection for Enclosures B1 and B2

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

143

9 9

92
L2

93
L3

95

96
U

97
V

89
DC+

81
R-

130BA390.11

130BA726.10

88
DC91
L1

8
R+

98
W

99

130BA740.10

Figure 9.35 Motor Connection Enclosures C1 and C2 (IP21/


NEMA Type 1 and IP55/66/NEMA Type 12)

L1

Figure 9.33 Motor Connection for Enclosure B3

91

130BA721.10

9 9

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

U 96

V 97

W 98

L2

L3
U

92 9
3

99 96

97

98

DC-

DC+

88 89

R-

81

R+

82

96

97

98

Figure 9.36 Motor Connection for Enclosures C3 and C4

9.5 Ground Leakage Current Protection

L1 91 L2
92 L3 9
3
U 96 V
97 W 9
8

DC- 88 D
C

+89

R- 81
R+ 82

99

Figure 9.34 Motor Connection for Enclosure B4

144

Follow national and local codes regarding protective


grounding of equipment with a leakage current > 3.5 mA.
The protective ground connection must have a cross
section of minimum 10 mm2 or consist of two separate
wires each with the same cross-section as the phase wires.
Adjustable frequency drive technology implies high
frequency switching at high power. This generates a
leakage current in the ground connection.
The ground leakage current is made up of several contributions and depends on various system configurations
including RFI filtering, motor cable length, motor cable
shielding, and adjustable frequency drive power.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Leakage current
a

b
Motor cable length

Figure 9.37 Motor Cable Length and Power Size Influence on


Leakage Current. Powersize a > Powersize b

See EN/IEC61800-5-1 and EN50178 for further information.


Using RCDs
Where residual current devices (RCDs), also known as
ground leakage circuit breakers (GLCBs), are used, comply
with the following:

Use RCDs of type B only as they are capable of


detecting AC and DC currents

Use RCDs with a delay to prevent faults due to


transient ground currents

Dimension RCDs according to the system configuration and environmental considerations

The leakage current includes several frequencies


originating from both the line power frequency and the
switching frequency. Whether the switching frequency is
detected depends on the type of RCD used.

The leakage current also depends on the line distortion.

RCD with low f cut-

Leakage current

RCD with high f cut-

130BB956.12

Leakage current

130BB958.12

130BB955.12

Electrical Installation

THVD=0%
50 Hz

THVD=5%

Mains

150 Hz
3rd harmonics

f sw

Frequency

Cable

Figure 9.39 Main Contributions to Leakage Current

The amount of leakage current detected by the RCD


depends on the cut-off frequency of the RCD.

Figure 9.38 Line Distortion Influences Leakage Current

EN/IEC61800-5-1 (Power Drive System Product Standard)


requires special care if the leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA.
Grounding must be reinforced in one of the following
ways:

Ground wire (terminal 95) of at least 0.016 in2


[10 mm2]

Two separate ground wires both complying with


the dimensioning rules

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

145

9 9

130BB957.11

Design Guide

Leakage current [mA]

100 Hz
2 kHz
100 kHz

Figure 9.41 Relay Outputs 1 and 2

To set the relay output, see parameter group 5-4* Relays.


No.

Figure 9.40 The Influence of the Cut-off Frequency of the RCD


on What Is Responded to/Measured

01-02

make (normally open)

01-03

break (normally closed)

04-05

make (normally open)

04-06

break (normally closed)

Table 9.18 Description of Relays


130BA029.12

9 9

Electrical Installation

9.6 Additional Connections


Re

9.6.1 Relay

lay
2
Re

Relay 1

lay
1

Terminal 01: common


Terminal 02: normal open 240 V
Terminal 03: normal closed 240 V

35

36

Relay 2 (Not FC 301)


Terminal 04: common

Terminal 05: normal open 400 V


Terminal 06: normal closed 240 V

Relay 1 and relay 2 are programmed in 5-40 Function Relay,


5-41 On Delay, Relay and 5-42 Off Delay, Relay.
Additional relay outputs by using Relay Option Module
MCB 105.

146

Figure 9.42 Terminals for Relay Connection


(Enclosure Types A1, A2 and A3).

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

130BA391.12

9.6.2 Disconnectors and Contactors


Assembling of IP55/NEMA Type 12 (enclosure type A5)
with line power disconnector.
Line power switch is placed on left side on enclosure types
B1, B2, C1 and C2. Line power switch on A5 enclosures is
placed on right side.
130BD470.10

03 02 01

06 05 04

DC

RELAY 2

Design Guide

RELAY 1

Electrical Installation

Figure 9.43 Terminals for Relay Connection


(Enclosure Types C1 and C2).

130BA215.10

9 9

REL

AY
1

OF

REL

AY
2

05

04

01
311

Figure 9.44 Terminals for Relay Connection


(Enclosure Types A5, B1 and B2).

L1

L2

L3

31

43

T1

T2

T3

32

44

Enclosure type

Type

A4/A5

Kraus&Naimer KG20A T303

B1

Kraus&Naimer KG64 T303

B2

Kraus&Naimer KG64 T303

130BB182.10

90

03
02

Figure 9.45 Location of Line Power Switch

Figure 9.46 Terminal Connections for A4, A5, B1, B2

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

147

9 9

L1

T1

L2

L3

T2

T3

13

130BB181.10

Design Guide

Electrical Installation

The connection cable to the brake resistor must be


shielded and the max. length from adjustable frequency
drive to the DC bar is limited to 82 feet [25 m].
1.

Connect the shield by means of cable clamps to


the conductive backplate on the adjustable
frequency drive and to the metal cabinet of the
brake resistor.

2.

Size the brake cable cross-section to match the


brake torque.

14

Enclosure type

Type

C1

Kraus&Naimer KG100 T303

C1

Kraus&Naimer KG105 T303

C2

Kraus&Naimer KG160 T303

Terminals 81 and 82 are brake resistor terminals.

NOTICE!

Figure 9.47 Terminal Connections for C1, C2

9.6.3 Load Sharing


The DC bus terminal is used for DC backup, with the
intermediate circuit being supplied from an external
source. It uses terminals 88 and 89.
The connection cable must be shielded and the max.
length from the adjustable frequency drive to the DC bar
is limited to 82 ft [25 m].
Load sharing enables the linking of the DC intermediate
circuits of several adjustable frequency drives.

If a short circuit in the brake IGBT occurs, prevent power


dissipation in the brake resistor by using a line switch or
contactor to disconnect the line power from the
adjustable frequency drive. Only the adjustable
frequency drive should control the contactor.

CAUTION
Note that voltages up to 1,099 V DC, depending on the
supply voltage, may occur on the terminals.

9.6.5 PC Software
The PC is connected via a standard (host/device) USB
cable, or via the RS-485 interface.

CAUTION
Note that voltages up to 1099 V DC may occur on the
terminals.
Load sharing calls for extra equipment and safety
considerations.

CAUTION
Note that line power disconnect may not isolate the
adjustable frequency drive due to DC link connection.

148

9.6.4 Brake Resistor

USB is a serial bus utilizing four shielded wires with


Ground pin 4 connected to the shield in the PC USB port.
When connecting the PC to an adjustable frequency drive
through the USB cable, there is a potential risk of
damaging the PC USB host controller. All standard PCs are
manufactured without galvanic isolation in the USB port.
Any ground potential difference caused by not following
the recommendations described in AC Line Input
Connection in the Instruction Manual can damage the USB
host controller through the shield of the USB cable.
It is recommended to use a USB isolator with galvanic
isolation to protect the PC USB host controller from
ground potential differences when connecting the PC to
an adjustable frequency drive through a USB cable.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

130BT308.10

It is recommended not to use a PC power cable with a


ground plug when the PC is connected to the adjustable
frequency drive through a USB cable. It reduces the
ground potential difference, but does not eliminate all
potential differences due to the ground and shield
connected in the PC USB port.

Data transfer from PC to adjustable frequency drive via


MCT 10 Set-up Software
1.
Connect a PC to the unit via the USB COM port.
2.

Open MCT 10 Set-up Software.

3.

Select Open stored files are shown.

4.

Open the appropriate file.

5.

Select Write to drive.

All parameters are now transferred to the adjustable


frequency drive.
A separate manual for MCT 10 Set-up Software is available.
Download it from www.danfoss.com/BusinessAreas/DrivesSolutions/Softwaredownload/.

9.6.5.2 MCT 31
The MCT 31 harmonic calculation PC tool enables easy
estimation of the harmonic distortion in a given
application. Both the harmonic distortion of Danfoss
adjustable frequency drives as well as non-Danfoss
adjustable frequency drives with additional harmonic
reduction devices, such as Danfoss AHF filters and 1218pulse rectifiers, can be calculated.

Figure 9.48 USB Connection

9.6.5.1 MCT 10
To control the adjustable frequency drive from a PC, install
the MCT 10 Set-up Software.
Data storage in PC via MCT 10 Set-up Software
1.
Connect a PC to the unit via the USB COM port.
2.

Open MCT 10 Set-up Software.

3.

Select the USB port in the network section.

4.

Select copy.

5.

Select the project section.

6.

Select paste.

7.

Select Save as.

MCT 31 can also be downloaded from www.danfoss.com/


BusinessAreas/DrivesSolutions/Softwaredownload/.

9.6.5.3 Harmonic Calculation Software


(HCS)
HCS is an advanced version of the harmonic calculation
tool. The calculated results are compared to relevant
norms and can be printed afterwards.
See www.danfoss-hcs.com/Default.asp?LEVEL=START

All parameters are now stored.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

149

9 9

9 9

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

9.7 Additional Motor Information

9.7.2 Connection of Multiple Motors

9.7.1 Motor Cable

NOTICE!

Motor
U2

U1

V2

W2

V1

W1

175HA036.11

All types of three-phase asynchronous standard motors can


be used with an adjustable frequency drive unit. The
factory setting is for clockwise rotation with the adjustable
frequency drive output connected as follows:

Motor
U2

U1

97

V2

W2

V1

W1

97

VCC+ mode may be used in some applications.


The total current consumption of the motors
must not exceed the rated output current IINV for
the adjustable frequency drive.

Do not use common joint connection for long


cable lengths, see Figure 9.51.

The total motor cable length specified in


Table 5.2, is valid as long as the parallel cables are
kept short (less than 10 m each), see Figure 9.53
and Figure 9.54.

Consider voltage drop across the motor cable,


see Figure 9.54.

For long parallel cables, use LC filter, see


Figure 9.54.

For long cables without parallel connection, see


Figure 9.55.

98

FC
96

The adjustable frequency drive can control several motors


connected in parallel. When using parallel motor
connection observe the following:

FC
96

Problems may arise at start and at low RPM values if


motor sizes are widely different because small motors'
relatively high ohmic resistance in the stator calls for a
higher voltage at start and at low RPM values.

NOTICE!

98

When motors are connected in parallel, 1-02 Flux Motor


Feedback Source cannot be used, and 1-01 Motor Control
Principle must be set to [0] U/f.

Figure 9.49 Terminal Connection for Clockwise and Counterclockwise Rotation

The direction of rotation can be changed by switching two


phases in the motor cable or by changing the setting of
4-10 Motor Speed Direction.
Motor rotation check can be performed using 1-28 Motor
Rotation Check and following the steps shown in the
display.

150

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Figure 9.50 Common Joint Connection for Short Cable


Lengths

130BD777.10

130BD774.10

Electrical Installation

130BD778.10

130BD775.10

Figure 9.53 Parallel Cables with Load

9 9

Figure 9.51 Common Joint Connection for Long Cable


Lengths

130BD776.10

Figure 9.54 LC Filter for Long Parallel Cables

Figure 9.52 Parallel Cables without Load

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

151

9 9

Design Guide

130BD779.10

Electrical Installation

Figure 9.55 Long Cables in Series Connection

Enclosure types

Power Size (hp


[kW])

A1, A2, A4, A5

0.51
[0.370.75]

A2, A4, A5

1.52 [1.11.5]

A2, A4, A5

35 [2.24]

A3, A4, A5

7.510 [5.57.5]

B1, B2, B3, B4,


C1, C2, C3, C4

15100 [1175]

A3
B4
C3

Voltage [V]

1 cable (ft [m])

2 cables (ft [m])

3 cables (ft [m])

4 cables (ft [m])

400

500 [150]

145 [45]

26 [8]

20 [6]

500

500 [150]

23 [7]

13 [4]

10 [3]

400

500 [150]

145 [45]

66 [20]

26 [8]

500

500 [150]

145 [45]

16 [5]

13 [4]

400

500 [150]

145 [45]

66 [20]

36 [11]

500

500 [150]

145 [45]

66 [20]

20 [6]

400

500 [150]

145 [45]

66 [20]

36 [11]

500

500 [150]

145 [45]

66 [20]

36 [11]

400

500 [150]

250 [75]

165 [50]

120 [37]

500

500 [150]

250 [75]

165 [50]

120 [37]

1.510 [1.17.5]

525690

330 [100]

165 [50]

110 [33]

82 [25]

1130

525690

500 [150]

250 [75]

165 [50]

120 [37]

5060 [3745]

525690

500 [150]

250 [75]

165 [50]

120 [37]

Table 9.19 Max. Cable Length for Each Parallel Cable

152

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Electrical Installation

Design Guide

9.8 Safety
9.8.1 High Voltage Test
Carry out a high voltage test by short-circuiting terminals
U, V, W, L1, L2 and L3. Energize maximum 2.15 kV DC for
380500 V adjustable frequency drives and 2.525 kV DC for
525690 V adjustable frequency drives for one second
between this short-circuit and the chassis.

WARNING
When running high voltage tests of the entire installation, interrupt the line power and motor connection if
the leakage currents are too high.

9.8.2 EMC Grounding


Proper EMC grounding practice

Respect safety grounding.


Keeping the ground connection as short as
possible results in the best EMC performance.

Wires with greater square have a lower


impedance and better EMC grounding.

In cases where multiple devices with metal


cabinets are used, mount them on common
metal mounting plate to improve EMC
performance.

9 9

NOTICE!
If necessary, use washers for fastening bolts, e.g., in case
of painted parts.

CAUTION
POTENTIAL HAZARD IN THE EVENT OF INTERNAL
FAILURE
Risk of personal injury when the adjustable frequency
drive is not properly closed.

Before applying power, ensure all safety covers


are in place and securely fastened.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

153

10 Application Examples
10.1 Commonly Used Applications

Parameter settings are the regional default values


unless otherwise indicated (selected in
0-03 Regional Settings).

Parameters associated with the terminals and


their settings are shown next to the drawings.

Where switch settings for analog terminals A53 or


A54 are required, these are also shown.

CAUTION

Thermistors must use reinforced or double insulation to


meet PELV insulation requirements.

130BB930.10

Parameters

The examples in this section are intended as a quick


reference for common applications.

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

Function
1-29 Automatic
Motor
Adaptation
(AMA)

Setting
[1] Enable
complete
AMA

5-12 Terminal 27 [0] No


Digital Input
operation
*=Default Value
Notes/comments: Parameter
group 12* Motor Data must be
set according to motor

53

Parameters
12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

Function
1-29 Automatic
Motor
Adaptation
(AMA)

Setting
[1] Enable
complete
AMA

Table 10.2 AMA without T27 Connected

5-12 Terminal 27 [2]* Coast


Digital Input
inverse

Parameters
FC

*=Default Value
Notes/comments: Parameter
group 12* Motor Data must be
set according to motor

+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

+10 V
A IN

50

COM

20

53

D IN

27

A IN

54

D IN

29

COM

55

D IN

32

A OUT

42

D IN

33

COM

39

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

Table 10.1 AMA with T27 Connected

130BB926.10

FC
+24 V

130BB929.10

10 10

Design Guide

Application Examples

53

Function

Setting

6-10 Terminal 53 0.07 V*


Low Voltage
6-11 Terminal 53 10 V*
High Voltage
6-14 Terminal 53 0 RPM
Low Ref./Feedb.
Value
6-15 Terminal 53 1,500 RPM
High Ref./Feedb.
Value
*=Default Value

Notes/comments:

-10 - +10V

U-I

A53

Table 10.3 Analog Speed Reference (Voltage)

154

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

130BB927.10

Parameters
FC
12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

Setting

Speed

6-12 Terminal 53 4 mA*


Low Current
6-13 Terminal 53 20 mA*
High Current
6-14 Terminal 53 0 RPM
Low Ref./Feedb.
Value

Start (18)

Figure 10.1 Start/Stop with Safe Torque Off

6-15 Terminal 53 1,500 RPM


High Ref./Feedb.
Value

Parameters

*=Default Value

FC

130BB803.10

+24 V

Function

130BB805.11

Application Examples

Function

Setting

+10 V
A IN

50

+24 V

12

A IN

54

+24 V

13

COM

55

D IN

18

D IN

19

5-12 Terminal 27 [6] Stop


Digital Input
Inverse

COM

20

*=Default Value

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

Notes/comments:
If 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V

50

A IN

53

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

A OUT

42

COM

39

Notes/comments:

4 - 20mA

U-I

A53

Table 10.4 Analog Speed Reference (Current)

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10

50

A IN

53

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

130BB802.10

Parameters
Function

Setting

5-10 Terminal 18 [8] Start*


Digital Input

5-10 Terminal 18 [9] Latched


Digital Input
Start

is set to [0] No operation, a


jumper wire to terminal 27 is
not needed.

10 10

5-12 Terminal 27 [0] No


Digital Input
operation
5-19 Terminal 37 [1] Safe Stop
Safe Stop
Alarm

Table 10.6 Pulse Start/Stop

*=Default Value
Notes/comments:
If 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input

Speed

is set to [0] No operation, a


jumper wire to terminal 27 is
not needed.

130BB806.10

53

Latched Start (18)


Stop Inverse (27)

Table 10.5 Start/Stop Command with Safe Torque Off

MG33BF22

Figure 10.2 Latched Start/Stop Inverse

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

155

Design Guide

Application Examples

+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM
D IN
D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

Parameters
Setting

5-10 Terminal 18
Digital Input

[8] Start

5-11 Terminal 19
Digital Input

[10]
Reversing*

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

20

COM

20

27

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

53

5-12 Terminal 27
Digital Input

[0] No
operation

5-14 Terminal 32
Digital Input

[16] Preset
ref bit 0

5-15 Terminal 33
Digital Input

[17] Preset
ref bit 1

3-10 Preset
Reference
Preset
Preset
Preset
Preset

ref.
ref.
ref.
ref.

0
1
2
3

25%
50%
75%
100%

53

130BB683.10

FC

130BB934.10

Parameters
Function

Function

Setting

6-10 Terminal 53 0.07 V*


Low Voltage
6-11 Terminal 53 10 V*
High Voltage
6-14 Terminal 53 0 RPM
Low Ref./Feedb.
Value
6-15 Terminal 53 1,500 RPM
High Ref./Feedb.
Value
*=Default Value

5k Notes/comments:

U-I

*=Default Value
Notes/comments:

A53

Table 10.9 Speed Reference (using a Manual Potentiometer)

10 10
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

5-11 Terminal 19 [1] Reset


Digital Input

D IN

19

COM

20

*=Default Value

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

130BB928.10

Parameters
FC

FC

Function

Setting

Notes/comments:

53

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

130BB804.10

Parameters
Table 10.7 Start/Stop with Reversing and Four Preset Speeds

Function

Setting

5-10 Terminal 18 [8] Start*


Digital Input
5-12 Terminal 27 [19] Freeze
Digital Input
Reference
5-13 Terminal 29 [21] Speed
Digital Input
Up
5-14 Terminal 32 [22] Slow
Digital Input
*=Default Value
Notes/comments:

53

Table 10.8 External Alarm Reset


Table 10.10 Speed Up/Down

156

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

S peed
R efe rence

S tart ( 18 )
Freez e ref ( 27 )
S peed up ( 29 )
S peed down ( 32 )

Parameters
VLT

130BB686.12

130BB840.10

Application Examples

130BB685.10

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

Function

Setting

8-30 Protocol

FC*

8-31 Address

1*

8-32 Baud Rate

9,600*

Setting

1-90 Motor
Thermal
Protection

[2]
Thermistor
trip
[1] Analog
input 53

+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

1-93 Thermistor
Source

D IN

27

*=Default Value

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

Figure 10.3 Speed Up/Down

Parameters

Function

Notes/comments:
If only a warning is desired, set
1-90 Motor Thermal Protection
to [1] Thermistor warning.

53

U-I

*=Default Value
Notes/comments:
Select protocol, address, and
Baud rate in the parameters
mentioned above.

A53

Table 10.12 Motor Thermistor

10 10

53

R1

01
02
03

R2

04
05
RS-485

06
61
68
69

+
-

Table 10.11 RS-485 Network Connection

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

157

Application Examples

Design Guide

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

D IN

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

39

53

R1

01
02
03

R2

04

10 10

05
06

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

4-31 Motor
100 RPM
Feedback Speed
Error

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

4-32 Motor
Feedback Loss
Timeout

D IN

29

D IN

32

5s

Function

Setting

1-00 Configuration Mode

[0] Speed
open-loop

1-01 Motor
[1] VVCplus
Control Principle
5-40 Function
Relay

[32] Mech.
brake ctrl.

5-10 Terminal 18 [8] Start*


Digital Input

D IN

33

D IN

37

5-11 Terminal 19 [11] Start


Digital Input
reversing

+10 V
A IN

50

1-71 Start Delay

0.2

53

A IN

54

1-72 Start
Function

13-00 SL
[1] On
Controller Mode

COM

55

[5] VVCplus/
FLUX
Clockwise

A OUT

42

[19] Warning

39

1-76 Start
Current

Im,n

13-01 Start
Event

COM

13-02 Stop
Event

[44] Reset
key

01

2-20 Release
Brake Current

App.
dependent

13-10 Comparat
or Operand

[21] Warning
no.

04

2-21 Activate
Brake Speed
[RPM]

Half of
nominal slip
of the motor

13-11 Comparat
or Operator

[1] *

05

*=Default Value

06

Notes/comments:

13-12 Comparat
or Value

90

13-51 SL
Controller Event

[22]
Comparator 0

7-00 Speed PID [2] MCB 102


Feedback Source
17-11 Resolution 1024*
(PPR)

13-52 SL
[32] Set
Controller Action digital out A
low
5-40 Function
Relay

[80] SL digital
output A

*=Default Value
Notes/comments:
If the limit in the feedback
monitor is exceeded, Warning
90 is issued. The SLC monitors
Warning 90 and in the case
that Warning 90 becomes
TRUE, then relay 1 is triggered.
External equipment may
indicate that service is required.
If the feedback error goes
below the limit again within 5
s, the adjustable frequency
drive continues and the
warning disappears. But relay 1
is still triggered until [Reset] on
the LCP.

02
03

Table 10.14 Mechanical Brake Control (Open-loop)


130BB842.10

13

[1] Warning

130BB841.10

12

+24 V

4-30 Motor
Feedback Loss
Function

R1

+24 V

Parameters

Setting

R2

FC

130BB839.10

Parameters
Function

1-76
Current
Speed
1-71

Time
2-21 1-71

2-21

Start (18)
Start
reversing (19)

Relay output
Open
Closed

Figure 10.4 Mechanical Brake Control (Open-loop)

Table 10.13 Using SLC to Set a Relay

158

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Application Examples

Design Guide

10.1.2 Programming of Torque Limit and


Stop

10.1.1 Closed-loop Drive System


An adjustable frequency drive system consist usually of
more elements such as
Motor

Gearbox
Mechanical Brake
Adjustable frequency drive
Encoder as feedback system
Brake resistor for dynamic braking
Transmission
Load

130BA120.10

Applications demanding mechanical brake control usually


need a brake resistor.

Brake resistor

Transmission

Motor
Encoder

Mech. brake

Gearbox
Load

In applications with an external electro-mechanical brake,


such as hoisting applications, it is possible to stop the
adjustable frequency drive via a 'standard' stop command
and simultaneously activate the external electromechanical brake.
The example given below illustrates the programming of
adjustable frequency drive connections.
The external brake can be connected to relay 1 or 2.
Program terminal 27 to [2] Coast, inverse or [3] Coast and
Reset, inverse, and program terminal 29 to [1] Terminal
mode 29 Output and [27] Torque limit & stop.
Description
If a stop command is active via terminal 18 and the
adjustable frequency drive is not at the torque limit, the
motor ramps down to 0 Hz.
If the adjustable frequency drive is at the torque limit and
a stop command is activated, terminal 29 Output
(programmed to [27] Torque limit and stop) is activated.
The signal to terminal 27 changes from 'logic 1' to 'logic 0',
and the motor starts to coast, thereby ensuring that the
hoist stops even if the adjustable frequency drive itself
cannot handle the required torque (i.e., due to excessive
overload).

Start/stop via terminal 18


5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input, [8] Start

Quickstop via terminal 27


5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input, [2] Coasting Stop,
Inverse

Terminal 29 Output
5-02 Terminal 29 Mode, [1] Terminal 29 Mode
Output
5-31 Terminal 29 digital Output, [27] Torque Limit &
Stop

Relay output [0] (Relay 1)


5-40 Function Relay, [32] Mechanical Brake Control

Figure 10.5 Example of FC 302 Closed-loop Speed Control

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

159

10 10

18

19

32

GND

29

P 5-31 [27]

27

130BA194.10

13

P 5-02 [1]

12

Design Guide

P 5-12 [2]

+24V

P 5-10 [8]

Application Examples

33

20

37

Start

10.1.3 Programming of Speed Control


The required motor speed is set via a potentiometer
connected to terminal 53. The speed range is 0 to
1,500 RPM corresponding to 0 to 10 V over the potentiometer. Starting and stopping is controlled by a switch
connected to terminal 18. The Speed PID monitors the
actual RPM of the motor by using a 24 V (HTL) incremental
encoder as feedback. The feedback sensor is an encoder
(1024 pulses per revolution) connected to terminals
32 and 33.

I max

0.1 Amp

130BA174.10

L1
L2
L3
N
PE
External

F1

24 VDC
+

12

91 92 93 95

37
P 5-40 [0] [32]

L1 L2 L3 PE

01

18
50
53
55
39
20
32
33

02

Connection

03

Mechanical Brake

Relay 1

10 10

V W PE

96 97 98 99

Figure 10.6 External Electro-mechanical Brake

M
3

24 Vdc

Figure 10.7 Example - Speed Control Connections

160

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Application Examples

Design Guide

Application Example

FC
+24 V

12

+24 V

13

D IN

18

D IN

19

COM

20

D IN

27

D IN

29

D IN

32

130BB839.10

Parameters
Function

Setting

7-00 Speed PID [2] MCB 102


Feedback Source
17-11 Resolution 1024*
(PPR)
13-00 SL
[1] On
Controller Mode
13-01 Start
Event

[19] Warning

13-02 Stop
Event

[44] Reset
key

13-10 Comparat
or Operand

[21] Warning
no.

13-11 Comparat
or Operator

[1] *

33

D IN

37

+10 V
A IN

50

A IN

54

COM

55

A OUT

42

COM

13-12 Comparat
or Value

90

39
01

13-51 SL
Controller Event

[22]
Comparator 0

R1

D IN

53

02
03

R2

04
05
06

13-52 SL
[32] Set
Controller Action digital out A
low
5-40 Function
Relay

10 10

[80] SL digital
output A

* = Default Value
Notes/comments:
Warning 90 will be issued when
the feedback signal from the
encoder does not correspond
to the reference. The SLC
monitors Warning 90 and if
Warning 90 becomes TRUE,
then Relay 1 is triggered.
External equipment may then
indicate that service may be
required.
Table 10.15 Using SLC to Set a Relay

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

161

Design Guide

11 Options and Accessories


11.2.1.1 Galvanic Isolation in MCB 101

11.1 Communication Options


VLT PROFIBUS DP V1 MCA 101

VLT EtherCAT MCA 124


VLT PROFIBUS Drive MCA 114

If the digital inputs 7, 8 or 9 are to be switched by use of


the internal 24 V power supply (terminal 9), establish
connection between terminals 1 and 5, see Figure 11.2.

VLT PROFINET MCA 120


VLT EtherNet/IP MCA 121

Control card (FC 100/200/300)

VLT Modbus TCP MCA 122


VLT POWERLINK MCA 122

CPU
General Purpose
I/O option MCB 101

11.2 I/O, Feedback and Safety Options

0V

24V

CAN BUS

DeviceNet Converter MCA 194

CPU

11.2.1 VLT General Purpose I/O Module


MCB 101

0V

24V
DIG &
ANALOG
OUT

DIG IN

Fit MCB 101 into slot B in the VLT AutomationDrive.

X30/

ANALOG
IN
RIN=
10kohm

0/24VDC
DOUT4
0/24VDC
AOUT2
0/4-20mA
24V

DOUT3

GND(1)

DIN9

COM DIN

MCB 101 is used for extension of digital and analog inputs


and outputs of FC 301 and FC 302.

DIN8

RIN=
5kohm

DIN7

VLT

130BA209.10

CAN Open MCA 105

10

AIN4

DeviceNet MCA 104

VLT

Digital/analog inputs are galvanically isolated from other


inputs/outputs on the MCB 101 and in the control card of
the adjustable frequency drive. Digital/analog outputs in
the MCB 101 are galvanically isolated from other inputs/
outputs on the MCB 101, but not from these on the
control card of the adjustable frequency drive.

AIN3

VLT

GND(2)

11

12

MCB 101

FC Series

General Purpose I/O

B slot
Code No. 130BXXXX

DIN7

DIN8

DIN9

GND(1)

DOUT3

DOUT4

AOUT2

24V

GND(2)

AIN3

AIN4

SW. ver. XX.XX

X30/

10

11

12

Figure 11.1 MCB 101 Option

162

130BA208.10

Terminal cover
PLC
(PNP)
0V

<500 ohm

Extended fixture for LCP

>600 ohm

>600 ohm

Contents:
MCB 101 option module

COM
DIN

11 11

Options and Accessories

0-10
VDC

0-10
VDC

24V DC

PLC
(NPN)
24V DC

0V

Figure 11.2 Principle Diagram

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Digital input - terminal X30/1-4


Number of digital inputs
Terminal number
Logic
Voltage level
Voltage level, logic'0' PNP (GND = 0 V)
Voltage level, logic'1' PNP (GND = 0 V)
Voltage level, logic '0' NPN (GND = 24 V)
Voltage level, logic '1' NPN (GND = 24 V)
Maximum voltage on input
Pulse frequency ranges
Duty cycle, min. pulse width
Input impedance

3
X30.2, X30.3, X30.4
PNP or NPN
024 V DC
< 5 V DC
> 10 V DC
< 14 V DC
> 19 V DC
28 V continuous
0110 kHz
4.5 ms
> 2 k

Analog input - terminal X30/11, 12


Number of analog inputs
Terminal number
Modes
Voltage level
Input impedance
Max. voltage
Resolution for analog inputs
Accuracy of analog inputs
Bandwidth

2
X30.11, X30.12
Voltage
010 V
> 10 k
20 V
10 bit (+ sign)
Max. error 0.5% of full scale
FC 301: 20 Hz/ FC 302: 100 Hz

Digital outputs - terminal X30/6, 7


Number of digital outputs
Terminal number
Voltage level at digital/frequency output
Max. output current
Max. load
Max. capacitive load
Minimum output frequency
Maximum output frequency
Accuracy of frequency output

2
X30.6, X30.7
024 V
40 mA
600
< 10 nF
0 Hz
32 kHz
Max. error: 0.1% of full scale

Analog output - terminal X30/8


Number of analog outputs
Terminal number
Current range at analog output
Max. load GND - analog output
Accuracy on analog output
Resolution on analog output

1
X30.8
020 mA
500
Max. error: 0.5% of full scale
12 bit

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

163

11 11

11 11

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

11.2.2 VLT Encoder Option MCB 102


The encoder module can be used as feedback source for
closed-loop flux control (1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source)
as well as closed-loop speed control (7-00 Speed PID
Feedback Source). Configure encoder option in parameter
group 17-** Feedback Option.
Used for
VVCplus closed-loop

NOTICE!
The LEDs are only visible when removing the LCP.
Reaction in case of an encoder error can be selected in
17-61 Feedback Signal Monitoring: [0] Disabled, [1]
Warning or [2] Trip.
When the encoder option kit is ordered separately, the
kit includes
Encoder Option MCB 102

Enlarged LCP fixture and enlarged terminal cover

The encoder option does not support FC 302 adjustable


frequency drives manufactured before week 50/2004.
Min. software version: 2.03 (15-43 Software Version)

Flux Vector Speed control


Flux Vector Torque control
Permanent magnet motor

Supported encoder types:


Incremental encoder: 5 V TTL type, RS-422, max. frequency:
410 kHz
Incremental encoder: 1 Vpp, sine-cosine
Hiperface Encoder: Absolute and Sine-Cosine (Stegmann/
SICK)
EnDat encoder: Absolute and Sine-Cosine (Heidenhain)
Supports version 2.1
SSI encoder: Absolute

NOTICE!
Incremental encoders are not recommended for use with
PM motors due to risk of wrong polarity.

NOTICE!
It is strongly recommended to always supply the
encoder through the MCB 102. It shall be avoided to use
external power supply for the encoder.
Encoder monitor:
The 4 encoder channels (A, B, Z and D) are monitored,
open and short circuit can be detected. There is a green
LED for each channel which lights up when the channel is
OK.

164

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Connector
Designation
X31

Incremental
SinCos Encoder
Encoder (refer to Hiperface
Figure 11.3)
(refer to
Figure 11.4)

NC

NC

5 VCC

GND

A input

EnDat Encoder

SSI Encoder

Description

24 V*

24 V output (2125 V, Imax:125 mA)

5 VCC

5 V*

5 V output (5 V 5%, Imax: 200 mA)

GND

GND

GND

8 VCC

8 V Output (712 V, Imax: 200 mA)

+COS

+COS

A input

A inv input

REFCOS

REFCOS

A inv input

B input

+SIN

+SIN

B input

B inv input

REFSIN

REFSIN

Z input

+Data RS-485

Clock out

Clock out

Z input OR +Data RS-485

10

Z inv input

-Data RS-485

Clock out inv.

Clock out inv.

Z input OR -Data RS-485

11

NC

NC

Data in

Data in

Future use

12

NC

NC

Data in inv.

Data in inv.

Future use

B inv input

Max. 5 V on X31.5-12
Table 11.1 Encoder Connections

10

11

12

10

130BA164.10

Data -RS 485 (green)

Data +RS 485 (gray)

REFSIN (brown)

+SIN (white)

REFCOS (black)

+COS (pink)

5 V GND

GND (blue)

8V

Us 7-12V (red)

24 V

130BA163.11

* Supply for encoder: see data on encoder

11

12

Figure 11.3 Incremental Encoder

NOTICE!
Max. cable length 492 ft [150 m].

MG33BF22

Figure 11.4 SinCos Encoder Hiperface

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

165

11 11

11 11

Design Guide

130BA119.10

Options and Accessories

A
A
B

Resolver Poles

17-50 Poles: 2 *2

Resolver Input
Voltage

17-51 Input Voltage: 2.08.0 Vrms *7.0 Vrms

Resolver Input
Frequency

17-52 Input Frequency: 215 kHz


*10.0 kHz

Transformation ratio 17-53 Transformation Ratio: 0.11.1 *0.5

Secondary input
voltage

Max 4 Vrms

Secondary load

App. 10 k

Table 11.2 Resolver Specifications

MCB 103
Resolver Input
SW. ver. X.XX

Option B
Code No.

REF+
REFCOS+
COSSIN+
SINA+
AB+
BZ+
Z-

130BA247.11

X32/ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

Figure 11.5 Rotation Direction

11.2.3 VLT Resolver Option MCB 103


LED 1 REF OK
LED 2 COS OK
LED 3 SIN OK
LED NA

Resolver Option MCB 103 is used for interfacing resolver


motor feedback to VLT AutomationDrive. Resolvers are
used basically as motor feedback device for permanent
magnet brushless synchronous motors.
When the resolver option is ordered separately, the kit
includes:
Resolver Option MCB 103

Enlarged LCP fixture and enlarged terminal cover

Selection of parameters: 17-5* Resolver Interface.

R1

Rotor

S1

R1
R2
S1
S3
S2
S4

S3

R2
Resolver
stator

Resolver Option MCB 103 supports a various number of


resolver types.

REF+
REFCOS+
COSSIN+
SIN-

S4

S2

Motor

Figure 11.6 MCB 103 Resolver Input

LED indicators
LED 1 is on when the reference signal is OK to resolver.
LED 2 is on when cosine signal is OK from resolver
LED 3 is on when Sinus signal is OK from resolver.
The LEDs are active when 17-61 Feedback Signal Monitoring
is set to [1] Warning or [2] Trip.

166

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

130BT102.10

Options and Accessories

Figure 11.7 Permanent Magnet (PM) Motor with Resolver as


Speed Feedback

Set-up example
In this example, a permanent magnet (PM) motor is used
with resolver as speed feedback. A PM motor must usually
operate in flux mode.
Wiring
The max cable length is 500 ft [150 m] when a twisted-pair
cable is used.

11 11

NOTICE!
Resolver cables must be shielded and separated from the
motor cables.

NOTICE!
The shield of the resolver cable must be correctly
connected to the de-coupling plate and connected to
chassis (ground) on the motor side.

NOTICE!
Always use shielded motor cables and brake chopper
cables.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

167

11 11

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

1-00 Configuration Mode

[1] Speed closed-loop

1-01 Motor Control Principle

[3] Flux with feedback

1-10 Motor Construction

[1] PM, non-salient SPM

1-24 Motor Current

Nameplate

1-25 Motor Nominal Speed

Nameplate

1-26 Motor Cont. Rated Torque

Nameplate

AMA is not possible on PM motors


1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs)

Motor data sheet

30-80 d-axis Inductance (Ld)

Motor data sheet (mH)

1-39 Motor Poles

Motor data sheet

1-40 Back EMF at 1000 RPM

Motor data sheet

1-41 Motor Angle Offset

Motor data sheet (Usually zero)

17-50 Poles

Resolver data sheet

17-51 Input Voltage

Resolver data sheet

17-52 Input Frequency

Resolver data sheet

17-53 Transformation Ratio

Resolver data sheet

17-59 Resolver Interface

[1] Enabled

Table 11.3 Parameters to Adjust

11.2.4 VLT Relay Card MCB 105


The Relay Option MCB 105 includes three pieces of SPDT contacts and must be fitted into option slot B.
Electrical Data
Max terminal load (AC-1)1) (Resistive load)
Max terminal load (AC-15)1) (Inductive load @ cos 0.4)
Max terminal load (DC-1)1) (Resistive load)
Max terminal load (DC-13)1) (Inductive load)
Min terminal load (DC)
Max switching rate at rated load/min load
1)

240 V AC 2 A
240 V AC 0.2 A
24 V DC 1 A
24 V DC 0.1 A
5 V 10 mA
6 min-1/20 s-1

IEC 947 part 4 and 5

When the relay option kit is ordered separately the kit includes
Relay Module MCB 105

168

Enlarged LCP fixture and enlarged terminal cover


Label for covering access to switches S201, S202 and S801
Cable strips for fastening cables to relay module

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RK
A
M
0 32
EN
A0 G4
D
00 15
A E IN
BF 8
D 12
kV D
R1 0
.1 A
0B : .9A 11 M
B2 S/N 14 0A 3F
nt
z 6. 1
T5
rre
XP
0H 1 C/1
cu
e
XX 00 0/6 0Hz 45
1
ag
CIA N1 V 5 00 ax
ak
0
le
: XXX -48 0-1 b M
h
: 0 in m
hig st
T/C x38 -U Ta
.)
0
P/N : 3 3x P20
IN T: IS/I
U
O AS
CH

N: and tek min


IO / RCDFransk st (4
UTNUALUAL / : sk tek ENT UL
CAEE MA MAN ING/Fran QUIPMTUPE IN
S IR
N rge 261 L E SE
AR cha 134 TRO REFU
Wtored 76x1 L CONFOR P
VO

S
D IA L
TE STR UA S
LIS DU AN ION
IN E M AT
IC
SE PL
AP

How to add the Relay Card MCB 105 Option:


1.
Disconnect power to the adjustable frequency
drive.
2.

Disconnect power to the live part connections on


relay terminals.

3.

Remove the LCP, the terminal cover and the LCP


fixture from the adjustable frequency drive.

4.

Fit the MCB 105 option in slot B.

5.

Connect the control cables and fasten the cables


with the enclosed cable strips.

6.

Make sure the length of the stripped wire is


correct (see Figure 11.11).

7.

Do not mix live parts (high voltage) with control


signals (PELV).

8.

Fit the enlarged LCP fixture and enlarged


terminal cover.

9.

Replace the LCP.

10.

Connect power to the adjustable frequency drive.

11.

Select the relay functions in 5-40 Function Relay


[6-8], 5-41 On Delay, Relay [6-8] and 5-42 Off
Delay, Relay [6-8].

68

39

Re
12

13

42

50

mov
e ju

mpe
r to

18

19

53

54

activ
ate
Sa

fe

27

29

32

33

Stop

20

LA
BE
L

IMPORTANT! The label MUST be placed on the LCP frame as


shown (UL-approved).

Relay card

DC-

130BA710.11

Figure 11.8 Enclosure Types A2-A3-B3

DC+

50 53 5

to activate

18 19 27

Safe Stop

To access RS-485 termination switch S801 or current/


voltage switches S201/S202, dismount the relay card (see
Figure 11.8 and Figure 11.9, position 2).

IMPORTANT! The label MUST be placed on the LCP frame as


shown (UL-approved).

Relay card

Relay 7

Relay 8

Figure 11.9 Enclosure Types A5-B1-B2-B4-C1-C2-C3-C4

WARNING

MG33BF22

Relay 9

NC
1

Warning Dual supply

11 11

28 32 38
2

12 13

jumper

39 42

Remove

Array [6] is relay 7, array [7] is relay 8, and array [8] is


relay 9.

NOTICE!

61 6

LABE

NOTICE!

NC

NC

10

130BA162.10

61

130BA709.11

Design Guide

Options and Accessories

11

12

Figure 11.10 Relays

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

169

Design Guide

89m

2m

130BA177.10

Options and Accessories

The Safe PLC Interface Option MCB 108 is designed to be


built-in between the Safe dual pole (plus/minus) on the
Safe PLC and the Safe Stop input on FC 302. The Safe PLC
interface allows the safe output on the Safe PLC to
maintain the test pulses on the plus and minus output
without impacting the sensor signal to safe stop T37.
It can be used in combination with safety devices to satisfy
the requirement of IEC61800-5-2 SIL 2, ISO13849-1 cat. 3
for Safe Torque Off (STO).

NC

Live part

PELV

10

10

11

12

The option module MCB 108 is galvanically isolated via an


internal DC/DC drive and it can be fitted into option slot B.

11

12

11 11

1
1

130BA176.11

Figure 11.11 Correct Wire Inserting

11.2.5 VLT Safe PLC Interface Option MCB


108

10

11

12

Figure 11.12 Correct Relay Wiring

NOTICE!
Do not combine 24/48 V systems with high-voltage
systems.

170

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Input voltage (DC)


Typical current input (DC)
Max. current input (DC)
Max. current inrush (DC)
Output voltage (DC)
Turn on delay
Turn off delay

1828 V DC
60 mA
110 mA DC
500 mA DC
20 V DC@Vin = 24 V
1 ms
3 ms

Observe the following precautions


The FC 302 with MCB 108 (including the connections between X31/9 and Terminal 37) must be placed inside an
IP54 enclosure.

Safe Stop activation (i.e., removal of 24 V DC voltage supply to terminal 37 by removing voltage to dual pole input
of MCB 108) does not provide electrical safety.

The safety device connected to the dual pole input of the MCB 108 must fulfill the requirements of cat. 3 / PL d
according to ISO 13849-1 for interrupting the voltage/current to the MCB 108. This also applies for the connections
between the MCB 108 and the safety device.

Read and follow the instructions for the safety device to connect it properly to MCB 108.

11 11

MCB 108

Safe PLC
24 V DC
P - Control
P - Monitor

X31/2
X31/3

M - Monitor

FC 302

X31/9
GND

GX X31/10

37

Safe
channel

130BA831.11

Figure 11.13 Option Module Safe PLC Interface MCB 108

20

M - Monitor
GND

Figure 11.14 Safe PLC Interface MCB 108 Connection

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

171

Design Guide

11.2.6 VLT PTC Thermistor Card MCB 112


The MCB 112 option makes it possible to monitor the
temperature of an electrical motor through a galvanicallyisolated PTC thermistor input. It is a B option for adjustable
frequency drive with Safe Torque Off.

ATEX Certification with FC 102, FC 202 and FC 302


The MCB 112 has been certified for ATEX, which means
that the adjustable frequency drive with the MCB 112 can
be used with motors in potentially explosive atmospheres.
See the VLT PTC Thermistor Card MCB 112 Instruction
Manual for more information.

For different application possibilities, see


chapter 10 Application Examples.

ZIEHL

MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card

TP

DO

NC

10

11

DO FOR SAFE
STOP T37

NC

NC

NC

13

NC

NC

12

T2

NC

NC

Reference for 10, 12


20-28 VDC
10 mA
20-28 VDC
60 mA

11
10
12
X44

Option B
Code No.130B1137

Figure 11.16 ATmosphre EXplosive (ATEX)

130BA638.10

MS 220 DA
Motor protection

com

X44/1 and X44/2 are the thermistor inputs. X44/12 enables


Safe Torque Off of the adjustable frequency drive (T-37), if
the thermistor values make it necessary, and X44/10
informs the adjustable frequency drive that a request for
safe torque off came from the MCB 112 to ensure a
suitable alarm handling. One of the digital inputs
parameters (or a digital input of a mounted option) must
be set to [80] PTC Card 1 to use the information from
X44/10. Configure 5-19 Terminal 37 Safe Stop to the desired
Safe Torque Off functionality (default is Safe Stop Alarm).

T1

11 11

Options and Accessories

12

18 19 27 29 32 33
Control Terminals of FC302

20

37

TP
PTC
M3~

Figure 11.15 Installation of MCB 112

172

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Electrical Data
Resistor connection
PTC compliant with DIN 44081 and DIN 44082.
Number
Shut-off value
Reset value
Trigger tolerance
Collective resistance of the sensor loop
Terminal voltage
Sensor current
Short-circuit
Power consumption

1..6 resistors in series


3.3 .... 3.65 .... 3.85
1.7 .... 1.8 ... 1.95
6 C
< 1.65
2.5 V for R 3.65 , 9 V for R =
1 mA
20 R 40
60 mA

Testing conditions
EN 60 947-8
Measurement voltage surge resistance
Overvoltage category
Pollution degree
Measurement isolation voltage Vbis
Reliable galvanic isolation until Vi
Perm. ambient temperature

6000 V
III
2
690 V
500 V
-4F+140F [-20C+60C]
EN 60068-2-1 Dry heat
595%, no condensation permissible
10 to 1000 Hz 1.14 g
50 g

Moisture
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Safety system values
EN 61508 for Tu = 75 C ongoing
SIL

2 for maintenance cycle of 2 years


1 for maintenance cycle of 3 years
0
4.10 *10-3
78%
8494 FIT
934 FIT

HFT
PFD (for yearly functional test)
SFF
s + DD
DU
Ordering number 130B1137

11.2.7 VLT Extended Relay Card MCB 113


The MCB 113 adds seven digital inputs, two analog outputs and 4 SPDT relays to the standard I/O of the adjustable
frequency drive for increased flexibility and to comply with the German NAMUR NE37 recommendations.
The MCB 113 is a standard C1 option for the VLT AutomationDrive and is automatically detected after mounting.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

173

11 11

11 11

Relay 5
Relay 4

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
X46/

Relay 3

+
-DI7

+
Ext. 24 VDC
1 2
X48/

+
-DI1
+
-DI2
+
-DI3
+
DI4
+
DI5
+
DI6
-

+
A03
+
-A03
1 2 3 4
X45/

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
X47/
130BA965.10

Design Guide

Relay 6

Options and Accessories

Figure 11.17 Electrical Connections of MCB 113

MCB 113 can be connected to an external 24 V on X58/ to ensure galvanical isolation between the VLT AutomationDrive
and the option card. If galvanical isolation is not needed, the option card can be supplied through internal 24 V from the
adjustable frequency drive.

NOTICE!
It is OK to combine 24 V signals with high voltage signals in the relays as long as there is one unused relay in between.
To set up MCB 113, use parameter groups 5-1* Digital input, 6-7* Analog Output 3, 6-8* Analog output 4, 14-8* Options, 5-4*
Relays and 16-6* Inputs and Outputs.

NOTICE!
In parameter group 5-4* Relay, Array [2] is relay 3, array [3] is relay 4, array [4] is relay 5 and array [5] is relay 6.
Electrical Data
Relays
Numbers
Load at 250 V AC/30 V DC
Load at 250 V AC/30 V DC with cos = 0.4
Overvoltage category (contact - ground)
Overvoltage category (contact - contact)
Combination of 250 V and 24 V signals
Maximum thru-put delay
Isolated from ground/chassis for use on IT line power systems
Digital Inputs
Numbers
Range
Mode
Input impedance
Low trigger level
High trigger level
Maximum thru-put delay

7
0/24 V
PNP/NPN
4 kW
6.4 V
17 V
10 ms

Analog Outputs
Numbers
Range
Resolution
Linearity

174

4 SPDT
8A
3.5 A
III
II
Possible with one unused relay in between
10 ms

2
0/420 mA
11 bit
<0.2%

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

11.2.8 VLT Sensor Input Option MCB 114


The sensor input option card MCB 114 can be used in the following cases:

Sensor input for temperature transmitters PT100 and PT1000 for monitoring bearing temperatures

Support extended PID controllers with I/Os for setpoint, transmitter/sensor inputs

As general extension of analog inputs with one additional input for multi-zone control or differential pressure
measurements

Typical motors, designed with temperature sensors to protect bearings from being overloaded, are fitted with 3 PT100/1000
temperature sensors; one in front, one in the backend bearing, and one in the motor windings. The Danfoss Option MCB
114 supports 2- or 3-wire sensors with individual temperature limits for under/over temperature. An auto detection of
sensor type PT100 or PT1000 takes place at power-up.
The option can generate an alarm if the measured temperature is either below the low limit or above the high limit
specified by the user. The individual measured temperature on each sensor input can be read out in the display or by
readout parameters. If an alarm occurs, the relays or digital outputs can be programmed to be active high by selecting [21]
Thermal Warning in parameter group 5-** Digital In/Out.
A fault condition has a common warning/alarm number associated with it, which is Alarm/Warning 20, Temp. input error.
Any present output can be programmed to be active in case the warning or alarm appears.

11.2.8.1 Electrical and Mechanical Specifications


Analog Input
Number of analog inputs
Format
Wires
Input impedance
Sample rate
Third order filter
The option is able to supply the analog sensor with 24 V
DC (terminal 1).
Temperature Sensor Input
Number of analog inputs supporting PT100/1000
Signal type
Connection
Frequency PT100 and PT1000 input
Resolution

1
020 mA or 420 mA
2
<200
1 kHz
100 Hz at 3 dB

3
PT100/1000
PT 100 2 or 3 wire/PT1000 2 or 3 wire
1 Hz for each channel
10 bit
-50204 C
-58399 F

Temperature range

Galvanic Isolation
The sensors to be connected are expected to be galvanically isolated from the AC line voltage
level.
Cabling
Maximum signal cable length

MG33BF22

IEC 61800-5-1 and UL508C

1,640 ft [500 m]

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

175

11 11

11 11

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

11.2.9 VLT Safe Option MCB 15x

11.2.8.2 Electrical Wiring

NOTICE!
Option B

SW. ver. xx.xx

Code No. 130B1272

VDD

I IN

For more information on MCB 15x, see the MCB 15x Safe
Option Instruction Manual.
130BC308.10

MCB 114
Sensor Input

GND TEMP WIRE GND TEMP WIRE GND TEMP WIRE GND
1
1
2
2
3
3

130BB326.10

PLC

X48/ 1

9 10 11 12

2 or 3
wire

2 or 3
wire

Terminal

Name

Function

VDD

24 V DC to supply 420 mA
sensor

I in

420 mA input

GND

Analog input GND

4, 7, 10

Temp 1, 2, 3

Temperature input

5, 8, 11

Wire 1, 2, 3

Third wire input if three wire


sensors are used

6, 9, 12

GND

Field bus
Interface

2 or 3
wire

Internal Bus 1

C
MCB 150/151
Safety Option

Option B

4-20mA
2 or 3
wire

Option A

Control Card

Internal Bus 2
IGBT

37 STO
ERGENCY
EM

ST OP

Temp. input GND


E

Figure 11.18 MCB 114

Figure 11.19 Safe Drive System

The MCB 15x performs safety functions in accordance with


EN IEC 61800-5-2. It monitors safe motion sequences on
adjustable frequency drives, which are safely brought to a
stop and shut down in the event of an error.
The MCB 15x is built into a VLT AutomationDrive FC 302
and requires a signal from a sensor unit. A safe drive
system from Danfoss consists of the following

176

Adjustable frequency drive, VLT


AutomationDrive FC 302

MCB 15x built into the adjustable frequency drive

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

evaluates signals from safety devices, such as

activates the selected failure reaction Safe Torque


Off or Safe Stop 1 in the event of an error

Light curtain devices

processes the MCB 15x status function

provides fault detection at activation of safety


functions (shorts across contacts, short circuit) on
signal between the safety control system and
MCB 15x

provides safe connection between MCB 15x and


safety control system

MCB 150
Safe Option

Option B
130B3280

TTL Enc. interface


SW. ver. 1 .xx

1 2

3 4

130BC306.10

Front View

ENC nB

Y30/ 1

11 11

S37

GND

LED:

24V

The MCB 15x can be used to monitor the stopping,


starting or speed of a rotating or laterally moving device.
As speed monitor, the option is often used in combination
with hard guarding, access doors, and safety gates with
solenoid-lock or -unlock safety switches. When the speed
of the monitored device drops below the set switch point
(where its speed is no longer considered dangerous), the
MCB 15x sets S37 output low. This allows the operator to
open the safety gate. In speed monitor applications, the
safety output S37 is high for operation (when the motor
speed of the monitored device is below the set switch
point). When the speed exceeds the set value, indicating a
too-high (dangerous) speed, the safety output is low.

Interlocking switch

DI2 B

The MCB 15x Safe Option is constructed as a standard


option for the VLT AutomationDrive FC 302 and is
automatically detected after mounting.

Non-Contact Magnetic switch

ENC B

There are two variants of the MCB 15x, one with HTL
encoder interface (MCB 151) and one with TTL encoder
interface (MCB 150).

E-STOP push buttons

ENC nA

signals the status of safety functions to the safety


control system via possible connected Profibus
serial communication bus

activates the safety functions via inputs on the


MCB 15x

DI2 A

monitors safe motion sequences

ENC A

activates safety functions

DI1 A

The safety control system

GND

The MCB 15x

DI1 B

Options and Accessories

9 10 11 12

Figure 11.20 MCB 150

removes the power to the motor,


switches the motor to torque-free, if Safe Torque
Off is activated

MCB 151

Option B
130B3290

Safe Option
HTL Enc. interface
SW. ver. 1 .xx

1 2

3 4

GND

130BC307.10

The adjustable frequency drive

ENC A

DI2 A

GND

ENC B

DI2 B

S37

DI1 B

GND

GND

Y31/

24V

DI1 A

LED:

9 10 11 12

Figure 11.21 MCB 151

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

177

11 11

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Technical Specifications
MCB 150/MCB 151
Power consumption
Current consumption VCC (5 V)
Current consumption VDD (24 V)

2 W (equivalent power consumption related to VDD)


< 200 mA
< 30 mA (< 25 mA for MCB 150)

Digital inputs
Number of digital inputs
Input voltage range
Input voltage, logic '0'
Input voltage, logic '1'
Input voltage (max)
Input current (min)
Input resistance
Galvanic isolation
Short circuit-proof
Input pulse recognition time (min)
Discrepancy time (min)

4 (2 x 2-channel Digital Safety Input)


0 to 24 V DC
< 5 V DC
> 12 V DC
28 V DC
6 mA @Vin=24 V (inrush current 12 mA peak)
approx. 4 k
No
Yes
3 ms
9 ms
< 110 ft [30 m] (shielded or non-shielded cable)
> 110 ft [30 m] (shielded cable)

Cable length
Digital output (Safe output)
Number of outputs
Output voltage low
Output voltage high
Output voltage (max)
Nominal output current (@24 V)
Nominal output current (@0 V)
Galvanic Isolation
Diagnostic test pulse
Short circuit-proof
Cable length

1
< 2 V DC
> 19.5 V DC
24.5 V DC
< 100 mA
< 0.5 mA
No
300 us
Yes
< 110 ft [30 m] (shielded cable)

TTL encoder input (MCB 150)


Number of encoder inputs
4 (2 x differential inputs A/A, B/B)
Encoder types
TTL, RS-422/RS-485 incremental encoders
Input differential voltage range
-7 to +12 V DC
Input common mode voltage
-12 to +12 V DC
Input voltage, logic '0' (diff)
< -200 mV DC
Input voltage, logic '1' (diff)
> +200 mV DC
Input resistance
approx. 120
Maximum frequency
410 KHz
Short circuit-proof
Yes
Cable
< 500 ft [150 m] (Tested with shielded cable - Heidenhain AWM Style 20963 176F [80C] 30 V E63216, 330 ft
length
[100 m] shielded motor cable, no load on motor)

178

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

HTL encoder input (MCB 151)


Number of encoder inputs
2 (2 x single ended inputs A; B)
Encoder types
HTL incremental encoders; HTL Proximity sensor
Logic input
PNP
Input voltage range
0 to 24 V DC
Input voltage, logic '0'
< 5 V DC
Input voltage, logic '1'
> 12 V DC
Input voltage (max)
28 V DC
Input resistance
approx. 4
Maximum frequency
110 kHz
Short circuit-proof
Yes
Cable
< 330 ft [100 m] (Tested with shielded cable - Heidenhain AWM Style 20963 176F [80C] 30 V E63216, 330 ft
length
[100 m] shielded motor cable, no load on motor)
24 V supply output
Supply voltage
Maximum output current
Short circuit-proof
Cable length

24 V DC (Voltage tolerance: +0.5 V DC to -4.5 V DC)


150 mA
Yes
< 110 ft [30 m] (shielded or non-shielded cable)
> 110 ft [30 m] (shielded cable)

Ground I/O section


Cable length
Cable cross-sections
Digital inputs/output supply voltage

< 110 ft [30 m] (shielded or non-shielded cable)


> 110 ft [30 m] (shielded cable)

0.75 mm2/AWG 18, AEH without plastic collar in accordance with DIN 46228/1

Reset characteristics

Manual reset time


Manual reset pulse time
Automatic reset time
Start-up reset time

5 ms (MCB 15x)
5 ms (adjustable frequency drive)
10 ms (serial communication bus)
10 s (MCB 15x and adjustable frequency drive)
4 ms
5 s (42-90 Restart Safe Option)

Response time
Input to output response time
Emergency stop until beginning of SS1/SLS
Cross fault detection time

MG33BF22

2 ms
7 ms
3 ms (@activated output)

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

179

11 11

11 11

Design Guide

11.2.10 VLT C Option Adapter MCF 106

2
1

The C Option Adapter MCF 106 makes it possible to add


an additional B option to the adjustable frequency drive.
One A and one B option can be installed in the standard A
and B slots of the control card and up to two B options
can be installed in the C Option Adapter.
For further information, see the VLT AutomationDrive FC
300, C Option Adapter MCF 106 Installation Instructions.

X62

X60

130BB794.10

Options and Accessories

X55

11.3 Motion Control Options


Ordering
Motion Control Options (MCO) are supplied either as
option cards for field installation or as built-in options. For
retrofit, purchase a mounting kit. Each enclosure has its
own mounting kit. MCO 3xx is to be used in slot C0, but
can be combined with another option in slot C1.
Mounting kit depending on enclosure type

Order no.

Bookstyle
A2 and A3 (1.58 in [40 mm] for one C option)

130B7530

A2 and A3 (2.36 in [60 mm] for C0 + C1 option)

130B7531

B3 (1.58 [40 mm] for one C option)

130B1413

B3 (2.36 in [60 mm] for C0 + C1 option)

130B1414

X56

X57

X58

Compact
A5

130B7532

B, C, D, E and F (except B3)

130B7533

Table 11.4 Mounting Kit Ordering Numbers

X59

Technical specifications
For enclosures A5, B1 and B2 all MCO 3xx terminals are
located next to the control card. Remove the front cover
to get access.
MCO control terminals are plug connectors with screw
terminals. Terminals X55, X56, X57, X58 and X59 are
duplicated to be used for both bookstyle and compact
enclosures.

Terminal block for bookstyle

Terminal block for compact

X55

Encoder 2

X56

Encoder 1

X57

Digital inputs

X58

24 V DC supply

X59

Digital outputs

X62

MCO CAN Bus

X60

Debug connections (RS-485)

Figure 11.22 Location of Terminal Blocks

180

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

Terminal Overview

Terminal number

Descriptive Name Digital outputs

Digital Output/Input

Digital Output/Input

Digital Output

Digital Output

Digital Output

Digital Output

Digital Output

Digital Output

Terminal number

Descriptive Name Encoder 2


(Feedback)

+24 V Supply

+8 V Supply

+5 V Supply

GND

A not

B not

Z/Clock

Terminal number

MCO Debug (RS-485)

10

Z not/Clock not

1CS

Control Select

11

DATA

62

RxD/TxD - P

12

DATA not

63

RxD/TxD - N

66

0V

67

+5 V

Table 11.9 Terminal Block X59

Table 11.5 Terminal Block X55


Terminal number

Descriptive Name Encoder 1 (Master)

+24 V Supply

N/A

Terminal number

MCO CAN Bus

+5 V Supply

N/A

GND

CAN - L

DRAIN

A not

CAN - H

N/A

B not

Z/Clock

10

Z not/Clock not

11

DATA

12

DATA not

Table 11.10 Terminal Block X60

11.3.1 VLT Motion Control Option MCO


305

Table 11.6 Terminal Block X56

The MCO 305 is an integrated free programmable motion


controller for FC 301 and FC 302, for more information, see
chapter 11.3.1 Motion Control Options.

Terminal number

Descriptive Name Digital inputs

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

Digital Input

NOTICE!

10

Digital Input

Terminal block X62 is not supported for MCO 350.

Table 11.7 Terminal Block X57


Terminal number

Descriptive Name Supply

+24 V Supply

GND

Table 11.8 Terminal Block X58

MG33BF22

11 11

Table 11.11 Terminal Block X62

11.3.2 VLT Synchronizing Controller MCO


350

NOTICE!
Terminal block X59 has fixed functionality for MCO 350.

NOTICE!
Terminal block X60 is not used for MCO 350.
For more information, see chapter 11.3.1 Motion Control
Options.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

181

11 11

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

11.3.3 VLT Positioning Controller MCO


351

NOTICE!
Terminal block X59 has fixed functionality for MCO 351.

The filter reduces the ramp-up time of the voltage, the


peak load voltage UPEAK and the ripple current I to the
motor, which means that current and voltage become
almost sinusoidal. Consequently, the acoustic motor noise
is reduced to a minimum.

Terminal block X62 is not supported for MCO 351.

The ripple current in the sine-wave filter coils also causes


some noise. Solve the problem by integrating the filter in a
cabinet or similar.

NOTICE!

11.4.3 dU/dt Filters

NOTICE!

Terminal block X60 is not used for MCO 351.


For more information, see chapter 11.3.1 Motion Control
Options.

11.4 Accessories
11.4.1 Brake Resistors
In applications where the motor is used as a brake, energy
is generated in the motor and sent back into the
adjustable frequency drive. If the energy cannot be
transported back to the motor, it increases the voltage in
the adjustable frequency drive DC line. In applications with
frequent braking and/or high inertia loads, this increase
may lead to an overvoltage trip in the adjustable
frequency drive and finally a shutdown. Brake resistors are
used to dissipate the excess energy resulting from the
regenerative braking. The resistor is selected in respect to
its ohmic value, its power dissipation rate and its physical
size. Danfoss offers a wide variety of different resistors that
are specially designed to our adjustable frequency drives.
See chapter 5.5.3 Control with Brake Function for
dimensioning of brake resistors. Code numbers can be
found in chapter 7 How to Order.

Compared to sine-wave filters (see chapter 11.4.2 Sine-wave


Filters), the dU/dt filters have a cut-off frequency above the
switching frequency.

11.4.4 Common Mode Filters


High frequency common mode cores reduce electromagnetic interference and eliminate bearing damage by
electrical discharge. They are special nanocrystalline
magnetic cores which have superior filtering performance
compared to regular ferrite cores. They act like a commonmode inductor (between phases and ground).
Installed around the three motor phases (U, V, W), the
common mode filters reduce high-frequency common
mode currents. As a result, high frequency electromagnetic
interference from the motor cable is reduced.

11.4.5 Harmonic Filters

11.4.2 Sine-wave Filters


When a motor is controlled by an adjustable frequency
drive, resonance noise is heard from the motor. This noise,
which is the result of the motor design, arises every time
an inverter switch in the adjustable frequency drive is
activated. The frequency of the resonance noise thus
corresponds to the switching frequency of the adjustable
frequency drive.
For the FC 300, Danfoss supplies a sine-wave filter to
dampen the acoustic motor noise.

182

dU/dt filters are differential-mode low-pass filters which


reduce motor terminal phase-to-phase peak voltages and
reduce the rise time to a level that lowers the stress on the
insulation at the motor windings. This is especially an issue
at short motor cables.

The Danfoss AHF 005 and AHF 010 are advanced harmonic
filters not to be compared with traditional harmonic trap
filters. The Danfoss harmonic filters have been specially
designed to match the Danfoss adjustable frequency
drives.
By connecting the Danfoss harmonic filters AHF 005 or
AHF 010 in front of a Danfoss adjustable frequency drive,
the total harmonic current distortion generated back to
line power is reduced to 5% and 10% respectively.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

11.4.6 IP21/Type 1 Enclosure Kit

130BT324.10

Design Guide

Options and Accessories

IP20/IP4X top/TYPE 1 is an optional enclosure element


available for IP20 compact units.
If the enclosure kit is used, an IP20 unit is upgraded to
comply with enclosure IP21/4X top/TYPE 1.

130BT323.10

The IP4X top can be applied to all standard IP20 FC 300


variants.

11 11

C
E
D

Figure 11.23 Enclosure Type A2

Figure 11.24 Enclosure Type A3

Top cover

Brim

Base part

Base cover

Screw(s)

Table 11.12 Legend to Figure 11.23 and Figure 11.24

Place the top cover as shown. If an A or B option is used,


the brim must be fitted to cover the top inlet. Place the
base part C at the bottom of the adjustable frequency
drive and use the clamps from the accessory bag to
correctly fasten the cables.
Holes for cable connectors:
Size A2: 2x M25 and 3xM32

MG33BF22

Size A3: 3xM25 and 3xM32

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

183

Enclosure type

Height A
(in [mm])

Width B
(in [mm])

Depth C*
(in [mm])

A2

14.65 [372]

3.54 [90]

8.07 [205]

A3

14.65 [372]

5.12 [130]

8.07 [205]

B3

18.70 [475]

6.50 [165]

9.8 [249]

B4

26.38 [670]

10.04 [255]

9.69 [246]

C3

29.72 [755]

12.95 [329]

13.27 [337]

C4

37.40 [950]

15.39 [391]

13.27 [337]

130BT621.12

Design Guide

Options and Accessories

Table 11.13 Dimensions

130BT620.12

* If option A/B is used, the depth increases (see


chapter 8.2.1 Mechanical Dimensions for details)

A
B

11 11

D
F

Figure 11.25 Enclosure Type B3

Figure 11.26 Enclosure Types B4 - C3 - C4

Top cover

Brim

Base part

Base cover

Screw(s)

Fan cover

Top clip

Table 11.14 Legend to Figure 11.25 and Figure 11.25

184

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Options and Accessories

Design Guide

130BA200.10

NOTICE!
Side-by-side installation is not possible when using the
IP21/IP4X/TYPE 1 Enclosure Kit.

11.4.7 Remote Mounting Kit for LCP


The LCP can be moved to the front of a cabinet by using
the remote built-in kit. The enclosure is the IP66. The
fastening screws must be tightened with a torque of max.
1 Nm.
The LCP enclosure is rated IP66
Enclosure

IP66 front

Max. cable length between and unit

10 ft [3 m]

Communication std

Figure 11.28 LCP Kit with Numerical LCP, Fasteners and


Gasket
Ordering no. 130B1114

RS-485

130BA138.10

Table 11.15 Technical Data

11 11

Figure 11.27 LCP Kit with Graphical LCP, Fasteners, 10 ft [3 m]


Cable and Gasket
Ordering No. 130B1113

MG33BF22

Figure 11.29 Dimensions

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

185

Design Guide

Step 2
130BA845.10

130BA138.10

Options and Accessories

Figure 11.30 LCP Kit with Graphical LCP, Fasteners, 10 ft [3 m]


Cable and Gasket, for US only

Figure 11.32 Upper Bracket

11.4.8 Mounting Bracket for Enclosure


Types A5, B1, B2, C1 and C2
130BA844.10

Step 1

11 11

Measure distance A or B, and position the upper bracket,


but do not tighten it. See dimensions in Table 11.16.
Enclosure
A5

IP
55/66

A (ins [mm]) B (ins [mm])

Ordering
number

18.90 [480]

19.49 [495]

B1

21/55/66 21.06 [535]

21.65 [550]

130B1080
130B1081

B2

21/55/66 27.76 [705]

28.35 [720]

130B1082

B3

21/55/66 28.74 [730]

29.33 [745]

130B1083

B4

21/55/66 32.28 [820]

32.87 [835]

130B1084

Table 11.16 Details

Figure 11.31 Lower Bracket

Position the lower bracket and mount it with screws. Do


not tighten the screws completely, as this will make it
difficult to mount the adjustable frequency drive.

186

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Step 3

Step 4
130BA846.10

130BA847.10

Options and Accessories

11 11

Figure 11.34 Tightening of Screws


Figure 11.33 Positioning

Place the adjustable frequency drive in the lower bracket,


and lift the upper one. When the adjustable frequency
drive is in place, lower the upper bracket.

MG33BF22

Now tighten the screws. For extra security, drill and mount
screws in all holes.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

187

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12 RS-485 Installation and Set-up


12.1 Installation and Set-up
12.1.1 Overview
RS-485 is a two-wire bus interface compatible with multi-drop network topology, that is, nodes can be connected as a bus,
or via drop cables from a common trunk line. A total of 32 nodes can be connected to one network segment.
Repeaters divide network segments, see Figure 12.1.

Figure 12.1 RS-485 Bus Interface

NOTICE!
Each repeater functions as a node within the segment in which it is installed. Each node connected within a given
network must have a unique node address across all segments.
Terminate each segment at both ends using either the termination switch (S801) of the adjustable frequency drives or a
biased termination resistor network. Always use shielded twisted pair (STP) cable for bus cabling and follow good common
installation practice.
Low-impedance ground connection of the shield at every node is important, including at high frequencies. Thus, connect a
large surface of the shield to ground, for example with a cable clamp or a conductive cable connector. It may be necessary
to apply potential-equalizing cables to maintain the same ground potential throughout the network - particularly in installations with long cables.
To prevent impedance mismatch, always use the same type of cable throughout the entire network. When connecting a
motor to the adjustable frequency drive, always use shielded motor cable.
Cable

Shielded twisted pair (STP)

Impedance []

120

Cable length [m]

Max. 4,000 ft [1,200 m] (including drop lines)


Max. 1,650 ft [500 m] station-to-station

Table 12.1 Cable Specifications

188

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.2 Network Connection

12.3 Bus Termination

One or more adjustable frequency drives can be connected


to a control (or master) using the RS-485 standardized
interface. Terminal 68 is connected to the P signal
(TX+, RX+), while terminal 69 is connected to the N signal
(TX-,RX-). See drawings in chapter 3.5 Wiring Schematic.

The RS-485 bus must be terminated by a resistor network


at both ends. For this purpose, set switch S801 on the
control card to "ON".

RS 485

68

69

68

69

68

69

Figure 12.2 Parallel Connections

61 68 69

39

42

50

53

54

130BB021.10

To avoid potential equalizing currents in the shield, ground


the cable shield via terminal 61, which is connected to the
frame via an RC link.

55

Remove jumper to enable Safe Stop


12

13

18

19

27

29

32

33

20

12.4.1 EMC Precautions


The following EMC precautions are recommended to
achieve interference-free operation of the RS-485 network.
Observe relevant national and local regulations, for
example regarding protective ground connection. Keep the
RS-485 communication cable away from motor and brake
resistor cables to avoid coupling of high frequency noise
from one cable to another. Normally a distance of 200 mm
(8 inches) is sufficient, but keeping the greatest possible
distance between the cables is recommended, especially
where cables run in parallel over long distances. When
crossing is unavoidable, the RS-485 cable must cross motor
and brake resistor cables at an angle of 90.
130BD507.11

RS 232
USB

12.4 RS-485 Installation and Set-up

Fieldbus cable

130BA060.11

If more than one adjustable frequency drive is connected


to a master, use parallel connections.

Communication protocol must be set to 8-30 Protocol.

12 12

37

Min. 200 mm

90 crossing

Brake resistor

Figure 12.3 Control Card Terminals

MG33BF22

Figure 12.4 Cable Routing

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

189

Design Guide

12.5 FC Protocol Overview


The FC protocol, also referred to as FC bus or Standard
bus, is the Danfoss standard serial communication bus. It
defines an access technique according to the masterfollower principle for communications via a serial bus.
One master and a maximum of 126 followers can be
connected to the bus. The master selects the individual
followers via an address character in the message. A
follower itself can never transmit without first being
requested to do so, and direct message transfer between
the individual followers is not possible. Communications
occur in the half-duplex mode.
The master function cannot be transferred to another node
(single-master system).
The physical layer is RS-485, thus utilizing the RS-485 port
built into the adjustable frequency drive. The FC protocol
supports different message formats:

12.7 FC Protocol Message Framing


Structure
12.7.1 Content of a Character (byte)
Each character transferred begins with a start bit. Then 8
data bits are transferred, corresponding to a byte. Each
character is secured via a parity bit. This bit is set at "1"
when it reaches parity. Parity is when there is an equal
number of 1s in the 8 data bits and the parity bit in total.
A stop bit completes a character, thus consisting of 11 bits
in all.

Figure 12.5 Content of a Character

A short format of 8 bytes for process data


A long format of 16 bytes that also includes a
parameter channel

12.7.2 Message Structure

A format used for texts

Each message has the following structure:

12.6 Network Configuration


12.6.1 Adjustable Frequency Drive Set-up
Set the following parameters to enable the FC protocol for
the adjustable frequency drive.
Parameter Number

Setting

8-30 Protocol

Adjustable Frequency Drive

8-31 Address

1126

8-32 FC Port Baud Rate

2400115200

8-33 Parity / Stop Bits

Even parity, 1 stop bit (default)

Table 12.2 FC Protocol Parameters

1.

Start character (STX)=02 hex

2.

A byte denoting the message length (LGE)

3.

A byte denoting the adjustable frequency drive


address (ADR)

A number of data bytes (variable, depending on the type


of message) follows.
A data control byte (BCC) completes the message.

STX

LGE

ADR

DATA

BCC

195NA099.10

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Figure 12.6 Message Structure

190

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

RS-485 Installation and Set...

12.7.3 Message Length (LGE)


The message length is the number of data bytes plus the
address byte ADR and the data control byte BCC.
4 data bytes

LGE=4+1+1=6 bytes

12 data bytes

LGE=12+1+1=14 bytes

Messagescontaining texts

101)+n bytes

Table 12.3 Length of Messages


1)

The 10 represents the fixed characters, while the n is variable


(depending on the length of the text).

12.7.4 Adjustable Frequency Drive Address


(ADR)
Two different address formats are used.
The address range of the adjustable frequency drive is
either 1-31 or 1-126.
1. Address format 1-31:
Bit 7 = 0 (address format 1-31 active)
Bit 6 is not used
Bit 5 = 1: Broadcast, address bits (0-4) are not
used
Bit 5 = 0: No Broadcast
Bit 0-4 = adjustable frequency drive address 1-31

12 12

2. Address format 1-126:


Bit 7 = 1 (address format 1-126 active)
Bit 0-6 = adjustable frequency drive address
1-126
Bit 0-6 = 0 Broadcast
The follower returns the address byte unchanged to the
master in the response message.

12.7.5 Data Control Byte (BCC)


The checksum is calculated as an XOR-function. Before the
first byte in the message is received, the calculated
checksum is 0.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

191

Design Guide

12.7.6 The Data Field


The structure of data blocks depends on the type of message. There are three message types, and the type applies for both
control messages (masterfollower) and response messages (followermaster).
The three types of message are:
Process block (PCD)
The PCD is made up of a data block of four bytes (two words) and contains:

STX

Control word and reference value (from master to follower)


Status word and present output frequency (from follower to master)

LGE

ADR

PCD1

PCD2

130BA269.10

BCC

Figure 12.7 Process Block

STX

LGE

ADR

PKE

PWEhigh

IND

PWElow

PCD1

PCD2

BCC

130BA271.10

Parameter block
The parameter block is used to transfer parameters between master and follower. The data block is made up of 12 bytes
(six words) and also contains the process block.

Figure 12.8 Parameter Block

Text block
The text block is used to read or write texts via the data block.
STX

LGE

ADR

PKE

IND

Ch1

Ch2

Chn

PCD1

PCD2

BCC

130BA270.10

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Figure 12.9 Text Block

192

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.7.7 The PKE Field

PKE

IND

AK

PWEhigh

PWElow

130BA268.10

The PKE field contains two subfields: Parameter command


and response AK, and parameter number PNU:

PNU

Parameter
commands
and replies

Parameter
number

15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0

Figure 12.10 PKE Field

Bits no. 12-15 transfer parameter commands from master


to follower and return processed follower responses to the
master.
Bit no.

PWE low
(Hex)

Fault Report

The parameter number used does not exist

There is no write access to the defined parameter

Data value exceeds the parameter's limits

The sub index used does not exist

The parameter is not the array type.

The data type does not match the defined


parameter

11

Data change in the defined parameter is not


possible in the adjustable frequency drive's
present mode. Certain parameters can only be
changed when the motor is turned off

82

There is no bus access to the defined parameter

83

Data change is not possible because factory setup is selected

Table 12.6 Parameter Value Fault Report

12.7.8 Parameter Number (PNU)

Parameter command

15

14

13

12

No command

Read parameter value

Write parameter value in RAM (word)

Write parameter value in RAM (double


word)

Write parameter value in RAM and


EEPROM (double word)

Write parameter value in RAM and


EEPROM (word)

Read/write text

Bits no. 0-11 transfer parameter numbers. The function of


the relevant parameter is defined in the parameter
description in the Programming Guide.

12 12

12.7.9 Index (IND)


The index is used together with the parameter number to
read/write-access parameters with an index, e.g.,
15-30 Alarm Log: Error Code. The index consists of two
bytes, a low byte and a high byte.
Only the low byte is used as an index.

Table 12.4 Parameter Commands Master Follower


Bit no.

If the command cannot be performed, the follower sends


this response:
0111 Command cannot be performed
- and issues the following fault report in the parameter
value (PWE):

Response

15

14

13

12

No response

Parameter value transferred (word)

Parameter value transferred (double


word)

Command cannot be performed

text transferred

Table 12.5 Response Follower Master

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

193

Design Guide

12.7.10 Parameter Value (PWE)

12.7.11 Supported Data Types

The parameter value block consists of two words (four


bytes), and the value depends on the defined command
(AK). The master prompts for a parameter value when the
PWE block contains no value. To change a parameter value
(write), write the new value in the PWE block and send
from the master to the follower.

Unsigned means that there is no operational sign in the


message.

When a follower responds to a parameter request (read


command), the present parameter value in the PWE block
is transferred and returned to the master. If a parameter
contains not a numerical value, but several data options,
e.g., 0-01 Language where [0] is English, and [4] is Danish,
select the data value by entering the value in the PWE
block. See Example - Selecting a data value. Serial
communication is only capable of reading parameters
containing data type 9 (text string).
15-40 FC Type to 15-53 Power Card Serial Number contain
data type 9.
For example, read the unit size and AC line voltage range
in 15-40 FC Type. When a text string is transferred (read),
the length of the message is variable, and the texts are of
different lengths. The message length is defined in the
second byte of the message, LGE. When using text transfer
the index character indicates whether it is a read or a write
command.
To read a text via the PWE block, set the parameter
command (AK) to F Hex. The index character high-byte
must be 4.
Some parameters contain text that can be written to via
the serial bus. To write a text via the PWE block, set the
parameter command (AK) to F Hex. The index characters
high-byte must be 5.
PKE

IND

Read text

Fx xx

04 00

Write text

Fx xx

05 00

PWE high

PWE low

Data types

Description

Integer 16

Integer 32

Unsigned 8

Unsigned 16

Unsigned 32

Text string

10

Byte string

13

Time difference

33

Reserved

35

Bit sequence

Table 12.7 Supported Data Types

12.7.12 Conversion
The various attributes of each parameter are displayed in
factory setting. Parameter values are transferred as whole
numbers only. Conversion factors are therefore used to
transfer decimals.
4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz] has a conversion factor of
0.1. To preset the minimum frequency to 10 Hz, transfer
the value 100. A conversion factor of 0.1 means that the
value transferred is multiplied by 0.1. The value 100 is
therefore read as 10.0.
Examples:
0 s conversion index 0
0.00 s conversion index -2
0 ms conversion index -3
0.00 ms conversion index -5

130BA275.10

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Figure 12.11 Text via PWE Block

194

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Conversion index

The message looks like this:

Conversion factor

100
74

E19E

67
5

100000

10000

1000

100

10

-1

0.1

-2

0.01

-3

0.001

-4

0.0001

-5

0.00001

-6

0.000001

-7

0.0000001

PKE

IND

H 03E8

PWE high

PWE low

Figure 12.12 Write Data in EEPROM

NOTICE!
4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] is a single word, and the
parameter command for write in EEPROM is E.
Parameter number 4-14 is 19E in hexadecimal.
The response from the follower to the master is:

119E

H 0000

H 0000
PWE high

IND

PKE

H 03E8

PWE low

130BA093.10

1000000

H 0000

Figure 12.13 Response from Follower

Table 12.8 Conversion Table

12.7.13 Process Words (PCD)

12.8.2 Reading a Parameter Value

The block of process words is divided into two blocks of


16 bits, which always occur in the defined sequence.
PCD 1

PCD 2

Control message (masterfollower control


word)

Reference value

Control message (followermaster) status


word

Present output
frequency

Read the value in 3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp-up Time


PKE = 1155 Hex - Read parameter value in 3-41 Ramp 1
Ramp-up Time
IND = 0000 Hex
PWEHIGH = 0000 Hex
PWELOW = 0000 Hex

Table 12.9 Process Words (PCD)


1155

12.8 Examples

H 0000

PKE

0000

IND

PWE high

H 0000

PWE low

12 12
130BA094.10

H 0000

130BA092.10

75

Figure 12.14 Parameter Value

12.8.1 Writing a Parameter Value


Change 4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] to 100 Hz.
Write the data in EEPROM.
PKE = E19E Hex - Write single word in 4-14 Motor Speed
High Limit [Hz]
IND = 0000 Hex
PWEHIGH = 0000 Hex
PWELOW = 03E8 Hex - Data value 1000, corresponding to
100 Hz, see chapter 12.7.12 Conversion.

If the value in 3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp-up Time is 10 s, the


response from the follower to the master is

Figure 12.15 Response from Follower

3E8 Hex corresponds to 1000 decimal. The conversion


index for 3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp-up Time is -2, i.e., 0.01.
3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp-up Time is of the type Unsigned 32.
MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

195

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.9 Modbus RTU Overview


12.9.1 Assumptions
Danfoss assumes that the installed controller supports the
interfaces in this document, and strictly observes all
requirements and limitations stipulated in the controller
and adjustable frequency drive.

12.9.2 What the User Should Already Know


The built-in Modbus RTU (Remote Terminal Unit) is
designed to communicate with any controller that
supports the interfaces defined in this document. It is
assumed that the user has full knowledge of the
capabilities and limitations of the controller.

12.9.3 Modbus RTU Overview


Regardless of the type of physical communication
networks, the Modbus RTU Overview describes the process
a controller uses to request access to another device. This
process includes how the Modbus RTU responds to
requests from another device, and how errors are detected
and reported. It also establishes a common format for the
layout and contents of message fields.
During communications over a Modbus RTU network, the
protocol determines:

12 12

How each controller learns its device address

The master can address individual followers, or initiate a


broadcast message to all followers. Followers return a
response to queries that are addressed to them
individually. No responses are returned to broadcast
queries from the master. The Modbus RTU protocol
establishes the format for the masters query by providing
the device (or broadcast) address, a function code defining
the requested action, any data to be sent, and an errorchecking field. The followers response message is also
constructed using Modbus protocol. It contains fields
confirming the action taken, any data to be returned and
an error-checking field. If an error occurs in receipt of the
message, or if the follower is unable to perform the
requested action, the follower constructs an error message,
and send it in response, or a timeout occurs.

12.9.4 Adjustable Frequency Drive with


Modbus RTU
The adjustable frequency drive communicates in Modbus
RTU format over the built-in RS-485 interface. Modbus RTU
provides access to the control word and bus reference of
the adjustable frequency drive.
The control word allows the Modbus master to control
several important functions of the adjustable frequency
drive:

Recognizes a message addressed to it

Start
Stop of the adjustable frequency drive in various
ways:

Determines which actions to take

Coast stop

Extracts any data or other information contained


in the message

Quick stop

DC Brake stop

Normal (ramp) stop

If a reply is required, the controller constructs the reply


message and sends it.
Controllers communicate using a master-follower
technique in which only the master can initiate
transactions (called queries). Followers respond by
supplying the requested data to the master, or by taking
the action requested in the query.

Reset after a fault trip


Run at a variety of preset speeds
Run in reverse
Change the active set-up
Control the adjustable frequency drives built-in
relay

The bus reference is commonly used for speed control. It is


also possible to access the parameters, read their values,
and where possible, write values to them. This permits a
range of control options, including controlling the setpoint
of the adjustable frequency drive when its internal PI
controller is used.

196

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.10 Network Configuration

12.11.2 Modbus RTU Message Structure

To enable Modbus RTU on the adjustable frequency drive,


set the following parameters

The transmitting device places a Modbus RTU message


into a frame with a known beginning and ending point.
This allows receiving devices to begin at the start of the
message, read the address portion, determine which
device is addressed (or all devices, if the message is
broadcast), and to recognize when the message is
completed. Partial messages are detected, and errors are
set as a result. Characters for transmission must be in
hexadecimal 00 to FF format in each field. The adjustable
frequency drive continuously monitors the network bus,
also during silent intervals. When the first field (the
address field) is received, each adjustable frequency drive
or device decodes it to determine which device is being
addressed. Modbus RTU messages addressed to zero are
broadcast messages. No response is permitted for
broadcast messages. A typical message frame is shown in
Table 12.12.

Parameter

Setting

8-30 Protocol

Modbus RTU

8-31 Address

1247

8-32 Baud Rate

2400115200

8-33 Parity / Stop Bits

Even parity, 1 stop bit (default)

Table 12.10 Modbus RTU Parameters

12.11 Modbus RTU Message Framing


Structure
12.11.1 Adjustable Frequency Drive with
Modbus RTU
The controllers are set up to communicate on the Modbus
network using RTU (Remote Terminal Unit) mode, with
each byte in a message containing two 4-bit hexadecimal
characters. The format for each byte is shown in
Table 12.11.
Start
bit

Data byte

Stop/
parity

Stop

Table 12.11 Format for Each Byte


Coding System

8-bit binary, hexadecimal 0-9, A-F. 2


hexadecimal characters contained in each
8-bit field of the message

Bits Per Byte

1 start bit
8 data bits, least significant bit sent first
1 bit for even/odd parity; no bit for no
parity
1 stop bit if parity is used; 2 bits if no parity

Error Check Field

Cyclical Redundancy Check (CRC)

MG33BF22

Start

Address

Function

Data

CRC
check

End

T1-T2-T3T4

8 bits

8 bits

Nx8
bits

16 bits

T1-T2-T3T4

Table 12.12 Typical Modbus RTU Message Structure

12.11.3 Start/Stop Field


Messages start with a silent period of at least 3.5 character
intervals. This is implemented as a multiple of character
intervals at the selected network baud rate (shown as Start
T1-T2-T3-T4). The first field to be transmitted is the device
address. Following the last transmitted character, a similar
period of at least 3.5 character intervals marks the end of
the message. A new message can begin after this period.
The entire message frame must be transmitted as a
continuous stream. If a silent period of more than 1.5
character intervals occurs before completion of the frame,
the receiving device flushes the incomplete message and
assumes that the next byte is the address field of a new
message. Similarly, if a new message begins before 3.5
character intervals after a previous message, the receiving
device considers it a continuation of the previous message.
This causes a timeout (no response from the follower),
since the value in the final CRC field is not valid for the
combined messages.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

197

12 12

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.11.4 Address Field

12.11.7 CRC Check Field

The address field of a message frame contains 8 bits. Valid


follower device addresses are in the range of 0247
decimal. The individual follower devices are assigned
addresses in the range of 1247. (0 is reserved for
broadcast mode, which all followers recognize.) A master
addresses a follower by placing the follower address in the
address field of the message. When the follower sends its
response, it places its own address in this address field to
let the master know which follower is responding.

Messages include an error-checking field, operating based


on a Cyclical Redundancy Check (CRC) method. The CRC
field checks the contents of the entire message. It is
applied regardless of any parity check method used for the
individual characters of the message. The CRC value is
calculated by the transmitting device, which appends the
CRC as the last field in the message. The receiving device
recalculates a CRC during receipt of the message and
compares the calculated value to the actual value received
in the CRC field. If the two values are unequal, a bus
timeout results. The error-checking field contains a 16-bit
binary value implemented as two 8-bit bytes. When this is
done, the low-order byte of the field is appended first,
followed by the high-order byte. The CRC high-order byte
is the last byte sent in the message.

12.11.5 Function Field


The function field of a message frame contains 8 bits. Valid
codes are in the range of 1-FF. Function fields are used to
send messages between master and follower. When a
message is sent from a master to a follower device, the
function code field tells the follower what kind of action to
perform. When the follower responds to the master, it uses
the function code field to indicate either a normal (errorfree) response, or that some kind of error occurred (called
an exception response). For a normal response, the
follower simply echoes the original function code. For an
exception response, the follower returns a code that is
equivalent to the original function code with its most
significant bit set to logic 1. In addition, the follower places
a unique code into the data field of the response message.
This tells the master what kind of error occurred, or the
reason for the exception. Also refer to
chapter 12.11.10 Function Codes Supported by Modbus RTU
and chapter 12.11.11 Modbus Exception Codes.

12.11.6 Data Field

12.11.8 Coil Register Addressing


In Modbus, all data are organized in coils and holding
registers. Coils hold a single bit, whereas holding registers
hold a 2-byte word (i.e., 16 bits). All data addresses in
Modbus messages are referenced to zero. The first
occurrence of a data item is addressed as item number
zero. For example: The coil known as coil 1 in a
programmable controller is addressed as coil 0000 in the
data address field of a Modbus message. Coil 127 decimal
is addressed as coil 007EHEX (126 decimal).
Holding register 40001 is addressed as register 0000 in the
data address field of the message. The function code field
already specifies a holding register operation. Therefore,
the 4XXXX reference is implicit. Holding register 40108 is
addressed as register 006BHEX (107 decimal).

The data field is constructed using sets of two hexadecimal


digits, in the range of 00 to FF hexadecimal. These are
made up of one RTU character. The data field of messages
sent from a master to follower device contains additional
information which the follower must use to take the action
defined by the function code. This can include items such
as coil or register addresses, the quantity of items to be
handled and the count of actual data bytes in the field.

198

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

Coil number

Description

Signal direction

1-16

Adjustable frequency drive control word

Master to follower

17-32

Adjustable frequency driver speed or setpoint reference Range 0x00xFFFF


(-200% ... ~200%)

Master to follower

33-48

Adjustable frequency drive status word (see Table 12.15)

Follower to master

49-64

Open-loop mode: Adjustable frequency drive output frequency closed-loop


mode: Adjustable frequency drive feedback signal

Follower to master

Parameter write control (master to follower)

Master to follower

65

66-65536

0=

Parameter changes are written to the RAM of the adjustable


frequency drive.

1=

Parameter changes are written to the RAM and EEPROM of the


adjustable frequency drive.

Reserved

Table 12.13 Coil Descriptions


Coil

Coil

01

Preset reference LSB

33

Control not ready

Control ready

02

Preset reference MSB

34

03

DC brake

No DC brake

Adjustable frequency drive Adjustable frequency drive


not ready
ready

04

Coast stop

No coast stop

35

Coasting stop

Safety closed

No alarm

Alarm

05

Quick stop

No quick stop

36

06

Freeze freq.

No freeze freq.

37

Not used

Not used

07

Ramp stop

Start

38

Not used

Not used

08

No reset

Reset

39

Not used

Not used

09

No jog

Jog

40

No warning

Warning

10

Ramp 1

Ramp 2

41

Not at reference

At reference

Data valid

42

Hand mode

Auto mode

11

Data not valid

12

Relay 1 off

Relay 1 on

43

Out of freq. range

In frequency range

13

Relay 2 off

Relay 2 on

44

Stopped

Running

14

Set up LSB

45

Not used

Not used

15

Set up MSB

46

No voltage warning

Voltage warning

16

No reversing

47

Not in current limit

Current limit

48

No thermal warning

Thermal warning

Reversing

Table 12.14 Adjustable Frequency Drive Control Word


(FC Profile)

MG33BF22

12 12

Table 12.15 Adjustable Frequency Drive Status Word


(FC Profile)

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

199

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

12.11.10 Function Codes Supported by


Modbus RTU

Register
number

Description

00001-00006

Reserved

00007

Last error code from an FC data object interface

00008

Reserved

00009

Parameter index*

00010-00990

000 parameter group (parameters 001 through


099)

01000-01990

100 parameter group (parameters 100 through


199)

02000-02990

200 parameter group (parameters 200 through


299)

03000-03990

300 parameter group (parameters 300 through


399)

04000-04990

400 parameter group (parameters 400 through


499)

...

...

49000-49990

4900 parameter group (parameters 4900 through


4999)

50000

Input data: Adjustable frequency drive control


word register (CTW).

50010

Input data: Bus reference register (REF).

...

Modbus RTU supports use of the following function codes


in the function field of a message.
Function

Function code (hex)

Read coils

Read holding registers

Write single coil

Write single register

Write multiple coils

Write multiple registers

10

Get comm. event counter

Report follower ID

11

Table 12.17 Function Codes


Function

Function
Code

Subfunction
code

Sub-function

Diagnostics

Restart communication

Return diagnostic register

...

10

50200

Output data: Adjustable frequency drive status


word register (STW).

Clear counters and


diagnostic register

11

Return bus message count

50210

Output data: Adjustable frequency drive main


actual value register (MAV).

12

Return bus communication error count

13

Return follower error


count

14

Return follower message


count

Table 12.16 Holding Registers


* Used to specify the index number to be used when accessing an
indexed parameter.

12.11.9 How to Control the Adjustable


Frequency Drive
This section describes codes which can be used in the
function and data fields of a Modbus RTU message.

200

Table 12.18 Function Codes

12.11.11 Modbus Exception Codes


For a full explanation of the structure of an exception code
response, refer to chapter 12.11.5 Function Field.
Code Name

Meaning

The function code received in the query is


not an allowable action for the server (or
follower). This may be because the
function code is only applicable to newer
devices and was not implemented in the
unit selected. It could also indicate that
the server (or follower) is in the wrong
state to process a request of this type, for
example, because it is not configured and
is being asked to return register values.

Illegal
function

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

Code Name

Meaning

12.12.3 IND (Index)

Illegal data
address

The data address received in the query is


not an allowable address for the server
(or follower). More specifically, the
combination of reference number and
transfer length is invalid. For a controller
with 100 registers, a request with offset
96 and length 4 would succeed, a request
with offset 96 and length 5 generates
exception 02.

Some parameters in the adjustable frequency drive are


array parameters, e.g., 3-10 Preset Reference. Since the
Modbus does not support arrays in the holding registers,
the adjustable frequency drive has reserved the holding
register 9 as pointer to the array. Before reading or writing
an array parameter, set the holding register 9. Setting
holding register to the value of 2 causes all following read/
write to array parameters to be to the index 2.

Illegal data
value

A value contained in the query data field


is not an allowable value for server (or
follower). This indicates a fault in the
structure of the remainder of a complex
request, such as that the implied length is
incorrect. It specifically does NOT mean
that a data item submitted for storage in
a register has a value outside the
expectation of the application program,
since the Modbus protocol is unaware of
the significance of any particular value of
any particular register.

Follower
An unrecoverable error occurred while the
device failure server (or follower) was attempting to
perform the requested action.

Table 12.19 Modbus Exception Codes

12.12 How to Access Parameters

12.12.4 Text Blocks


Parameters stored as text strings are accessed in the same
way as the other parameters. The maximum text block size
is 20 characters. If a read request for a parameter is for
more characters than the parameter stores, the response is
truncated. If the read request for a parameter is for fewer
characters than the parameter stores, the response is
padded with spaces.

12.12.5 Conversion Factor


The different attributes for each parameter can be seen in
the section on factory settings. Since a parameter value
can only be transferred as a whole number, a conversion
factor must be used to transfer decimals.

12.12.6 Parameter Values

12.12.1 Parameter Handling


The PNU (Parameter Number) is translated from the
register address contained in the Modbus read or write
message. The parameter number is translated to Modbus
as (10 x parameter number) DECIMAL. Example: Reading
3-12 Catch up/slow-down Value (16 bit): The holding
register 3120 holds the parameters value. A value of 1352
(Decimal) means that the parameter is set to 12.52%
Reading 3-14 Preset Relative Reference (32 bit): The holding
registers 3410 and 3411 hold the parameters value. A
value of 11300 (Decimal) means that the parameter is set
to 1113.00.
For information on the parameters, size and converting
index, consult the product relevant programming guide.

Standard data types


Standard data types are int 16, int 32, uint 8, uint 16 and
uint 32. They are stored as 4x registers (400014FFFF). The
parameters are read using function 03hex "Read Holding
Registers." Parameters are written using the function 6hex
"Preset Single Register" for 1 register (16 bits), and the
function 10 hex "Preset Multiple Registers" for two registers
(32 bits). Readable sizes range from one register (16 bits)
up to ten registers (20 characters).
Non-standard data types
Non-standard data types are text strings and are stored as
4x registers (400014FFFF). The parameters are read using
function 03hex "Read Holding Registers" and written using
function 10hex "Preset Multiple Registers." Readable sizes
range from one register (two characters) up to ten
registers (20 characters).

12.12.2 Storage of Data


The Coil 65 decimal determines whether data written to
the adjustable frequency drive are stored in EEPROM and
RAM (coil 65=1) or only in RAM (coil 65=0).

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

201

12 12

12 12

Design Guide

RS-485 Installation and Set...

12.13 Danfoss FC Control Profile

NOTICE!

12.13.1 Control Word According to FC


Profile (8-10 Control Profile = FC
profile)

Make a selection in 8-56 Preset Reference Select to define


how Bit 00/01 gates with the corresponding function on
the digital inputs.

CTW

Bit
no.:

130BA274.11

Master-follower
Speed ref.

15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0

Figure 12.16 Control Word

Bit

Bit value = 0

Bit value = 1

00

Reference value

External selection lsb

01

Reference value

External selection msb

02

DC brake

Ramp

03

Coasting

No coasting

04

Quick stop

Ramp

05

Hold output frequency

Use ramp

06

Ramp stop

Start

07

No function

Reset

08

No function

Jog

09

Ramp 1

Ramp 2

10

Data invalid

Data valid

11

No function

Relay 01 active

12

No function

Relay 02 active

13

Parameter set-up

Selection lsb

14

Parameter set-up

Selection msb

15

No function

Reverse

Make a selection in 8-50 Coasting Select to define how Bit


03 gates with the corresponding function on a digital
input.

Bit 05, Hold output frequency


Bit 05 = 0: The present output frequency (in Hz) freezes.
Change the frozen output frequency only with the digital
inputs (5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input to 5-15 Terminal 33
Digital Input) programmed to Speed up and Slow-down.

NOTICE!
If Freeze output is active, the adjustable frequency drive
can only be stopped by the following:

Explanation of the Control Bits


Bits 00/01
Bits 00 and 01 are used to select between the four
reference values, which are pre-programmed in 3-10 Preset
Reference according to Table 12.21.
Programmed ref.
value

Parameter

Bit 01

Bit 00

3-10 Preset
Reference [0]

3-10 Preset
Reference [1]

3-10 Preset
Reference [2]

3-10 Preset
Reference [3]

202

Bit 03, Coasting


Bit 03 = 0: The adjustable frequency drive immediately
"lets go" of the motor (the output transistors are "shut
off"), and it coasts to a standstill.
Bit 03 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive starts the
motor if the other starting conditions are met.

Bit 04, Quick stop


Bit 04 = 0: Makes the motor speed ramp down to stop
(set in 3-81 Quick Stop Ramp Time).

Table 12.20 Control Word Bits

Table 12.21 Reference Values

Bit 02, DC brake


Bit 02 = 0 leads to DC braking and stop. Set braking
current and duration in 2-01 DC Brake Current and 2-02 DC
Braking Time.
Bit 02 = 1 leads to ramping.

Bit 03 Coasting stop


Bit 02 DC braking
Digital input (5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input to
5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input) programmed to
DC braking, Coasting stop, or Reset and coasting
stop

Bit 06, Ramp stop/start


Bit 06 = 0: Causes a stop and makes the motor speed
ramp down to stop via the selected ramp-down parameter.
Bit 06 = 1: Permits the adjustable frequency drive to start
the motor if the other starting conditions are met.
Make a selection in 8-53 Start Select to define how Bit 06
Ramp stop/start gates with the corresponding function on
a digital input.
Bit 07, Reset
Bit 07 = 0: No reset. Bit 07 = 1: Resets a trip. Reset is
activated on the leading edge of the signal, i.e. when
changing from logic 0 to logic 1.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Bit 08, Jog


Bit 08 = 1: The output frequency is determined by
3-19 Jog Speed [RPM].

12.13.2 Status Word According to FC


Profile (STW) (8-10 Control Profile =
FC profile)

Bit 09, Selection of ramp 1/2


Bit 09 = "0": Ramp 1 is active (3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp-up Time
to 3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp-down Time). Bit 09 = "1": Ramp 2
(3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp-up Time to 3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp-down
Time) is active.
Bit 10, Data not valid/Data valid
Tell the adjustable frequency drive whether to use or
ignore the control word.
Bit 10 = 0: The control word is ignored. Bit 10 = 1: The
control word is used. This function is relevant because the
message always contains the control word, regardless of
the message type. Turn off the control word if it should
not be used when updating or reading parameters.
Bit 11, Relay 01
Bit 11 = "0": Relay not activated.
Bit 11 = "1": Relay 01 activated provided that Control word
bit 11 is selected in 5-40 Function Relay.
Bit 12, Relay 04
Bit 12 = "0": Relay 04 is not activated.
Bit 12 = "1": Relay 04 is activated provided that Control
word bit 12 is selected in 5-40 Function Relay.
Bit 13/14, Selection of set-up
Use bits 13 and 14 to select from the four menu set-ups
according to Table 12.22.
Set-up

Bit 14

Bit 13

STW

Bit
no.:

Output freq.

15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0

Figure 12.17 Status Word

Bit

Bit = 0

Bit = 1

00

Control not ready

Control ready

01

Drive not ready

Drive ready

02

Coasting

Enable

03

No error

Trip

04

No error

Error (no trip)

05

Reserved

06

No error

Trip lock

07

No warning

Warning

08

Speed reference

Speed = reference

09

Local operation

Bus control

10

Out of frequency limit

Frequency limit OK

11

No operation

In operation

12

Drive OK

Stopped, auto-start

13

Voltage OK

Voltage exceeded

14

Torque OK

Torque exceeded

15

Timer OK

Timer exceeded

12 12

Table 12.23 Status Word Bits

Explanation of the Status Bits

Table 12.22 Four Menu Set-ups

The function is only possible when Multi Set-ups is selected


in 0-10 Active Set-up.
Make a selection in 8-55 Set-up Select to define how Bit
13/14 gates with the corresponding function on the digital
inputs.
Bit 15 Reverse
Bit 15 = 0: No reversing.
Bit 15 = 1: Reversing. In the default setting, reversing is
set to digital in 8-54 Reverse Select. Bit 15 causes reversing
only when ser. communication, logic or OR logic and is
selected.

MG33BF22

Follower-master

130BA273.11

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Bit 00, Control not ready/ready


Bit 00 = 0: The adjustable frequency drive trips.
Bit 00 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive controls are
ready, but the power component does not necessarily
receive any power supply (in case of external 24 V supply
to controls).
Bit 01, Drive ready
Bit 01 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive is ready for
operation, but the coasting command is active via the
digital inputs or via serial communication.
Bit 02, Coasting stop
Bit 02 = 0: The adjustable frequency drive releases the
motor.
Bit 02 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive starts the
motor with a start command.

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

203

Design Guide

Bit 04, No error/error (no trip)


Bit 04 = 0: The adjustable frequency drive is not in fault
mode. Bit 04 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive shows
an error but does not trip.
Bit 05, Not used
Bit 05 is not used in the status word.
Bit 06, No error/triplock
Bit 06 = 0: The adjustable frequency drive is not in fault
mode. Bit 06 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive is
tripped and locked.
Bit 07, No warning/warning
Bit 07 = 0: There are no warnings. Bit 07 = 1: A warning
has occurred.
Bit 08, Speed reference/speed = reference
Bit 08 = 0: The motor is running, but the present speed is
different from the preset speed reference. For example,
this might be the case when the speed ramps up/down
during start/stop.
Bit 08 = 1: The motor speed matches the preset speed
reference.
Bit 09, Local operation/bus control
Bit 09 = 0: [STOP/RESET] is activated on the control unit
or Local control in 3-13 Reference Site is selected. Control
via serial communication is not possible.
Bit 09 = 1 It is possible to control the adjustable
frequency drive via the serial communication / bus
communication.
Bit 10, Out of frequency limit
Bit 10 = 0: The output frequency has reached the value in
4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM] or 4-13 Motor Speed High
Limit [RPM].
Bit 10 = "1": The output frequency is within the defined
limits.
Bit 11, No operation/in operation
Bit 11 = 0: The motor is not running.
Bit 11 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive has a start
signal, or the output frequency is greater than 0 Hz.

Bit 14, Torque OK/limit exceeded


Bit 14 = 0: The motor current is lower than the torque
limit selected in 4-18 Current Limit.
Bit 14 = 1: The torque limit in 4-18 Current Limit is
exceeded.
Bit 15, Timer OK/limit exceeded
Bit 15 = 0: The timers for motor thermal protection and
thermal protection are not exceeded 100%.
Bit 15 = 1: One of the timers exceeds 100%.
All bits in the STW are set to 0 if the connection between
the Interbus option and the adjustable frequency drive is
lost, or if an internal communication problem has occurred.

12.13.3 Bus Speed Reference Value


Speed reference value is transmitted to the adjustable
frequency drive in a relative value expressed as %. The
value is transmitted in the form of a 16-bit word; in
integers (032767) the value 16384 (4000 hex) corresponds
to 100%. Negative figures are formatted by means of 2s
complement. The actual output frequency (MAV) is scaled
in the same way as the bus reference.
Master-follower

130BA276.11

Bit 03, No error/trip


Bit 03 =0: The adjustable frequency drive is not in fault
mode. Bit 03 = 1: The adjustable frequency drive trips. To
re-establish operation, enter [Reset].

16bit
CTW

Speed ref.

Follower-master
Actual output
freq.

STW

Figure 12.18 Actual Output Frequency (MAV)

The reference and MAV are scaled as follows:


-100%

0%

(C000hex)

100%

(0hex)

(4000hex)

Par.3-00 set to
Reverse

(1) -max- +max

Par.3-03

Forward

Par.3-03

Max reference

Max reference

0%

100%

(0hex)

Bit 12, Drive OK/stopped, autostart


Bit 12 = 0: There is no temporary overtemperature on the
inverter.
Bit 12 = 1: The inverter stops because of overtemperature,
but the unit does not trip and resumes operation once the
overtemperature stops.

130BA277.10

12 12

RS-485 Installation and Set...

(4000hex)

Par.3-00 set to
Forward

(0) min-max

Par.3-02
Min reference

Par.3-03
Max reference

Figure 12.19 Reference and MAV

Bit 13, Voltage OK/limit exceeded


Bit 13 = 0: There are no voltage warnings.
Bit 13 = 1: The DC voltage in the adjustable frequency
drives intermediate circuit is too low or too high.

204

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Design Guide

RS-485 Installation and Set...

NOTICE!

12.13.4 Control Word according to


PROFIdrive Profile (CTW)
The control word is used to send commands from a master
(for example, a PC) to a follower.
Bit

Bit=0

Bit=1

00

OFF 1

ON 1

01

OFF 2

ON 2

02

OFF 3

ON 3

03

Coasting

No coasting

04

Quick stop

Ramp

05

Hold frequency output

Use ramp

06

Ramp stop

Start

07

No function

Reset

08

Jog 1 OFF

Jog 1 ON

09

Jog 2 OFF

Jog 2 ON

10

Data invalid

Data valid

11

No function

Slow-down

12

No function

Catch up

13

Parameter set-up

Selection lsb

14

Parameter set-up

Selection msb

15

No function

Reverse

Bit 04, Quick stop/Ramp


Quick stop using the ramp time of 3-81 Quick Stop Ramp
Time.
When bit 04="0", a quick stop occurs.
When bit 04="1", the adjustable frequency drive can start if
the other start conditions are satisfied.

NOTICE!
The selection in 8-51 Quick Stop Select determines how
bit 04 is linked with the corresponding function of the
digital inputs.
Bit 05, Hold frequency output/Use ramp
When bit 05="0", the current output frequency is being
maintained even if the reference value is modified.
When bit 05="1", the adjustable frequency drive can
perform its regulating function again; operation occurs
according to the respective reference value.

Table 12.24 Control Word Bits

Explanation of the control bits


Bit 00, OFF 1/ON 1
Normal ramp stops using the ramp times of the actual
selected ramp.
Bit 00="0" leads to the stop and activation of the output
relay 1 or 2 if the output frequency is 0 Hz and if [Relay
123] has been selected in 5-40 Function Relay.
When bit 0="1", the adjustable frequency drive is in State
1: Switching on inhibited.
Bit 01, OFF 2/ON 2
Coasting stop
When bit 01="0", a coasting stop and activation of the
output relay 1 or 2 occurs if the output frequency is 0 Hz
and if [Relay 123] has been selected in 5-40 Function Relay.
Bit 02, OFF 3/ON 3
Quick stop using the ramp time of 3-81 Quick Stop Ramp
Time. When bit 02="0", a quick stop and activation of the
output relay 1 or 2 occurs if the output frequency is 0 Hz
and if [Relay 123] has been selected in 5-40 Function Relay.
When bit 02="1", the adjustable frequency drive is in State
1: Switching on inhibited.
Bit 03, Coasting/No coasting
Coasting stop Bit 03="0" leads to a stop.
When bit 03="1", the adjustable frequency drive can start if
the other start conditions are satisfied.

MG33BF22

The selection in 8-50 Coasting Select determines how bit


03 is linked with the corresponding function of the
digital inputs.

Bit 06, Ramp stop/Start


Normal ramp stop using the ramp times of the actual
ramp as selected. In addition, activation of the output relay
01 or 04 if the output frequency is 0 Hz if Relay 123 has
been selected in 5-40 Function Relay. Bit 06="0" leads to a
stop. When bit 06="1", the adjustable frequency drive can
start if the other start conditions are satisfied.

NOTICE!
The selection in 8-53 Start Select determines how bit 06
is linked with the corresponding function of the digital
inputs.
Bit 07, No function/Reset
Reset after switching off.
Acknowledges event in fault buffer.
When bit 07="0", no reset occurs.
When there is a slope change of bit 07 to "1", a reset
occurs after switching off.
Bit 08, Jog 1 OFF/ON
Activation of the pre-programmed speed in 8-90 Bus Jog 1
Speed. JOG 1 is only possible if bit 04="0" and bit
00-03="1".
Bit 09, Jog 2 OFF/ON
Activation of the pre-programmed speed in 8-91 Bus Jog 2
Speed. JOG 2 is only possible if bit 04="0" and bit
00-03="1".

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

205

12 12

12 12

Design Guide

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Bit 10, Data invalid/valid


Is used to tell the adjustable frequency drive whether the
control word is to be used or ignored.
Bit 10=0 causes the control word to be ignored,
Bit 10=1 causes the control word to be used. This
function is relevant because the control word is always
contained in the message regardless of which type of
message is used, that is, it is possible to turn off the
control word if it should not be used for updating or
reading parameters.

12.13.5 Status Word according to


PROFIdrive Profile (STW)

Bit 11, No function/Slow-down


Is used to reduce the speed reference value by the amount
given in 3-12 Catch up/slow-down Value value. When bit
11="0", no modification of the reference value occurs.
When bit 11="1", the reference value is reduced.
Bit 12, No function/Catch up
Is used to increase the speed reference value by the
amount given in 3-12 Catch up/slow-down Value.
When bit 12="0", no modification of the reference value
occurs.
When bit 12="1", the reference value is increased.
If both slowing down and accelerating are activated (bit 11
and 12="1"), slowing down has priority, that is, the speed
reference value is reduced.
Bits 13/14, Set-up selection
Bits 13 and 14 are used to select between the four
parameter set-ups according to Table 12.25:
The function is only possible if [9] Multi Set-up has been
selected in 0-10 Active Set-up. The selection in 8-55 Set-up
Select determines how bits 13 and 14 are linked with the
corresponding function of the digital inputs. Changing setup while running is only possible if the set-ups have been
linked in 0-12 This Set-up Linked to.
Set-up

Bit 13

Bit 14

Table 12.25 Set-up Selection

Bit 15, No function/Reverse


Bit 15=0 causes no reversing.
Bit 15=1 causes reversing.
Note: In the factory setting, reversing is set to digital in
8-54 Reverse Select.

The status word is used to notify a master (for example, a


PC) about the status of a follower.
Bit

Bit=0

Bit=1

00

Control not ready

Control ready

01

Drive not ready

Drive ready

02

Coasting

Enable

03

No error

Trip

04

OFF 2

ON 2

05

OFF 3

ON 3

06

Start possible

Start not possible

07

No warning

Warning

08

Speed reference

Speed=reference

09

Local operation

Bus control

10

Out of frequency limit Frequency limit ok

11

No operation

In operation

12

Drive OK

Stopped, autostart

13

Voltage OK

Voltage exceeded

14

Torque OK

Torque exceeded

15

Timer OK

Timer exceeded

Table 12.26 Status Word Bits

Explanation of the status bits


Bit 00, Control not ready/ready
When bit 00="0", bit 00, 01 or 02 of the Control word is "0"
(OFF 1, OFF 2 or OFF 3) - or the adjustable frequency drive
is switched off (trip).
When bit 00="1", the adjustable frequency drive control is
ready, but there is not necessarily power supply to the unit
present (in the event of external 24 V supply of the control
system).
Bit 01, VLT not ready/ready
Same significance as bit 00, however, there is a supply
from the power unit. The adjustable frequency drive is
ready when it receives the necessary start signals.
Bit 02, Coasting/Enable
When bit 02="0", bit 00, 01 or 02 of the control word is "0"
(OFF 1, OFF 2 or OFF 3 or coasting) - or the adjustable
frequency drive is switched off (trip).
When bit 02="1", bit 00, 01 or 02 of the control word is
"1"; the adjustable frequency drive has not tripped.

NOTICE!
Bit 15 causes reversing only when Ser. communication,
Logic or or Logic and is selected.

206

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

RS-485 Installation and Set...

Design Guide

Bit 03, No error/Trip


When bit 03="0", no error condition of the adjustable
frequency drive exists.
When bit 03="1", the adjustable frequency drive has
tripped and requires a reset signal before it can start.
Bit 04, ON 2/OFF 2
When bit 01 of the control word is "0", then bit 04="0".
When bit 01 of the control word is "1", then bit 04="1".
Bit 05, ON 3/OFF 3
When bit 02 of the control word is "0", then bit 05="0".
When bit 02 of the control word is "1", then bit 05="1".
Bit 06, Start possible/Start not possible
If PROFIdrive has been selected in 8-10 Control Word Profile,
bit 06 is "1" after a switch-off acknowledgment, after
activation of OFF2 or OFF3, and after switching on the AC
line voltage. Start not possible is reset with bit 00 of the
control word being set to "0" and bit 01, 02 and 10 being
set to "1".
Bit 07, No warning/Warning
Bit 07=0 means that there are no warnings.
Bit 07=1 means that a warning has occurred.
Bit 08, Speedreference/Speed=reference
When bit 08="0", the current speed of the motor deviates
from the set speed reference value. This may occur, for
example, when the speed is being changed during start/
stop through ramp up/down.
When bit 08="1", the current speed of the motor
corresponds to the set speed reference value.

Bit 12, Drive OK/Stopped, autostart


When bit 12="0", there is no temporary overloading of the
inverter.
When bit 12="1", the inverter has stopped due to
overloading. However, the adjustable frequency drive has
not switched off (trip) and starts again after the
overloading has ended.
Bit 13, Voltage OK/Voltage exceeded
When bit 13 = "0", the voltage limits of the adjustable
frequency drive are not exceeded.
When bit 13 = "1", the direct voltage in the intermediate
circuit of the adjustable frequency drive is too low or too
high.
Bit 14, Torque OK/Torque exceeded
When bit 14="0", the motor torque is below the limit
selected in 4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and 4-17 Torque
Limit Generator Mode.
When bit 14="1", the limit selected in 4-16 Torque Limit
Motor Mode or 4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode is
exceeded.
Bit 15, Timer OK/Timer exceeded
When bit 15="0", the timers for the thermal motor
protection and thermal adjustable frequency drive
protection have not exceeded 100%.
When bit 15="1", one of the timers has exceeded 100%.

Bit 09, Local operation/Bus control


Bit 09="0" indicates that the adjustable frequency drive has
been stopped with [Stop] on the LCP, or that [Linked to
hand] or [Local] has been selected in 3-13 Reference Site.
When bit 09="1", the adjustable frequency drive can be
controlled through the serial interface.

12 12

Bit 10, Out of frequency limit/Frequency limit OK


When bit 10="0", the output frequency is outside the limits
set in 4-52 Warning Speed Low and 4-53 Warning Speed
High.
When bit 10="1", the output frequency is within the
indicated limits.
Bit 11, No operation/Operation
When bit 11="0", the motor does not turn.
When bit 11 = "1", the adjustable frequency drive has a
start signal, or the output frequency is higher than 0 Hz.

MG33BF22

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

207

Index

Design Guide

Index

Cooling.............................................................................................. 50, 52
Cooling conditions............................................................................ 121

A
Abbreviations........................................................................................... 9

Accessory bags...................................................................................... 97

DC brake................................................................................................ 202

Acoustic noise................................................................................. 51, 90

DC bus connection............................................................................ 148

Airflow...................................................................................................... 52

DC link................................................................................................ 20, 61

AMA with T27 connected................................................................ 154

Dead band............................................................................................... 35

AMA without T27 connected......................................................... 154

Decoupling plate................................................................................ 142

Ambient conditions............................................................................. 76

Definitions............................................................................................... 10

Analog inputs............................................................................... 78, 163

Derating automatic.............................................................................. 41

Analog output.............................................................................. 79, 163

Derating, low air pressure................................................................. 50

Analog speed reference.................................................................. 155

Derating, manual.................................................................................. 50

Application examples....................................................................... 154

Derating, running at low speed...................................................... 50


DeviceNet................................................................................................ 96

Digital inputs................................................................................ 77, 163

Brake function........................................................................................ 63

Digital output............................................................................... 79, 163

Brake IGBT............................................................................................... 16

Directive EMC......................................................................................... 11

Brake resistor......................................................................... 16, 61, 182

Directive low-voltage.......................................................................... 11

Brake resistor cabling.......................................................................... 63

Directive machinery............................................................................ 11

Braking energy............................................................................... 10, 63

Discharge time...................................................................................... 14

Braking time........................................................................................... 62

Disposal instruction............................................................................. 12

Branch circuit protection................................................................. 133

Dust........................................................................................................... 52

Cabinet heater....................................................................................... 49

Efficiency.................................................................................................. 90

Cable, lengths and cross-sections.................................................. 76

Electrical interference....................................................................... 123

Cable, motor........................................................................................ 150

Electro-mechanical brake............................................................... 159

Cable, shielded/armored................................................................. 142

EMC emissions....................................................................................... 53

Cable, specifications............................................................................ 76

EMC interference.................................................................................. 19

Catch up/slow-down........................................................................... 33

EMC precautions................................................................................ 189

CE mark.................................................................................................... 11

EMC test results..................................................................................... 54

Circuit breaker........................................................................... 129, 133

Emission requirements....................................................................... 56

Coast....................................................................................... 10, 202, 203

Environment........................................................................................... 76

Condensation........................................................................................ 49

Equipment optional............................................................................... 9

Conducted emission........................................................................... 55

External alarm reset........................................................................... 156

Constant torque applications (CT mode).................................... 50

Extreme running conditions............................................................. 39

Control card..................................................................................... 79, 80


Control characteristics........................................................................ 80

Control logic........................................................................................... 15

Filter........................................................................................................... 52

Control wiring.............................................................................. 19, 123

Filter RFI............................................................................................ 51, 90

Control word.............................................................................. 202, 205

Filter sine-wave..................................................................................... 15

Conventions.............................................................................................. 9

Filters......................................................................................................... 52

208

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Index

Design Guide

Flux..................................................................................................... 22, 23

MCT 31................................................................................................... 149

Freeze reference................................................................................... 33

Mechanical brake................................................................................. 45

Front cover tightening torque............................................. 119, 120

Mechanical brake control................................................................ 158

Function code..................................................................................... 200

Mechanical dimensions......................................................... 0

Fuse......................................................................................................... 133

Mechanical mounting...................................................................... 121

, 119

Message length (LGE)....................................................................... 191

Modbus exception code.................................................................. 200

Galvanic isolation............................................................................... 175

Modbus RTU......................................................................................... 196

Ground wire......................................................................................... 123

Modbus RTU overview..................................................................... 196


Moment of inertia................................................................................. 39

Motor cable..................................................................... 0

, 0

, 150

Harmonic Calculation Software (HCS)........................................ 149

Motor connection.............................................................................. 142

Harmonic filters.................................................................................. 111

Motor feedback..................................................................................... 23

HCS.......................................................................................................... 149

Motor output......................................................................................... 75

High voltage........................................................................................... 13

Motor phases......................................................................................... 39

High voltage test................................................................................ 153

Motor power........................................................................................ 123

HTL encoder......................................................................................... 177

Motor thermal protection............................................................... 204

Humidity.................................................................................................. 49

Motor thermistor................................................................................ 157


Motor voltage........................................................................................ 87

I
Immunity requirements..................................................................... 57
Input power.................................................................................. 19, 123

Motor wiring........................................................................................... 19
Motor-generated overvoltage......................................................... 39

Intermediate circuit............................................................... 15, 39, 87

Inverter..................................................................................................... 15

Network connection......................................................................... 189

IP21/Type 1 enclosure kit................................................................ 183

Options and accessories.................................................................... 97

Jog........................................................................................................... 203

Ordering from type code................................................................... 91


Ordering numbers............................................................... 91, 97, 115

K
Knockouts............................................................................................. 125

Ordering numbers, sine-wave filters........................................... 113


Output performance (U, V, W)......................................................... 75

L
Latched start/stop inverse.............................................................. 155
LCP.................................................................................................... 29, 185
Leakage current................................................................. 14, 123, 144
Line drop-out......................................................................................... 43
Line power disconnector................................................................ 147
Line power supply............................................. 11, 59, 69, 70, 71, 75
Load sharing........................................................................................... 16

Output, 24 V DC.................................................................................... 79

P
PELV........................................................................................................ 154
Performance........................................................................................... 80
PID...................................................................................... 19, 21, 24, 175
Point of common coupling............................................................... 59
Potential equalization...................................................................... 123
Potentiometer..................................................................................... 156

M
Maintenance.......................................................................................... 52
MCT 10................................................................................................... 149
MG33BF22

Ordering numbers, harmonic filters............................................ 111

Precautions general............................................................................. 12
Preset speeds....................................................................................... 156
Process PID control.............................................................................. 27

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

209

Index

Design Guide

Profibus.................................................................................................... 96

Speed PID.................................................................................. 19, 21, 24

Programming of Torque Limit and Stop................................... 159

Speed reference........................................................................ 154, 156

Protection................................................................................................ 61

Start/stop command......................................................................... 155

Protocol overview.............................................................................. 190

Status word................................................................................. 203, 206

Pulse start/stop................................................................................... 155

Switching on the output.................................................................... 40

Pulse width modulation..................................................................... 15


Pulse/encoder inputs.......................................................................... 78

T
Temperature........................................................................................... 49

Temperature ambient......................................................................... 49

Qualified personnel............................................................................. 13

Temperature maximum..................................................................... 49
Temperature sensor.......................................................................... 175

Terminal X30/11, 12.......................................................................... 163

Radiated emission................................................................................ 55

Terminal X30/1-4................................................................................ 163

Rectifier.................................................................................................... 15

Terminal X30/6, 7............................................................................... 163

Reference.............................................................................................. 154

Terminal X30/8.................................................................................... 163

Reference limits..................................................................................... 33

Thermal Protection.............................................................................. 12

Relay connection................................................................................ 146

Thermistor..................................................................................... 11, 154

Relay outputs......................................................................................... 80

Torque characteristics......................................................................... 75

Reversing............................................................................................... 156

Torque control....................................................................................... 19

Rise time.................................................................................................. 87

Torque, front cover tightening............................................ 119, 120

RS-485........................................................................................... 157, 188

TTL encoder.......................................................................................... 177

RS-485 installation and set-up...................................................... 188


RS-485 serial communication.......................................................... 79

U
U/f........................................................................................................ 20, 90

Unintended start................................................................................... 13

Safe Stop 1............................................................................................ 177

USB serial communication................................................................ 79

Safe Torque Off.......................................................................... 155, 177


Safety control system....................................................................... 177

Safety requirements.......................................................................... 117

Variable (quadratic) torque applications (VT)............................ 50

Scaling...................................................................................................... 34

Vibration.................................................................................................. 51

Sensor........................................................................................... 175, 177

Voltage level........................................................................................... 77

Sensor current....................................................................................... 15

VVCplus...................................................................................... 10, 15, 21

Sensor thermal...................................................................................... 15
Serial communication......................................................................... 79

Shielded cable....................................................................................... 19

Windmilling............................................................................................ 14

Shielded/armored.............................................................................. 142

Wiring schematic.................................................................................. 17

Shock......................................................................................................... 51
Short circuit (motor phase phase).............................................. 39
Short circuit ratio.................................................................................. 60
Side-by-side installation.................................................................. 121
Signal...................................................................................................... 177
Sine-wave filter................................................................ 113, 142, 182
Software versions................................................................................. 97

210

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

MG33BF22

Index

MG33BF22

Design Guide

Rev. 2014-04-04 All rights reserved.

211

www.danfoss.com/drives
Danfoss shall not be responsible for any errors in catalogs, brochures or other printed material. Danfoss reserves the right to alter its products at any time without notice, provided that alterations to
products already on order shall not require material changes in specifications previously agreed upon by Danfoss and the Purchaser. All trademarks in this material are property of the respective
companies. Danfoss and the Danfoss logotype are trademarks of Danfoss A/S. All rights reserved.

Danfoss A/S
Ulsnaes 1
DK-6300 Graasten
www.danfoss.com/drives

130R0301

MG33BF22

*MG33BF22*

Rev. 2014-04-04

You might also like